WO2017139603A1 - Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators - Google Patents

Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2017139603A1
WO2017139603A1 PCT/US2017/017408 US2017017408W WO2017139603A1 WO 2017139603 A1 WO2017139603 A1 WO 2017139603A1 US 2017017408 W US2017017408 W US 2017017408W WO 2017139603 A1 WO2017139603 A1 WO 2017139603A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
compound
alkyl
disorder
methyl
disease
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2017/017408
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Theodore M. Kamenecka
Jörg Holenz
Steven Wesolowski
Yuanjun He
Roland BÜRLI
Original Assignee
Astrazeneca Ab
Eolas Therapeutics, Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Priority to BR112018016446-1A priority Critical patent/BR112018016446B1/en
Priority to AU2017217931A priority patent/AU2017217931B2/en
Application filed by Astrazeneca Ab, Eolas Therapeutics, Inc. filed Critical Astrazeneca Ab
Priority to RS20220714A priority patent/RS63471B1/en
Priority to SG11201806368VA priority patent/SG11201806368VA/en
Priority to CN201780022666.9A priority patent/CN109219606B/en
Priority to ES17750847T priority patent/ES2923790T3/en
Priority to MYPI2018702747A priority patent/MY195239A/en
Priority to PL17750847.0T priority patent/PL3414241T3/en
Priority to CA3013927A priority patent/CA3013927C/en
Priority to HRP20220906TT priority patent/HRP20220906T1/en
Priority to CR20180429A priority patent/CR20180429A/en
Priority to DK17750847.0T priority patent/DK3414241T3/en
Priority to TNP/2018/000280A priority patent/TN2018000280A1/en
Priority to EP17750847.0A priority patent/EP3414241B1/en
Priority to MX2018009656A priority patent/MX2018009656A/en
Priority to LTEPPCT/US2017/017408T priority patent/LT3414241T/en
Priority to EA201891714A priority patent/EA036542B9/en
Priority to SI201731191T priority patent/SI3414241T1/en
Priority to KR1020187025645A priority patent/KR20180107232A/en
Priority to JP2018542231A priority patent/JP6883045B2/en
Priority to US16/076,818 priority patent/US10894789B2/en
Publication of WO2017139603A1 publication Critical patent/WO2017139603A1/en
Priority to IL260788A priority patent/IL260788B/en
Priority to PH12018501708A priority patent/PH12018501708A1/en
Priority to ZA2018/05839A priority patent/ZA201805839B/en
Priority to CONC2018/0009290A priority patent/CO2018009290A2/en
Priority to US17/116,773 priority patent/US11434236B2/en
Priority to US17/868,856 priority patent/US12084437B2/en

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D403/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00
    • C07D403/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D417/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00
    • C07D417/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00 containing three or more hetero rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/435Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/44Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/445Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4965Non-condensed pyrazines
    • A61K31/497Non-condensed pyrazines containing further heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/505Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim
    • A61K31/506Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim not condensed and containing further heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/53Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with three nitrogens as the only ring hetero atoms, e.g. chlorazanil, melamine
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/04Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system for ulcers, gastritis or reflux esophagitis, e.g. antacids, inhibitors of acid secretion, mucosal protectants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/12Antidiarrhoeals
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/12Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the kidneys
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P15/00Drugs for genital or sexual disorders; Contraceptives
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/06Antimigraine agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/08Antiepileptics; Anticonvulsants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/14Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abnormal movements, e.g. chorea, dyskinesia
    • A61P25/16Anti-Parkinson drugs
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/18Antipsychotics, i.e. neuroleptics; Drugs for mania or schizophrenia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/20Hypnotics; Sedatives
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/24Antidepressants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/28Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating neurodegenerative disorders of the central nervous system, e.g. nootropic agents, cognition enhancers, drugs for treating Alzheimer's disease or other forms of dementia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/30Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abuse or dependence
    • A61P25/32Alcohol-abuse
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/30Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abuse or dependence
    • A61P25/34Tobacco-abuse
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/30Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abuse or dependence
    • A61P25/36Opioid-abuse
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/04Anorexiants; Antiobesity agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/12Antihypertensives
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D401/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom
    • C07D401/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D405/00Heterocyclic compounds containing both one or more hetero rings having oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, and one or more rings having nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
    • C07D405/14Heterocyclic compounds containing both one or more hetero rings having oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, and one or more rings having nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D409/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms
    • C07D409/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D413/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms
    • C07D413/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing three or more hetero rings

Definitions

  • Orexins are a family of homologous peptides including species orexin A, or OR-A, and orexin B, or OR-B.
  • Orexin A is a 33 amino acid peptide and orexin B is a 28 amino acid peptide (Sakurai T. et al., Cell (1998), 92, 573-585).
  • Orexins are produced in neurons of the lateral hypothalamus and bind to at least two distinct G-protein-coupled receptors, termed OX 1 and OX 2 receptors.
  • the OX 1 receptor is selective for OR-A, while the OX 2 receptor can bind both OR-A and OR-B.
  • Orexins are found to stimulate food consumption, regulate states of sleep and wakefulness, and may be involved in neural mechanisms of drug abuse and addiction.
  • Orexin receptors are suitable targets for the development of drug candidates for the treatment of a variety of Orexin-related pathologies or symptoms, such as, but not limited to, sleep/wake disorders, anxiety, and obesity.
  • Numerous modulators of OX 1 , OX 2 , or both, have been developed to date [J. Med. Chem.2016, 59(2), 504-530].
  • many of the reported Orexin receptor modulators, such as antagonist ligands have suboptimal metabolic stabilities.
  • X is halogen, such as F
  • X’ is H or halogen, such as F
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR a R b; , -N(R a )C(O) alkyl; -N(R a )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R a )SO 2 alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR a R b ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR a R b ; where
  • B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH 2 CF 3 , -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or–Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NR c R d ; -N(R c )C(O) alkyl; - N(R c )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R c )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR c R d
  • E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR e R f ; -N(R e )C(O) alkyl; -N(R e )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R e )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR e R f ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR e R f ; wherein R e and R
  • n 1, 2, or 3;
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl).
  • A is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1- 4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR a R b; , -N(R a )C(O) alkyl; -N(R a )CO 2 alkyl; - N(R a )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR a R b ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR a R b ;
  • alkyl such as C 1- 4 al
  • R a and R b are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
  • n 1
  • X’ is halogen, such as F.
  • the com ound of formula I can be represented by formula (Ia),
  • X is halogen, such as F
  • X’ is H or halogen, such as F
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR a R b; , -N(R a )C(O) alkyl; -N(R a )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R a )SO 2 alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR a R b ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR a R b ; where
  • B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH 2 CF 3 , -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NR c R d ; -N(R c )C(O) alkyl; - N(R c )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R c )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR c R d
  • E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR e R f ; -N(R e )C(O) alkyl; -N(R e )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R e )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR e R f ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR e R f ; wherein R e and R
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl).
  • A is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1- 4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR a R b; , -N(R a )C(O) alkyl; -N(R a )CO 2 alkyl; - N(R a )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR a R b ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR a R b ;
  • alkyl such as C 1- 4 al
  • R a and R b are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
  • n 1
  • X’ is halogen, such as F.
  • the com ound of formula I can be represented by formula (Ib),
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR a R b; , -N(R a )C(O) alkyl; -N(R a )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R a )SO 2 alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR a R b ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR a R b ; where
  • B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH 2 CF 3 , -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NR c R d ; -N(R c )C(O) alkyl; - N(R c )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R c )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR c R d
  • E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR e R f ; -N(R e )C(O) alkyl; -N(R e )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R e )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR e R f ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR e R f ; wherein R e and R
  • n 1, 2, or 3;
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl).
  • A is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1- 4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR a R b; , -N(R a )C(O) alkyl; -N(R a )CO 2 alkyl; - N(R a )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR a R b ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR a R b ;
  • alkyl such as C 1- 4 al
  • R a and R b are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
  • n 1
  • R 5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NR j R k , -N(R j )C(O) alkyl, - N(R j )CO 2 alkyl, -N(R j )SO 2 alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO 2 H, -CO 2 alkyl, -CONR j R k , -SO 2 alkyl, or– SO 2 NR j R k ; wherein R j and R k are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
  • X, X’, Z, B, E, n, R 1 and R 2 are as defined herein.
  • the compound of formula (II) can be represented by formula (IIa),
  • X and X’ are both F.
  • the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (III):
  • R 5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NR j R k , -N(R j )C(O) alkyl, - N(R j )CO 2 alkyl, -N(R j )SO 2 alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO 2 H, -CO 2 alkyl, -CONR j R k , -SO 2 alkyl, or– SO 2 NR j R k ; wherein R j and R k are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
  • X, X’, Z, B, E, n, R 1 and R 2 are as defined herein.
  • the compound of formula (III) can be represented by formula (IIIa),
  • X and X’ are both F.
  • the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (IV):
  • R 6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NR o R p , -N(R o )C(O) alkyl, - N(R p )CO 2 alkyl, -N(R o )SO 2 alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO 2 H, -CO 2 alkyl, -CONR o R p , -SO 2 alkyl, or– SO 2 NR o R p ; wherein R o and R p are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
  • X and X’ are both F.
  • the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (V):
  • R 6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NR o R p , -N(R o )C(O) alkyl, - N(R p )CO 2 alkyl, -N(R o )SO 2 alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO 2 H, -CO 2 alkyl, -CONR o R p , -SO 2 alkyl, or– SO 2 NR o R p ; wherein R o and R p are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
  • X, X’, Z, A, E, n, R 1 and R 2 are as defined herein.
  • the compound of formula (V) can be represented by formula (Va),
  • X and X’ are both F.
  • the compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) is a compound selected from those species described or exemplified in the detailed description below.
  • this application provides a pharmaceutical composition, comprising at least one compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions as described herein may further comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
  • this application also describes a compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising of any of the foregoing for use as a medicament.
  • this application provides methods of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition mediated by orexin receptor activity a subject in need of such treatment, such as those described herein, comprising administering to the subject, such as a patient, an effective amount of at least one compound described herein or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof in a dose, at a frequency, and for a duration to provide a beneficial effect to the subject.
  • the orexin receptor can be OX 1 , OX 2 , or both.
  • this application provides methods of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a subject in need, such as a patient, comprising administering to the subject, such as a patient, an effective amount of at least one compound described herein or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof in a dose, at a frequency, and for a duration to provide a beneficial effect to the subject.
  • this application provides the use of a compound described herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising of any of the foregoing in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of diseases, disorders, and medical conditions regulated by orexin receptor activity, and the use of such compounds and salts for treatment of such diseases and medical conditions.
  • this application provides the use of a compound described herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising of any of the foregoing in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of diseases, disorders, and medical conditions, and the use of such compounds and salts for treatment of such diseases, disorder, and medical conditions.
  • this application provides a method of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a subject, such as a patient, comprising modulating an orexin receptor, wherein the modulating an orexin receptor comprises administering to the subject at least one compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising of any of the foregoing, in a dose, at a frequency, and for a duration to provide a beneficial effect to the subject patient.
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, head ache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease.
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder,
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
  • drug abuse and addiction can include abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine.
  • this application provides a method of modulating the activity of an orexin receptor, such as one or both of OX 1 or OX 2 , comprising contacting a cell comprising the orexin receptor with an effective amount of at least one compound described herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising any one of the foregoing.
  • this application describes a method of modulating the activity of an orexin receptor, such as one or both of OX 1 or OX 2 , comprising contacting a cell comprising the orexin receptor with an effective amount of at least one compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or with at least one compound or pharmaceutical composition as described herein.
  • the contacting is in vitro, ex vivo, or in vivo. Additional embodiments, features, and advantages of the invention will be apparent from the following detailed description and through practice of the embodiments described in this application.
  • X is halogen, such as F
  • X’ is H or halogen, such as F
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • A is optionally substituted aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl;
  • B is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl
  • E is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl
  • n 1, 2, or 3;
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl).
  • the compound of formula (I) can be represented by Formula (Ia):
  • X is halogen, such as F
  • X’ is H or halogen, such as F
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • A is optionally substituted aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl;
  • B is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl
  • E is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl
  • n 1, 2, or 3;
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl).
  • the com ound of formula I can be represented by formula (Ib),
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • A is optionally substituted aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl;
  • B is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl
  • E is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl
  • n 1, 2, or 3;
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl).
  • A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR a R b; , -N(R a )C(O) alkyl; - N(R a )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R a )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR a R b ; -SO 2 alkyl; and– SO 2 NR a R b ; wherein R
  • B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl,(e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH 2 CF 3 , -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NR c R d ; -N(R c )C(O) alkyl; -N(R c )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R c )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl;
  • alkyl such as C 1-4 alkyl,(e.g.,
  • E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR e R f ; -N(R e )C(O) alkyl; - N(R e )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R e )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR e R f ; -SO 2 alkyl; and– SO 2 NR e R f
  • the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (II) or (IIa):
  • X is halogen, such as F
  • X’ is H or halogen, such as F
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • M is1, 2, or 3;
  • B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH 2 CF 3 , -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or–Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NR c R d ; -N(R c )C(O) alkyl; - N(R c )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R c )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR c R d
  • E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR e R f ; -N(R e )C(O) alkyl; -N(R e )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R e )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR e R f ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR e R f ; wherein R e and R
  • n 1, 2, or 3;
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl); and R 5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NR j R k , -N(R j )C(O) alkyl, - N(R j )CO 2 alkyl, -N(R j )SO 2 alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO 2 H, -CO 2 alkyl, -CONR j R k , -SO 2 alkyl, or– SO 2 NR j R k ; wherein R j and R k are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
  • the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (III) or (IIIa):
  • X is halogen, such as F
  • X’ is H or halogen, such as F
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • n 1, 2, 3, or 4;
  • B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH 2 CF 3 , -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or–Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NR c R d ; -N(R c )C(O) alkyl; - N(R c )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R c )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR c R d
  • E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR e R f ; -N(R e )C(O) alkyl; -N(R e )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R e )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR e R f ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR e R f ; wherein R e and R
  • n 1, 2, or 3;
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NR j R k , -N(R j )C(O) alkyl, - N(R j )CO 2 alkyl, -N(R j )SO 2 alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO 2 H, -CO 2 alkyl, -CONR j R k , -SO 2 alkyl, or– SO 2 NR j R k ; wherein R j and R k are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
  • the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (IV) or (IVa):
  • X is halogen, such as F
  • X’ is H or halogen, such as F
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR a R b; , -N(R a )C(O) alkyl; -N(R a )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R a )SO 2 alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR a R b ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR a R b ; where
  • E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR e R f ; -N(R e )C(O) alkyl; -N(R e )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R e )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR e R f ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR e R f ; wherein R e and R
  • n 1, 2, or 3;
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NR o R p , -N(R o )C(O) alkyl, - N(R p )CO 2 alkyl, -N(R o )SO 2 alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO 2 H, -CO 2 alkyl, -CONR o R p , -SO 2 alkyl, or– SO 2 NR o R p ; wherein R o and R p are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
  • the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (V) or (Va):
  • X is halogen, such as F
  • X’ is H or halogen, such as F
  • Z is NR 2 or O
  • A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR a R b; , -N(R a )C(O) alkyl; -N(R a )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R a )SO 2 alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR a R b ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR a R b ; where
  • E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NR e R f ; -N(R e )C(O) alkyl; -N(R e )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R e )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR e R f ; -SO 2 alkyl; and–SO 2 NR e R f ; wherein R e and R
  • n 1, 2, or 3;
  • R 1 is alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 2 is H or alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl (e.g., methyl);
  • R 6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NR o R p , -N(R o )C(O) alkyl, - N(R p )CO 2 alkyl, -N(R o )SO 2 alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO 2 H, -CO 2 alkyl, -CONR o R p , -SO 2 alkyl, or– SO 2 NR o R p ; wherein R o and R p are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
  • compounds of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof are further characterized as follows.
  • A is aryl or heteroaryl.
  • n is 1.
  • X’ is halogen, such as F.
  • Z is NR 2 .
  • R 2 is hydrogen
  • R 2 is methyl
  • each occurrence of X is -F.
  • R 1 is C 1-4 alkyl, such as methyl.
  • A is an optionally substituted monocyclic or bicyclic heteroaryl. In certain such embodiments, A is selected from the list consisting of pyridinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, and benzoxazolyl. In certain embodiments, A is pyridinyl. In certain embodiments, A is pyrimidinyl. In certain embodiments, A is pyrazinyl. In certain embodiments, A is pyridazinyl.
  • A is unsubstituted.
  • A is optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, such as ethyl, -CHF 2 , or -CF 3 ; alkoxy, such as methoxy; or halo, such as -Cl.
  • A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of–F, -Br, -Cl, -CHF 2 , -CF 3 , methyl, ethyl, and methoxy.
  • A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of–F, -Br, -Cl, -CF 3 , methyl, ethyl, and methoxy.
  • A is monosubstituted. In certain such embodiments, A is substituted with -CHF 2 or -CF 3 , such as -CF 3 .
  • B is an optionally substituted aryl, such as phenyl.
  • B is an optionally substituted monocyclic heteroaryl or bicyclic heteroaryl.
  • B selected from the list consisting of pyridinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, imidazolyl, triazolyl, thiazolyl, thiophenyl, pyrazolyl, and benzoimidazolyl, such as pyridinyl, thiophenyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, pyrazolyl, triazolyl or benzoimidazolyl.
  • B is pyridinyl.
  • B is thiophenyl. In certain embodiments, B is oxazolyl. In certain embodiments, B is thiazolyl. In certain embodiments, B is pyrazolyl. In certain embodiments, B is triazolyl. In certain embodiments, B is benzoimidazolyl.
  • B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of an alkyl, such as methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, - CHF 2 , -CF 3 , or -CH 2 CF 3 ; halo, such as -F or–Cl; alkoxy, such as methoxy; and–CN.
  • B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of -F, -Cl, -Br, -CN, methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CF 3 , -CHF 2 , -CH 2 CF 3 , isopropoxy, and methoxy.
  • B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of -F, -Cl, -Br, -CN, methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CF 3 , -CH 2 CF 3 , isopropoxy, and methoxy.
  • B is optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, such as methyl.
  • B is monosubstituted. In certain such embodiments, B is substituted with an alkyl, such as methyl.
  • E is an optionally substituted phenyl.
  • E is an optionally substituted monocyclic heteroaryl, such as triazoyl, tetrazolyl, pyrazolyl, pyridinyl, oxadiazolyl, pyrazinyl, or pyrimidinyl. In certain embodiments, E is triazoyl. In certain embodiments, E is tetrazolyl. In certain embodiments, E is pyrazolyl. In certain embodiments, E is pyridinyl. In certain embodiments, E is oxadiazolyl. In certain embodiments, E is pyrimidinyl. In certain embodiments, E is pyrazinyl.
  • E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or– CF 3, e.g., methyl, halo, such as–F, -Br, or–Cl, e.g., -F or -Cl,; and alkoxy, such as methoxy.
  • alkyl such as methyl, ethyl, -CHF 2 , or– CF 3, e.g., methyl, halo, such as–F, -Br, or–Cl, e.g., -F or -Cl,; and alkoxy, such as methoxy.
  • E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as methyl, ethyl, or–CF 3, e.g., methyl, halo, such as–F, -Br, or–Cl, e.g., -F or -Cl,; and alkoxy, such as methoxy.
  • alkyl such as methyl, ethyl, or–CF 3, e.g., methyl, halo, such as–F, -Br, or–Cl, e.g., -F or -Cl,; and alkoxy, such as methoxy.
  • E is optionally substituted with one or more substituent independently selected from methyl or -F.
  • E is monosubstituted. In other embodiments, E is unsubstituted. In certain embodiments, the fragment -B-E in the compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib),
  • Y independently for each occurrence, represents CH or N
  • R 3 represents alkyl, such as C 1-4 alkyl(e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH 2 CF 3 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NR g R h ; -N(R g )C(O) alkyl; -N(R g )CO 2 alkyl; -N(R g )SO 2 alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO 2 H; -CO 2 alkyl; -CONR g R h ; -SO 2 alkyl; or–SO 2 NR g R h ; wherein R g and R h are each independently for each
  • the fragment -B-E is In certain such embodiments, R 3 is alkyl, such as -CH 3 or -CF 3 ; or alkoxy, such as methoxy.
  • the fragment -B-E is .
  • R 3 is halo, such as -F or -Cl; or alkyl, such as methyl; or -CN.
  • W independently for each occurrence, represents N, S, O, or CH;
  • V represents N or C
  • R 4 represents alkyl, , such as C 1-4 alkyl(e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH 2 CF 3 , or -CF 3 ); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NR i R j , -N(R i )C(O) alkyl, -N(R i )CO 2 alkyl, -N(R i )SO 2 alkyl, - C(O)alkyl, -CO 2 H, -CO 2 alkyl, -CONR i R j , -SO 2 alkyl, or–SO 2 NR i R j ; wherein R i and R j are independently for each
  • the structure is selected from the following: . In certain embodiments, the structure
  • R 4 is C 1-4 alkyl, such as methyl.
  • R 4 is C 1-4 alkyl, such as methyl.
  • Z is O. In other embodiments, Z is NR 2 .
  • n 1.
  • the compound of formula (I) is selected from the compounds provided in Table 1, and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
  • this application relates to a pharmaceutical composition
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising (a) a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; and (b) a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
  • this application relates to a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising any one of the foregoing, for use as a medicament.
  • this application relates to a method of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition mediated by orexin receptor activity in a subject in need of such treatment, comprising administering to the subject an effective amount of at least one compound according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising any one of the foregoing.
  • this application relates to a method of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a subject in need of such treatment, comprising administering to the subject an effective amount of at least one compound according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising any one of the foregoing.
  • formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising any one of the foregoing.
  • the disease, disorder or medical condition mediated by orexin receptor activity is eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder,
  • the drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine.
  • this application relates to the use of a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of the foregoing, in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of diseases, disorders, and medical conditions regulated by orexin receptor activity, and the use of such compounds for treatment of such diseases and medical conditions.
  • this application relates to the use of a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of the foregoing, in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of diseases, disorders, and medical conditions, and the use of such compounds for treatment of such diseases, disorder, and medical conditions.
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post- traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, headache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease.
  • the drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine.
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease,
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune- related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine- related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
  • this application relates to a method of modulating the activity of an orexin receptor OX 1 , OX 2 , or both, comprising contacting a cell comprising the orexin receptor with an effective amount of at least one compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of the foregoing.
  • the contacting is in vitro, ex vivo, or in vivo.
  • this application relates to a method of treating a disease or disorder in a subject, (e.g., a patient) in need thereof, comprising administering a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of the foregoing, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post- traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, headache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, pain, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, and psychosexual disorder.
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea,
  • gastroesophageal reflux gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
  • disease or disorder is selected from the group consisting of drug abuse or addiction, panic disorder, anxiety, post-traumatic stress disorder, pain, depression, seasonal affective disorder, an eating disorder, and hypertension.
  • drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine.
  • the application also includes pharmaceutically acceptable prodrugs, salts, solvates, such as hydrates, of the compounds represented by Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), preferably of those described above and of the specific compounds exemplified herein, and pharmaceutical compositions comprising such prodrugs, salts, or solvates, such as hydrates, and methods of using such salts or hydrates.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable prodrugs, salts, solvates such as hydrates, of the compounds represented by Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), preferably of those described above and of the specific compounds exemplified herein, and pharmaceutical compositions comprising such prodrugs, salts, or solvates, such as hydrates, and methods of using such salts or hydrates.
  • the present application also relates to pharmaceutically active metabolites of compounds described herein, and uses of such metabolites in the methods of the application.
  • any formula depicted herein is intended to represent a compound of that structural formula as well as certain variations or forms.
  • a formula given herein is intended to include a racemic form, or one or more enantiomeric, diastereomeric, or geometric isomers, or tautomeric forms, or a mixture thereof.
  • any formula given herein is intended to refer also to a solvate, such as a hydrate, solvate, or polymorph of such a compound, or a mixture thereof.
  • Any formula given herein is intended to refer to amorphous and/or crystalline physical forms of the compound.
  • the compounds described herein may be analytically pure, or a mixture in which the compound comprises at least 50%, at least 70%, at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, or at least 98% by weight of the mixture.
  • “subject” refers to both mammals and non-mammals.
  • Mammals include, for example, humans; non-human primates, e.g. apes and monkeys; and non-primates, e.g. mice, rats, rabbits, dogs, cats, cattle, horses, sheep, and goats.
  • Non-mammals include, for example, worms, fish and birds.
  • the subject is a human.
  • substantially refers to being completely or almost completely; for example, a composition that is "substantially free” of a component either has none of the component or contains such a trace amount that any relevant functional property of the composition is unaffected by the presence of the trace amount, or a compound is
  • substantially pure is there are only negligible traces of impurities present.
  • acyl is art-recognized and refers to a group represented by the general formula hydrocarbylC(O)-, preferably alkylC(O)-.
  • acylamino refers to an amino group substituted with an acyl group and may be represented, for example, by the formula hydrocarbylC(O)NH-.
  • acyloxy refers to a group represented by the general formula hydrocarbylC(O)O-, preferably alkylC(O)O-.
  • alkoxy refers to an alkyl group, preferably a lower alkyl group, having an oxygen attached thereto.
  • Representative alkoxy groups include methoxy, ethoxy, propoxy, tert- butoxy and the like.
  • alkoxyalkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with an alkoxy group and may be represented by the general formula alkyl-O-alkyl.
  • alkenyl refers to an aliphatic group containing at least one double bond and is intended to include both "unsubstituted alkenyls" and “substituted alkenyls", the latter of which refers to alkenyl moieties having substituents replacing a hydrogen on one or more carbons of the alkenyl group. Such substituents may occur on one or more carbons that are included or not included in one or more double bonds. Moreover, such substituents include all those contemplated for alkyl groups, as discussed below, except where stability is prohibitive. For example, substitution of alkenyl groups by one or more alkyl, carbocyclyl, aryl,
  • heterocyclyl, or heteroaryl groups is contemplated.
  • alkynyl refers to an aliphatic group containing at least one triple bond and is intended to include both "unsubstituted alkynyls" and “substituted alkynyls", the latter of which refers to alkynyl moieties having substituents replacing one or more hydrogens on one or more carbons of the alkynyl group. Such substituents may occur on one or more carbons that are included or not included in one or more triple bonds. Moreover, such substituents include all those contemplated for alkyl groups, as discussed above, except where stability is prohibitive. For example, substitution of alkynyl groups by one or more alkyl, carbocyclyl, aryl, heterocyclyl, or heteroaryl groups is contemplated.
  • An“alkyl” group or“alkane” is a straight chained or branched non-aromatic
  • a straight chained or branched alkyl group has from 1 to about 20 carbon atoms, such as from 1 to 12 carbon atoms, preferably from 1 to about 10, more preferably from 1 to 4, unless otherwise defined.
  • straight chained and branched alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, sec-butyl, tert-butyl, pentyl, isopentyl, tert-pentyl, hexyl, isohexyl, pentyl and octyl.
  • a C 1 -C 6 straight chained or branched alkyl group is also referred to as a "lower alkyl" group.
  • alkyl (or “lower alkyl) as used throughout the specification, examples, and claims is intended to include both “unsubstituted alkyls” and “substituted alkyls”, the latter of which refers to alkyl moieties having substituents replacing a hydrogen or more hydrogens on one or more carbons of the hydrocarbon backbone.
  • substituents can include, for example, a halogen (such as F, Cl, Br, or I), a hydroxyl, a carbonyl (such as a carboxyl, an alkoxycarbonyl, a formyl, or an acyl), a thiocarbonyl (such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate), an alkoxyl, a phosphoryl, a phosphate, a phosphonate, a phosphinate, an amino, an amido, an amidine, an imine, a cyano, a nitro, an azido, a sulfhydryl, an alkylthio, a sulfate, a sulfonate, a sulfamoyl, a sulfonamido, a sulfonyl, a heterocyclyl, an aralkyl, or
  • the moieties substituted on the hydrocarbon chain can themselves be substituted, if appropriate.
  • the substituents of a substituted alkyl may include substituted and unsubstituted forms of amino, azido, imino, amido, phosphoryl (including phosphonate and phosphinate), sulfonyl (including sulfate, sulfonamido, sulfamoyl and sulfonate), and silyl groups, as well as ethers, alkylthios, carbonyls (including ketones, aldehydes, carboxylates, and esters), haloalkyls (such as -CF 3 , -CHF 2 , -CH 2 F,), -CN, and the like.
  • Cycloalkyls can be further substituted with alkyls, alkenyls, alkoxys, alkylthios, aminoalkyls, carbonyl-substituted alkyls, haloalkyls (such as -CF 3 , -CHF 2 , -CH 2 F), -CN, and the like.
  • (ATOM) i-j when used in conjunction with a chemical moiety, such as, acyl, acyloxy, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, or alkoxy is meant to include groups that contain from i to j (including i and j) atoms.
  • C x-y alkyl refers to substituted or unsubstituted saturated hydrocarbon groups, including straight-chain alkyl and branched-chain alkyl groups that contain from x to y carbons in the chain, including haloalkyl groups such as - CF 3 , -CHF 2 , -CH 2 F, or 2,2,2-tirfluoroethyl, etc.
  • C 0 alkyl refers to a hydrogen atom where the group is in a terminal position, a bond if internal.
  • C 3-6 cycloalkyl refers to a cycloalkyl as defined herein that has 3 to 6 carbon ring atoms.
  • C 2-y alkenyl and C 2-y alkynyl refer to substituted or unsubstituted unsaturated aliphatic groups analogous in length and possible substitution to the alkyls described above, but that contain at least one double or triple bond respectively.
  • alkylamino refers to an amino group substituted with at least one alkyl group.
  • alkylthio refers to a thiol group substituted with an alkyl group and may be represented by the general formula alkylS-.
  • Hydrocarbyl groups include, but are not limited to aryl, heteroaryl, carbocycle, heterocyclyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and combinations thereof.
  • amine and“amino” are art-recognized and refer to both unsubstituted and substituted amines and salts thereof, e.g., a moiety that can be represented by wherein each R 30 independently represents a hydrogen or a hydrocarbyl group, or two R 30 are taken together with the N atom to which they are attached complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
  • aminoalkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with an amino group.
  • amide refers to a group: , wherein each R 30 independently represent a hydrogen or hydrocarbyl group, or two R 30 are taken together with the N atom to which they are attached complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
  • R 29 and R 30 independently represent hydrogen or a hydrocarbyl group, such as an alkyl group, or R 29 and R 30 taken together with the intervening atom(s) complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
  • halogen represents chlorine, fluorine, bromine, or iodine.
  • halo represents fluoro, chloro, bromo, or iodo.
  • haloalkyl refers to an alkyl group with one or more halo substituents, or one, two, or three halo substituents.
  • haloalkyl groups include—CF 3 , -CH 2 F, -CHF 2 , -CH 2 Br, -CH 2 CF 3 , and–CH 2 CH 2 F.
  • heteroatom refers to an atom of any element other than carbon or hydrogen.
  • exemplary heteroatoms include but are not limited to nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
  • heteroalkyl refers to a saturated or unsaturated chain of carbon atoms and at least one heteroatom, wherein no two heteroatoms are adjacent.
  • aryl includes substituted or unsubstituted monocyclic aromatic rings in which each atom of the ring is carbon.
  • the ring is a 5- to 7- membered ring, more preferably a 6-membered ring.
  • the term“aryl” also includes polycyclic ring systems having two or more cyclic rings in which two or more carbons are common to two adjoining rings wherein at least one of the rings is aromatic, e.g., the other cyclic rings can be cycloalkyls, cycloalkenyls, cycloalkynyls, aryls, heteroaryls, and/or heterocyclyls.
  • Aryl groups include benzene, naphthalene, phenanthrene, phenol, aniline, and the like.
  • aralkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with an aryl group.
  • An“aroyl” group refers to an aryl group bonded via an exocyclic carbonyl group, such as a benzoyl group.
  • heteroaryl includes substituted or unsubstituted monocyclic aromatic ring system, preferably 5- to 7-membered aromatic rings, more preferably 5- to 6- membered rings, whose ring structures include at least one heteroatom, preferably one to four heteroatoms, more preferably one to two heteroatoms.
  • a 5-membered heteroaryl is furan, thiophene, pyrrole, oxazole, isoxazole, thiazole, isothiazole, pyrazole, imidazole, oxadiazole, thiadiazole, triazole, or tetrazole.
  • a 6-membered heteroaryl is pyridine, pyrazine, pyrimidine, pyridazine, or triazine.
  • the term“heteroaryl” also include substituted or unsubstituted“polycyclic” ring systems having two or more cyclic rings in which two or more carbons are common to two adjoining rings wherein at least one of the rings is heteroaromatic, e.g., the other cyclic rings can be cycloalkyls, cycloalkenyls, cycloalkynyls, aryls, heteroaryls, and/or heterocyclyls.
  • heteroaryl groups include but are not limited to the following entities, in the form of properly bonded moieties:
  • heteroaryl refers to an alkyl group substituted with a heteroaryl group.
  • A“heteroaroyl” group refers to a heteroaryl group bonded via an exocyclic carbonyl group, analogous to a benzoyl group but wherein the phenyl ring of the benzoyl group is replaced by a heteroaryl group.
  • heterocyclyl refers to substituted or unsubstituted non-aromatic ring structures, preferably 3- to 10-membered rings, more preferably 3- to 7-membered rings, whose ring structures include at least one heteroatom, preferably one to four heteroatoms, more preferably one or two heteroatoms.
  • heterocyclyl and“heterocyclic” also include substituted or unsubstituted polycyclic ring systems having two or more cyclic rings in which two or more carbons are common to two adjoining rings wherein at least one of the rings is heterocyclic, e.g., the other cyclic rings can be cycloalkyls, cycloalkenyls, cycloalkynyls, aryls, heteroaryls, and/or heterocyclyls.
  • Heterocyclyl groups include, for example, piperidine, piperazine, pyrrolidine, morpholine, lactones, lactams, and the like.
  • heterocyclylalkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with a heterocycle group which is optionally substituted.
  • carbocycle refers to a saturated or unsaturated ring in which each atom of the ring is carbon.
  • carbocycle includes both aromatic carbocycles and non-aromatic carbocycles.
  • Non-aromatic carbocycles include both cycloalkane rings, in which all carbon atoms are saturated, and cycloalkene rings, which contain at least one double bond.
  • Carbocycle includes 5-7 membered monocyclic and 8-12 membered bicyclic rings. Each ring of a bicyclic carbocycle may be selected from saturated, unsaturated and aromatic rings.
  • Carbocycle includes bicyclic molecules in which one, two or three or more atoms are shared between the two rings.
  • the term“fused carbocycle” refers to a bicyclic carbocycle in which each of the rings shares two adjacent atoms with the other ring.
  • Each ring of a fused carbocycle may be selected from saturated, unsaturated and aromatic rings.
  • an aromatic ring e.g., phenyl
  • an aromatic ring e.g., phenyl
  • a saturated or unsaturated ring e.g., cyclohexane, cyclopentane, or cyclohexene.
  • Any combination of saturated, unsaturated and aromatic bicyclic rings, as valence permits, is included in the definition of carbocyclic.
  • Exemplary“carbocycles” include cyclopentane, cyclohexane, bicyclo[2.2.1]heptane, 1,5-cyclooctadiene, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphthalene, bicyclo[4.2.0]oct-3- ene, naphthalene and adamantane.
  • Exemplary fused carbocycles include decalin, naphthalene, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphthalene, bicyclo[4.2.0]octane, 4,5,6,7-tetrahydro-1H-indene and bicyclo[4.1.0]hept-3-ene.“Carbocycles” may be susbstituted at any one or more positions capable of bearing a hydrogen atom.
  • A“cycloalkyl” group refers to a cyclic hydrocarbon which is completely saturated.“Cycloalkyl” includes monocyclic and bicyclic rings. Typically, a monocyclic cycloalkyl group has from 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, more typically 3 to 8 carbon atoms unless otherwise defined.
  • the second ring of a bicyclic cycloalkyl may be selected from saturated, unsaturated and aromatic rings. Cycloalkyl includes bicyclic molecules in which one, two or three or more atoms are shared between the two rings.
  • the term“fused cycloalkyl” refers to a bicyclic cycloalkyl in which each of the rings shares two adjacent atoms with the other ring.
  • the second ring of a fused bicyclic cycloalkyl may be selected from saturated, unsaturated and aromatic rings.
  • carbocyclylalkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with a carbocycle group.
  • A“cycloalkenyl” group refers to a cyclic hydrocarbon containing one or more double bonds.
  • A“cycloalkynyl” group is a cyclic hydrocarbon containing one or more triple bonds.
  • polycyclyl refers to two or more rings (e.g., cycloalkyls, cycloalkenyls, cycloalkynyls, aryls, heteroaryls, and/or heterocyclyls) in which two or more atoms are common to two adjoining rings, e.g., the rings are“fused rings”.
  • rings e.g., cycloalkyls, cycloalkenyls, cycloalkynyls, aryls, heteroaryls, and/or heterocyclyls
  • Each of the rings of the polycycle can be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • each ring of the polycycle contains from 3 to 10 atoms in the ring, preferably from 5 to 7.
  • carbonate is art-recognized and refers to a group -OCO 2 -R 30 , wherein R 30 represents a hydrocarbyl group.
  • carboxy refers to a group represented by the formula -CO 2 H.
  • ester refers to a group -C(O)OR 30 wherein R 30 represents a hydrocarbyl group.
  • ether refers to a hydrocarbyl group linked through an oxygen to another hydrocarbyl group. Accordingly, an ether substituent of a hydrocarbyl group may be hydrocarbyl-O-. Ethers may be either symmetrical or unsymmetrical. Examples of ethers include, but are not limited to, heterocycle-O-heterocycle and aryl-O-heterocycle. Ethers include “alkoxyalkyl” groups, which may be represented by the general formula alkyl-O-alkyl.
  • the term“sulfate” is art-recognized and refers to the group -OSO 3 H, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • R 29 and R 30 independently represents hydrogen or hydrocarbyl, such as alkyl, or R 29 and R 30 taken together with the intervening atom(s) complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
  • sulfoxide is art-recognized and refers to the group -S(O)-R 30 , wherein R 30 represents a hydrocarbyl.
  • sulfonate is art-recognized and refers to the group SO 3 H, or a
  • sulfone is art-recognized and refers to the group -S(O) 2 -R 30 , wherein R 30 represents a hydrocarbyl.
  • thioalkyl refers to an alkyl group substituted with a thiol group.
  • thioester refers to a group -C(O)SR 30 or -SC(O)R 30 wherein R 30 represents a hydrocarbyl.
  • thioether is equivalent to an ether, wherein the oxygen is replaced with asulfur.
  • urea is art-recognized and may be represented by the general formula , wherein R 29 and R 30 independently represent hydrogen or a hydrocarbyl, such as alkyl, or either occurrence of R 29 taken together with R 30 and the intervening atom(s) complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
  • substitution refers to moieties having substituents replacing one or more hydrogens on one or more carbons of the backbone. It will be understood that “substitution” or“substituted with” includes the implicit proviso that such substitution is in accordance with permitted valence of the substituted atom and the substituent, and that the substitution results in a stable compound, e.g., which does not spontaneously undergo transformation such as by rearrangement, cyclization, elimination, etc. As used herein, the term “substituted” is contemplated to include all permissible substituents of organic compounds.
  • the permissible substituents include acyclic and cyclic, branched and unbranched, carbocyclic and heterocyclic, aromatic and non-aromatic substituents of organic compounds.
  • the permissible substituents can be one or more and the same or different for appropriate organic compounds.
  • the heteroatoms such as nitrogen may have hydrogen substituents and/or any permissible substituents of organic compounds described herein which satisfy the valences of the heteroatoms.
  • “substituted” means that the specified group or moiety bears one, two, or three substituents.
  • “substituted” means that the specified group or moiety bears one or two substituents.
  • “substituted” refers to the specified group or moiety bears one substituent.
  • Substituents can include any substituents described herein, for example, a halogen, a hydroxyl, a carbonyl (such as a carboxyl, an alkoxycarbonyl, a formyl, or an acyl), a
  • thiocarbonyl such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate
  • an alkoxyl such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate
  • an alkoxyl such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate
  • an alkoxyl such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate
  • an alkoxyl such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate
  • an alkoxyl such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate
  • an alkoxyl such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate
  • an alkoxyl such as a thioester, a thioacetate
  • references to chemical moieties herein are understood to include substituted variants.
  • reference to an“aryl” group or moiety implicitly includes both substituted and unsubstituted variants.
  • the term“unsubstituted” refers to that the specified group bears no substituents.
  • any disubstituent referred to herein is meant to encompass the various attachment possibilities when more than one of such possibilities are allowed.
  • reference to disubstituent -A-B-, where A ⁇ B, refers herein to such disubstituent with A attached to a first substituted member and B attached to a second substituted member, and it also refers to such disubstituent with A attached to the second substituted member and B attached to the first substituted member.
  • Protecting group refers to a group of atoms that, when attached to a reactive functional group in a molecule, mask, reduce or prevent the reactivity of the functional group. Typically, a protecting group may be selectively removed as desired during the course of a synthesis. Examples of protecting groups can be found in Greene and Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry, 3 rd Ed., 1999, John Wiley & Sons, NY and Harrison et al., Compendium of Synthetic Organic Methods, Vols.1-8, 1971-1996, John Wiley & Sons, NY.
  • nitrogen protecting groups include, but are not limited to, formyl, acetyl, trifluoroacetyl, benzyl, benzyloxycarbonyl (“CBZ”), tert-butoxycarbonyl (“Boc”), trimethylsilyl (“TMS”), 2- trimethylsilyl-ethanesulfonyl (“TES”), trityl and substituted trityl groups, allyloxycarbonyl, 9- fluorenylmethyloxycarbonyl (“FMOC”), nitro-veratryloxycarbonyl (“NVOC”) and the like.
  • hydroxylprotecting groups include, but are not limited to, those where the hydroxyl group is either acylated (esterified) or alkylated such as benzyl and trityl ethers, as well as alkyl ethers, tetrahydropyranyl ethers, trialkylsilyl ethers (e.g., TMS or TIPS groups), glycol ethers, such as ethylene glycol and propylene glycol derivatives and allyl ethers.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable is employed herein to refer to those compounds, materials, compositions, and/or dosage forms which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of human beings and animals without excessive toxicity, irritation, allergic response, or other problem or complication, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
  • A“pharmaceutically acceptable salt” is intended to mean a salt of a free acid or base of a compound represented herein that is non-toxic, biologically tolerable, or otherwise biologically suitable for administration to the subject. See, generally, S.M. Berge, et al.,“Pharmaceutical Salts,” J. Pharm. Sci., 1977, 66, 1-19.
  • Preferred pharmaceutically acceptable salts are those that are pharmacologically effective and suitable for contact with the tissues of subjects without undue toxicity, irritation, or allergic response.
  • a compound described herein may possess a sufficiently acidic group, a sufficiently basic group, both types of functional groups, or more than one of each type, and accordingly react with a number of inorganic or organic bases, and inorganic and organic acids, to form a pharmaceutically acceptable salt.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable salt may be prepared by any suitable method available in the art, for example, treatment of the free base with an inorganic acid, such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, sulfamic acid, nitric acid, boric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like, or with an organic acid, such as acetic acid, phenylacetic acid, propionic acid, stearic acid, lactic acid, ascorbic acid, maleic acid, hydroxymaleic acid, isethionic acid, succinic acid, valeric acid, fumaric acid, malonic acid, pyruvic acid, oxalic acid, glycolic acid, salicylic acid, oleic acid, palmitic acid, lauric acid, a pyranosidyl acid, such as glucuronic acid or galacturonic acid, an alpha-hydroxy acid, such as mandelic acid, citric acid, or
  • an inorganic acid such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid
  • base addition salts can be prepared by any suitable method available in the art, for example, treatment of such compound with a sufficient amount of the desired the desired base, either neat or in a suitable inert solvent.
  • suitable base addition salts include, but are not limited to, lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, ammonium, zinc, or magnesium salt, or other metal salts; organic amino salts, such as, alkyl, dialkyl, trialkyl, or tetra-alkyl ammonium salts.
  • salts include, but are not limited to, camsylate, sulfates, pyrosulfates, bisulfates, sulfites, bisulfites, phosphates, monohydrogen- phosphates, dihydrogenphosphates, metaphosphates, pyrophosphates, chlorides, bromides, iodides, acetates, propionates, decanoates, caprylates, acrylates, formates, isobutyrates, caproates, heptanoates, propiolates, oxalates, malonates, succinates, suberates, sebacates, fumarates, maleates, butyne-1,4-dioates, hexyne-1,6-dioates, benzoates, chlorobenzoates, methylbenzoates, dinitrobenzoates, hydroxybenzoates, methoxybenzoates, phthalates, sulfonates, methylsulfon
  • the neutral forms of the compounds are preferably regenerated by contacting the salt with a base or acid and isolating the parent compound in the conventional manner.
  • the parent form of the compound differs from the various salt forms in certain physical properties, such as solubility in polar solvents, but otherwise the salts are equivalent to the parent form of the compound for the purposes of the present application.
  • the term“prodrug” is intended to encompass compounds which, under physiologic conditions, are converted into the therapeutically active agents of the present application, e.g., a compound of described herein.
  • a common method for making a prodrug is to include one or more selected moieties which are hydrolyzed under physiologic conditions to yield the desired molecule.
  • the prodrug is converted by an enzymatic activity of the host animal.
  • a prodrug with a nitro group on an aromatic ring could be reduced by reductase to generate the desired amino group of the corresponding active compound in vivo.
  • functional groups such as a hydroxyl, carbonate, or carboxylic acid in the parent compound are presented as an ester, which could be cleaved by esterases.
  • amine groups in the parent compounds are presented in, but not limited to, carbamate, N- alkylated or N-acylated forms (Simpl ⁇ cio et al,“Prodrugs for Amines,” Molecules, (2008), 13:519-547).
  • some or all of the compounds of described herein in a formulation represented above can be replaced with the corresponding suitable prodrug.
  • a "pharmaceutically acceptable prodrug” is a prodrug that is non-toxic, biologically tolerable, and otherwise biologically suitable for administration to the subject. Illustrative procedures for the selection and preparation of suitable prodrug derivatives are described, for example, in“Design of Prodrugs”, ed. H. Bundgaard, Elsevier, 1985.
  • A“pharmaceutically active metabolite” or“metabolite” refers to a pharmacologically active product of metabolism/biochemical modification of a compound described herein, e.g., a compound of Formula (I), (Ia), or (Ib) or salt thereof, under physiological conditions, e.g., through certain enzymatic pathway.
  • an oxidative metabolite is formed by oxidation of the parent compound during metabolism, such as the oxidation of a pyridine ring to pyridine-N-oxide.
  • an oxidative metabolite is formed by demethylation of a methoxy group to result in a hydroxyl group.
  • Prodrugs and active metabolites of a compound may be determined using routine techniques known or available in the art. See, e.g., Bertolini et al., J. Med. Chem.1997, 40, 2011-2016; Shan et al., J. Pharm. Sci.1997, 86 (7), 765-767; Bagshawe, Drug Dev. Res.1995, 34, 220-230; Bodor, Adv. Drug Res.1984, 13, 255-331; Bundgaard, Design of Prodrugs (Elsevier Press, 1985); and Larsen, Design and Application of Prodrugs, Drug Design and Development (Krogsgaard-Larsen et al., eds., Harwood Academic Publishers, 1991).
  • A“hydrate” is a compound that exists in a composition with water molecules.
  • the composition can include water in stoichiometric quantities, such as a monohydrate or a dihydrate, or can include water in random amounts.
  • A“solvate” is a similar composition except that a solvent other that water, such as with methanol, ethanol, dimethylformamide, diethyl ether and the like replaces the water.
  • methanol or ethanol can form an“alcoholate,”” which can again be stoichiometic or non- stoichiometric.
  • Mixtures of such solvates or hydrates can also be prepared.
  • the source of such solvate or hydrate can be from the solvent of crystallization, inherent in the solvent of preparation or crystallization, or adventitious to such solvent.
  • the compounds of the application can exist as various polymorphs, pseudo-polymorphs, or in amorphous state.
  • polymorph refers to different crystalline forms of the same compound and other solid state molecular forms including pseudo-polymorphs, such as hydrates, solvates, or salts of the same compound.
  • pseudo-polymorphs such as hydrates, solvates, or salts of the same compound.
  • Different crystalline polymorphs have different crystal structures due to a different packing of molecules in the lattice, as a result of changes in temperature, pressure, or variations in the crystallization process. Polymorphs differ from each other in their physical properties, such as x-ray diffraction characteristics, stability, melting points, solubility, or rates of dissolution in certain solvents.
  • crystalline polymorphic forms are important aspects in the development of suitable dosage forms in pharmaceutical industry.
  • the present application further embraces isolated compounds according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va).
  • isolated compound refers to a preparation of a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a mixture of compounds according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), wherein the isolated compound has been separated from the reagents used, and/or byproducts formed, in the synthesis of the compound or compounds.“Isolated” does not mean that the preparation is technically pure (homogeneous), but it is sufficiently pure to compound in a form in which it can be used therapeutically.
  • an“isolated compound” refers to a preparation of a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) or a mixture of compounds according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), which contains the named compound or mixture of compounds according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) in an amount of at least 10 percent by weight of the total weight.
  • the preparation contains the named compound or mixture of compounds in an amount of at least 50% by weight of the total weight; more preferably at least 80% by weight of the total weight; and most preferably at least 90%, at least 95% or at least 98% by weight of the total weight of the preparation.
  • the compounds of the application and intermediates may be isolated from their reaction mixtures and purified by standard techniques such as filtration, liquid-liquid extraction, solid phase extraction, distillation, recrystallization or chromatography, including flash column chromatography, or HPLC.
  • a compound described herein or a salt thereof may exhibit the phenomenon of tautomerism whereby two chemical compounds that are capable of facile interconversion by exchanging a hydrogen atom between two atoms, to either of which it forms a covalent bond. Since the tautomeric compounds exist in mobile equilibrium with each other they may be regarded as different isomeric forms of the same compound. It is to be understood that the formulae drawings within this specification can represent only one of the possible tautomeric forms. However, it is also to be understood that the application encompasses any tautomeric form, and is not to be limited merely to any one tautomeric form utilized within the formulae drawings.
  • Such tautomerism can also occur with substituted pyrazoles such as 3-methyl, 5-methyl, or 3,5-dimethylpyrazoles, and the like.
  • Another example of tautomerism is amido-imido (lactam-lactim when cyclic) tautomerism, such as is seen in heterocyclic compounds bearing a ring oxygen atom adjacent to a ring nitrogen atom.
  • the equilibrium is an example of tautomerism. Accordingly, a structure depicted herein as one tautomer is intended to also include the other tautomer.
  • the isomers resulting from the presence of a chiral center comprise a pair of
  • Non-superimposable isomers that are called“enantiomers.”
  • Single enantiomers of a pure compound are optically active, i.e., they are capable of rotating the plane of plane polarized light.
  • Single enantiomers are designated according to the Cahn-Ingold-Prelog system.
  • the priority of substituents is ranked based on atomic weights, a higher atomic weight, as determined by the systematic procedure, having a higher priority ranking. Once the priority ranking of the four groups is determined, the molecule is oriented so that the lowest ranking group is pointed away from the viewer.
  • the therapeutic preparation may be enriched to provide predominantly one enantiomer of a compound (e.g., of formula (I), (Ia), or (Ib)).
  • enantiomerically enriched mixture may comprise, for example, at least 60 mol percent of one enantiomer, or more preferably at least 75, 90, 95, or even 99 mol percent.
  • a compound of the invention may have greater than 30% ee, 40% ee, 50% ee, 60% ee, 70% ee, 80% ee, 90% ee, or even 95% or greater ee.
  • the compound enriched in one enantiomer is substantially free of the other enantiomer, wherein substantially free means that the substance in question makes up less than 10%, or less than 5%, or less than 4%, or less than 3%, or less than 2%, or less than 1% as compared to the amount of the other enantiomer, e.g., in the composition or compound mixture.
  • composition or compound mixture contains 98 grams of a first enantiomer and 2 grams of a second enantiomer, it would be said to contain 98 mol percent of the first enantiomer and only 2% of the second enantiomer.
  • compounds of the application may have more than one stereocenter. In certain such embodiments, compounds of the application may be enriched in one or more diastereomer. For example, a compound of the application may have greater than 30% de, 40% de, 50% de, 60% de, 70% de, 80% de, 90% de, or even 95% or greater de.
  • Isolated optical isomers may be purified from racemic mixtures by well-known chiral separation techniques, such as but not limited to, normal and reverse phase chromatography, and crystallization. According to one such method, a racemic mixture of a compound of the application, or a chiral intermediate thereof, is separated using a chiral salt or carried out on a Chiralcell OD column. The column is operated according to the manufacturer’s instructions.
  • Isolated optical isomers can also be prepared by the use of chiral intermediates or catalysts in synthesis.
  • the optical center chiral center
  • Chiral catalyst can be used to impart at least some degree of enantiomeric purity to products of reactions catalyzed by the chiral catalyst.
  • compounds having at least some degree of enantiomeric enrichment can be obtained by physical processes such as selective crystallization of salts or complexes formed with chiral adjuvants.
  • a variety of compounds in the present application may exist in particular geometric or stereoisomeric forms.
  • the present application takes into account all such compounds, including tautomers, cis- and trans-isomers, R- and S-enantiomers, diastereomers, (D)-isomers, (L)- isomers, the racemic mixtures thereof, and other mixtures thereof, as being covered within the scope of this application. All tautomeric forms are encompassed in the present application.
  • the preferred compounds of the present application have a particular spatial arrangement of substituents on the aromatic rings, which are related to the structure activity relationship demonstrated by the compound class. Often such substitution arrangement is denoted by a numbering system; however, numbering systems are often not consistent between different ring systems. In six-membered aromatic systems, the spatial arrangements are specified by the common nomenclature“para” for 1,4-substitution,“meta” for 1,3-substitution and“ortho” for 1,2-substitution as shown below.
  • the present application further includes all pharmaceutically acceptable isotopically labeled compound [e.g., of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va)].
  • An “isotopically” or “radio-labeled” compound is a compound where one or more atoms are replaced or substituted by an atom having an atomic mass or mass number different from the atomic mass or mass number typically found in nature (i.e., naturally occurring).
  • hydrogen atoms are replaced or substituted by one or more deuterium or tritium (e.g., hydrogen atoms on a C 1-6 alkyl or a C 1-6 alkoxy are replaced with deuterium, such as d 3 -methoxy or 1,1,2,2-d 4 -3-methylbutyl).
  • deuterium or tritium e.g., hydrogen atoms on a C 1-6 alkyl or a C 1-6 alkoxy are replaced with deuterium, such as d 3 -methoxy or 1,1,2,2-d 4 -3-methylbutyl.
  • Certain isotopically labeled compounds e.g., compounds of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va)]
  • those incorporating a radioactive isotope are useful in drug and/or substrate tissue distribution studies.
  • the radioactive isotopes tritium, i.e., 3 H, and carbon 14, i.e., 14 C, are particularly useful for this purpose in view of their ease of incorporation and ready means of detection.
  • Such isotopically labeled compounds are useful in metabolic studies (preferably with 14 C), reaction kinetic studies (with, for example 2 H or 3 H), detection or imaging techniques [such as positron emission tomography (PET) or single-photon emission computed tomography (SPECT)] including drug or substrate tissue distribution assays, or in radioactive treatment of patients.
  • detection or imaging techniques such as positron emission tomography (PET) or single-photon emission computed tomography (SPECT)
  • PET positron emission tomography
  • SPECT single-photon emission computed tomography
  • substitution with heavier isotopes such as deuterium (i.e., 2 H) may afford certain therapeutic advantages resulting from greater metabolic stability, for example increased in vivo half-life or reduced dosage requirements.
  • Isotopically labeled compounds e.g., of formula (I), (Ia), or (Ib)] or their corresponding prodrugs can generally be prepared by conventional techniques known to those skilled in the art or by processes analogous to those described in the accompanying examples using an
  • Suitable isotopes that may be incorporated in compounds of the present application include but are not limited to isotopes of hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, fluorine, chlorine, and iodine, such as 2 H (also written as D for deuterium), 3 H (also written as T for tritium), 11 C, 13 C, 14 C, 13 N, 15 N, 15 O, 17 O, 18 O, 18 F, 35 S, 36 Cl , 82 B r, 75 Br, 76 B r, 77 Br, 123 I, 124 I, 125 I, 131 I, 31 P, and 32 P.
  • isotopes such as 2 H (also written as D for deuterium), 3 H (also written as T for tritium), 11 C, 13 C, 14 C, 13 N, 15 N, 15 O, 17 O, 18 O, 18 F, 35 S, 36 Cl , 82 B r, 75 Br, 76 B r, 77 Br, 123 I, 124 I, 125 I
  • Isotopically labeled compounds of this application and prodrugs thereof can generally be prepared by carrying out the procedures disclosed in the schemes or in the examples and preparations described below by substituting a readily available isotopically labeled reagent for a non-isotopically labeled reagent.
  • Provisos may apply to any of the disclosed categories or embodiments such that specific embodiments or species may be excluded from such categories or embodiments.
  • the compound or set of compounds, such as are used in the inventive methods can be any one of any of the combinations and/or sub-combinations of the above-listed embodiments.
  • compositions and methods of the present application may be utilized to treat a subject, such as a mammal, e.g., human, or a non-human mammal, in need thereof.
  • a subject such as a mammal, e.g., human
  • the composition or the compound is preferably administered as a pharmaceutical composition comprising, for example, a compound of the application and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the application relates to a pharmaceutical composition
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising as active ingredient a therapeutically effective amount of a compound according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or prodrug thereof, in association with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, excipient, or diluent.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable carrier refers to a
  • composition or vehicle such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, solvent or encapsulating material, which can act, for example, to stabilize, increase solubility or to increase the absorption of a compound such as a compound of the application.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable material, composition or vehicle such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, solvent or encapsulating material, which can act, for example, to stabilize, increase solubility or to increase the absorption of a compound such as a compound of the application.
  • Each carrier must be “acceptable” in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not injurious to the patient.
  • compositions are well known in the art.
  • materials which can serve as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers include, but are not limited to: (1) sugars, such as lactose, glucose, sucrose or dextrans; (2) starches, such as corn starch and potato starch; (3) cellulose, and its derivatives, such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; (4) powdered tragacanth; (5) malt; (6) gelatin; (7) talc; (8) excipients, such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; (9) oils, such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; (10) glycols, such as glycerol or propylene glycol; (11) polyols, such as glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; (12) esters, such as ethyl oleate and eth
  • the choice of a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, including a physiologically acceptable agent depends, for example, on the route of administration of the composition.
  • the pharmaceutical composition can be a self-emulsifying or a self-microemulsifying drug delivery system.
  • the pharmaceutical composition also can be a liposome or other polymer matrix, which can have incorporated therein. Liposomes, for example, which comprise phospholipids or other lipids, are nontoxic, physiologically acceptable and metabolizable carriers that are relatively simple to make and administer.
  • wetting agents such as sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium stearate, as well as coloring agents, release agents, coating agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present in the compositions.
  • Such liquid compositions may optionally contain: pharmaceutically-acceptable excipients such as suspending agents (for example, sorbitol, methyl cellulose, sodium alginate, gelatin, hydroxyethylcellulose, carboxymethylcellulose, aluminum stearate gel and the like); non- aqueous vehicles, e.g., oil (for example, almond oil or fractionated coconut oil), propylene glycol, ethyl alcohol, or water; preservatives (for example, methyl or propyl p-hydroxybenzoate or sorbic acid); wetting agents such as lecithin; and, if desired, flavoring or coloring agents.
  • suspending agents for example, sorbitol, methyl cellulose, sodium alginate, gelatin, hydroxyethylcellulose, carboxymethylcellulose, aluminum stearate gel and the like
  • non- aqueous vehicles e.g., oil (for example, almond oil or fractionated coconut oil), propylene glycol, ethyl alcohol, or water
  • antioxidants examples include: (1) water-soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbic acid, cysteine hydrochloride, sodium bisulfate, sodium
  • antioxidants such as ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT), lecithin, propyl gallate, alpha-tocopherol, and the like
  • metal-chelating agents such as citric acid, ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA), sorbitol, tartaric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like.
  • a pharmaceutical composition can be administered to a subject by any of a number of routes of administration including, but not limited to, for example, orally [for example, drenches as in aqueous or non-aqueous solutions or suspensions, tablets, pills, capsules (including sprinkle capsules and gelatin capsules), boluses, powders, granules, pastes for application to the tongue]; absorption through the oral mucosa (e.g., sublingually); anally, rectally or vaginally (for example, as a pessary, cream or foam); parenterally (including intramuscularly,
  • composition or compound may also be formulated for inhalation.
  • the composition or compound may be simply dissolved or suspended in sterile water. Details of appropriate routes of administration and compositions suitable for same can be found in, for example, U.S. Pat.
  • compositions are also contemplated by the application, including compositions that are in accord with national and local regulations governing such compositions.
  • the compositions are formulated for intravenous or oral administration.
  • the compounds the application may be provided in a solid form, such as a tablet, pills, dragees, powers, granules, or capsule, or as a solution, emulsion, or suspension.
  • the active ingredient is mixed with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate, and/or any of the following: (1) fillers or extenders, such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol, and/or silicic acid; (2) binders, such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, sucrose and/or acacia; (3) humectants, such as glycerol; (4) disintegrating agents, such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates, and sodium carbonate; (5) solution retarding agents, such as paraffin; (6) absorption accelerators
  • fillers or extenders such
  • microcrystalline cellulose aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar, and tragacanth; and (13) other non-toxic compatible substances employed in pharmaceutical formulations, such as, without limitation, , buffering agents, perfuming and preservative agents, sweetening agents, flavoring agents.
  • Oral tablets may be made by compression or molding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients, such as diluents, disintegrating agents, binding agents, lubricating agents, sweetening agents, flavoring agents, coloring agents and preservative agents.
  • Suitable inert fillers include sodium and calcium carbonate, sodium and calcium phosphate, lactose, starch, sugar, glucose, methyl cellulose, magnesium stearate, mannitol, sorbitol, and the like.
  • Exemplary liquid oral excipients include ethanol, glycerol, water, and the like.
  • Starch, polyvinyl-pyrrolidone (PVP), sodium starch glycolate, microcrystalline cellulose, and alginic acid are exemplary disintegrating agents.
  • Binding agents may include hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose, starch and gelatin.
  • the lubricating agent if present, may be magnesium stearate, stearic acid, or talc. If desired, the tablets may be coated with a material such as glyceryl monostearate or glyceryl distearate to delay absorption in the gastrointestinal tract, or may be coated with an enteric coating.
  • solid dosage forms of the pharmaceutical compositions such as dragees, capsules (including sprinkle capsules and gelatin capsules), pills and granules, may optionally be scored or prepared with coatings and shells, such as enteric coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical-formulating art.
  • active ingredient(s) may be mixed with a solid, semi-solid, or liquid diluent.
  • Soft gelatin capsules may be prepared by mixing the active ingredient with water, oil such as peanut oil or olive oil, liquid paraffin, a mixture of mono and di-glycerides of short chain fatty acids, polyethylene glycol 400, or propylene glycol.
  • compositions may also be formulated so as to provide slow or controlled release of the active ingredient therein using, for example, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose in varying proportions to provide the desired release profile, other polymer matrices, liposomes and/or microspheres. They may be sterilized by, for example, filtration through a bacteria-retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions that can be dissolved in sterile water, or some other sterile injectable medium immediately before use. These compositions may also optionally contain opacifying agents and may be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain portion of the gastrointestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner. Examples of embedding compositions that can be used include polymeric substances and waxes. The active ingredient can also be in micro-encapsulated form, if appropriate, with one or more of the above-described excipients.
  • Liquid dosage forms useful for oral administration include pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, lyophiles for reconstitution, microemulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs, or may be lyophilized or presented as a dry product for reconstitution with water or other suitable vehicle before use.
  • the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as, for example, water or other solvents, cyclodextrins and derivatives thereof, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers, such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof.
  • inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as, for example, water or other solvents, cyclodextrins and derivatives thereof, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers, such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl
  • formulations of the pharmaceutical compositions for administration to the mouth may be presented as a mouthwash, or an oral spray, or an oral ointment.
  • parenteral administration means modes of administration other than enteral and topical administration, usually by injection, and includes, without limitation, intravenous, intramuscular, intraarterial, intrathecal, intracapsular, intraorbital, intracardiac, intradermal, intranasal, intraperitoneal, transtracheal, subcutaneous, subcuticular, intraarticular, subcapsular, subarachnoid, intraspinal, and
  • the agents of the application may be provided in sterile aqueous solutions or suspensions, buffered to an appropriate pH and isotonicity or in parenterally acceptable oil.
  • Suitable aqueous vehicles include Ringer's solution and isotonic sodium chloride.
  • Such forms may be presented in unit-dose form such as ampoules or disposable injection devices, in multi-dose forms such as vials from which the appropriate dose may be withdrawn, or in a solid form or pre-concentrate that can be reconstituted into a sterile injectable
  • formulation such as solutions or dispersions just prior to use, which may contain antioxidants, buffers, bacteriostats, solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient or suspending or thickening agents.
  • Illustrative infusion doses range from about 1 to 1000 ⁇ g/kg/minute of agent admixed with a pharmaceutical carrier over a period ranging from several minutes to several days.
  • aqueous and nonaqueous carriers examples include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof, vegetable oils, such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters, such as ethyl oleate.
  • polyols such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like
  • vegetable oils such as olive oil
  • injectable organic esters such as ethyl oleate.
  • Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions, and by the use of surfactants.
  • These compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents.
  • antibacterial and antifungal agents for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid, and the like. It may also be desirable to include isotonic agents, such as sugars, sodium chloride, and the like into the compositions.
  • the absorption of the drug in order to prolong the effect of a drug, it is desirable to slow the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material having poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon its rate of dissolution, which, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally administered drug form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
  • Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsulated matrices of the subject compounds in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending on the ratio of drug to polymer, and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of drug release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions that are compatible with body tissue.
  • the aqueous solution is pyrogen-free, or substantially pyrogen-free.
  • the excipients can be chosen, for example, to effect delayed release of an agent or to selectively target one or more cells, tissues or organs.
  • formulations of the pharmaceutical compositions may be presented as a suppository, which may be prepared by mixing one or more active compounds with one or more suitable nonirritating excipients or carriers comprising, for example, cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol, a suppository wax or a salicylate, and which is solid at room temperature, but liquid at body temperature and, therefore, will melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
  • suitable nonirritating excipients or carriers comprising, for example, cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol, a suppository wax or a salicylate, and which is solid at room temperature, but liquid at body temperature and, therefore, will melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
  • suitable nonirritating excipients or carriers comprising, for example, cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol, a suppository wax or a salicylate, and which is solid at room temperature, but liquid at body temperature and, therefore, will melt in the rectum or vagina
  • the active compounds of the present application may be mixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and with any preservatives, buffers, excipients, or propellants, such as animal and vegetable fats, oils, waxes, paraffins, starch, tragacanth, cellulose derivatives, polyethylene glycols, silicones, bentonites, silicic acid, talc and zinc oxide, or mixtures thereof.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier such as animal and vegetable fats, oils, waxes, paraffins, starch, tragacanth, cellulose derivatives, polyethylene glycols, silicones, bentonites, silicic acid, talc and zinc oxide, or mixtures thereof.
  • Dosage forms for the topical include powders, sprays, ointments, pastes, creams, lotions, gels, solutions, patches and inhalants.
  • the active compounds may be mixed with a pharmaceutical carrier at a concentration of about 0.1% to about 10% of drug to vehicle.
  • Powders and sprays can contain, in addition to an active compound, excipients such as lactose, talc, silicic acid, aluminum hydroxide, calcium silicates and polyamide powder, or mixtures of these substances.
  • Sprays can additionally contain customary propellants, such as chlorofluorohydrocarbons and volatile unsubstituted hydrocarbons, such as butane and propane.
  • Transdermal patches have the added advantage of providing controlled delivery of a compound of the present application to the body.
  • dosage forms can be made by dissolving or dispersing the active compound in the proper medium.
  • Absorption enhancers can also be used to increase the flux of the compound across the skin. The rate of such flux can be controlled by either providing a rate controlling membrane or dispersing the compound in a polymer matrix or gel.
  • Ophthalmic formulations eye ointments, powders, solutions and the like, are also contemplated as being within the scope of this application. Exemplary ophthalmic formulations are described in U.S. Publication Nos.2005/0080056, 2005/0059744, 2005/0031697 and 2005/004074 and U.S. Patent No.6,583,124, the contents of which are incorporated herein by reference. If desired, liquid ophthalmic formulations have properties similar to that of lacrimal fluids, aqueous humor or vitreous humor or are compatible with such fluids. A preferred route of administration is local administration (e.g., topical administration, such as eye drops, or administration via an implant).
  • local administration e.g., topical administration, such as eye drops, or administration via an implant.
  • compositions can be formulated for delivery via a catheter, stent, wire, or other intraluminal device. Delivery via such devices may be especially useful for delivery to the bladder, urethra, ureter, rectum, or intestine.
  • Methods of introduction may also be provided by rechargeable or biodegradable devices.
  • Various slow release polymeric devices have been developed and tested in vivo in recent years for the controlled delivery of drugs, including proteinacious biopharmaceuticals.
  • a variety of biocompatible polymers including hydrogels, including both biodegradable and non- degradable polymers, can be used to form an implant for the sustained release of a compound at a particular target site.
  • therapeutically effective amount refers to an amount or dose sufficient to generally bring about the desired therapeutic benefit or an amount sufficient to modulate the biological activity of the target receptor in subjects needing such treatment.
  • Effective amounts or dosages of the compounds of the application may be ascertained by routine methods, such as modeling, dose escalation, or clinical trials, taking into account routine factors. Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions may be varied. In general, a suitable daily dose of an active compound used in the compositions and methods of the application will be that amount of the compound that is the lowest dose effective to produce a therapeutic effect.
  • the selected dosage level will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the particular compound or combination of compounds employed, or the salts, solvate, and prodrug thereof, the route of administration, the time of administration, the rate of excretion of the particular compound(s) being employed, the duration of the treatment, other drugs, compounds and/or materials used in combination with particular compound(s) employed, age, sex, weight, condition, general health, prior medical history of the patient being treated, and the preference and experience of the physician or veterinarian in charge, and like factors well known in the medical arts.
  • a regimen for a subject such as a patient
  • the compounds of the application are effective over a wide dosage range.
  • dosages from about 0.05 to about 5000 mg, preferably from about 1 to about 2000 mg, and more preferably between about 2 and about 2000 mg per day can be used.
  • a typical dosage is about 10 mg to about 1000 mg per day, or 25 to 200 mg per day, or 50 to 100 mg per day, or less than 100 mg per day.
  • the compounds of the application are dispensed in unit dosage form including from about 0.05 mg to about 1000 mg of active ingredient together with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier per unit dosage.
  • a unit dosage form includes from about 10 to about 200 mg of active ingredient.
  • dosage forms suitable for oral, nasal, pulmonal or transdermal administration include from about 125 ⁇ g to about 1250 mg, preferably from about 250 ⁇ g to about 500 mg, and more preferably from about 2.5 mg to about 250 mg, of the compounds admixed with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent.
  • Dosage forms can be administered daily or more than once a day, such as twice or thrice daily. Alternatively dosage forms can be administered less frequently than daily, such as every other day, or weekly, if found to be advisable by a prescribing physician. A larger dosage can be delivered by multiple administrations of the agent. In some embodiments, dosage forms are administered once, twice, or thrice daily. In preferred embodiments, the active compound will be administered once daily. Once improvement of the patient’s disease has occurred, the dose may be adjusted for maintenance treatment. For example, the dosage or the frequency of
  • administration, or both may be reduced as a function of the symptoms, to a level at which the desired therapeutic or prophylactic effect is maintained.
  • treatment may cease.
  • Patients may, however, require intermittent treatment on a long-term basis upon any recurrence of symptoms. Patients may also require chronic treatment on a long-term basis.
  • compounds of the application can be used to modulate, such as to activate (agonist), or to block activation of (antagonist), an orexin receptor.
  • the application provides a method of modulating an orexin receptor comprising contacting the receptor with an effective amount or concentration of a compound of the application.
  • the orexin receptor can be OX 1 or OX 2 .
  • the compound of the application is an antagonist of an orexin receptor such as OX 1 or OX 2 , or both, and can be a selective inhibitor of one or the other.
  • contacting can take place in vivo within tissues of a patient, such as a human patient.
  • modulation of an orexin receptor, for example, antagonism of orexin-1, by a compound of the application can be used to treat a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a patient, as described herein.
  • the application provides a method of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a patient, such as treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in which modulation of an orexin receptor is medically indicating, comprising administering to the subject, such as a patient, a compound of the application in a dose, at a frequency, and for duration to provide a beneficial effect to the subject.
  • Modulation, such as agonism or antagonism, of an orexin receptor can be medically indicated in treatment of a disease, disorder, or medical condition wherein the orexin receptor plays a metabolic or regulatory role.
  • Certain such conditions can be treated by selective modulation of a single class of orexin receptor, such as modulation of OX 1 while OX 2 is not influenced by administration of the compound of the application at the dose provided.
  • compounds of the application can be orexin-1 antagonists, and some of those are selective orexin-1 antagonists with respect to orexin-2.
  • selective is meant that one receptor is modulated at
  • the compound of the application can be a selective modulator, e.g., an antagonist, of orexin receptor OX 1 .
  • the compound of the application can be a selective modulator (e.g., antagonist) of an orexin receptor OX 2 .
  • the compound of the application can further modulate other types or classes of receptors having affinity for one of more forms of the orexin class of natural peptidic ligands.
  • the application provides a use of a compound of the application for treatment of a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a patient.
  • a compound of the application can be used in the preparation of a medicament for administration to a patient suffering from a disease, disorder, or medical condition.
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition can comprise an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, aggression associated with neurological disorders such as Alzheimer's disease, and aggression associated with neurodevelopmental disorders such as autism, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, head ache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune- related diseases, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease.
  • Drug or substance abuse or addiction includes relapse. These may include abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, nicotine, alcohol, cannabis, heroin, and/or any other drug of abuse.
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is narcolepsy, insomnia, learning disorders, memory disorders, depression, anxiety, addiction, obsessive compulsive disorder, affective neurosis, depressive neurosis, anxiety neurosis, dysthymic disorder, behavior disorder, mood disorder, sexual dysfunction, psychosexual dysfunction, sex disorder, schizophrenia, manic depression, delirium, dementia, severe mental retardation or dyskinesias (such as Huntington’s Disease or Tourette Syndrome), eating disorders (such as anorexia, bulimia, cachexia, or obesity), addictive feeding behaviors, binge/purge feeding behaviors, cardiovascular diseases, diabetes, appetite/taste disorders, emesis, vomiting, nausea, asthma, cancer, Parkinson’s Disease, Cushing’s Syndrome/Disease, basophile adenoma, prolactinoma, hyperprolactinemia, hypophysis tumor/adenoma, hypothalamic diseases, inflammatory bowel disease, gastric dyskinesia, gastric ulcers, Fr
  • hypothalamic hypogonadism adrenohypophysis hyperfunction
  • Kallman anosmia, hyposmia
  • functional or psychogenic amenorrhea adrenohypophysis hyperfunction
  • hypothalamic hypogonadism Kallman’s syndrome (anosmia, hyposmia), functional or psychogenic amenorrhea, hypopituitarism, hypothalamic
  • hypothyroidism hypothalamic-adrenal dysfunction
  • idiopathic hyperprolactinemia idiopathic hyperprolactinemia
  • hypothalamic disorders of growth hormone deficiency, idiopathic growth deficiency, dwarfism, gigantism, acromegaly, disturbed biological and circadian rhythms, sleep disturbances associated with disease such as neurological disorders, neuropathic pain, diabetic neuropathy, and restless leg syndrome, heart and lung diseases, acute and congestive heart failure, hypotension, hypertension, urinary retention, osteoporosis, angina pectoris, myocardial infarction, ischemic or hemorrhagic stroke, subsrachnoic hemorrhage, ulcers, allergies, benign prostatic hypertrophy, chronic renal failure, renal disease, impaired glucose tolerance, migraine, episodic migraine, headache disorders (such as tension-type headache, cluster headache, other trigeminal autonomic cephalalgias, other primary headaches such as hemicranias continua, secondary headaches, cranial neuralgia, or central or primary facial pain), hyperalgesia, pain, enhanced or exaggerated sensitivity to pain such as hyper
  • the compounds described herein are useful in a method of treating disorders including, but not limited to, sleep disorders, sleep disturbances, including enhancing sleep quality, improving sleep quality, increasing sleep efficiency, augmenting sleep maintenance; increasing the ratio of the time that a subject sleeps relative to the time that a subject is attempting to sleep; improving sleep initiation; decreasing sleep latency or onset (the time it takes to fall asleep); decreasing difficulties in falling asleep; increasing sleep continuity; decreasing the number of awakenings during sleep; decreasing intermittent wakings during sleep; decreasing nocturnal arousals; decreasing the time spent awake following the initial onset of sleep; increasing the total amount of sleep; reducing the fragmentation of sleep; altering the timing, frequency, or duration of REM sleep bouts; altering the timing, frequency, or duration of slow wave (such as stages 3 or 4) sleep bouts; increasing the amount and percentage of stage 2 sleep; promoting slow wave sleep; enhancing EEG-delta activity during sleep; decreasing nocturnal arousals, especially early morning awakenings; increasing daytime alertness;
  • mood disorders such as depression or more particularly depressive disorders, for example, single episodic or recurrent major depressive disorders and dysthymic disorders, or bipolar disorders, for example, bipolar I disorder, bipolar II disorder, and cyclothymic disorder, mood disorders due to a general medical condition, and substance-induced mood disorders
  • anxiety disorders including acute stress disorder, agoraphobia, generalized anxiety disorder, obsessive-compulsive disorder, panic attack, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, separation anxiety disorder, social phobia, specific phobia, substance-induced mood disorders
  • anxiety disorders including acute stress disorder, agoraphobia, generalized anxiety disorder, obsessive-compulsive disorder, panic attack, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, separation anxiety disorder, social phobia, specific phobia, substance-induced anxiety disorder and anxiety due to a general medical condition
  • acute neurological and psychiatric disorders such as cerebral deficits subsequent to cardiac bypass surgery and grafting, stroke, ischemic stroke
  • Huntington's Chorea amyotrophic lateral sclerosis; multiple sclerosis; ocular damage;
  • retinopathy cognitive disorders; idiopathic and drug-induced Parkinson's disease; muscular spasms and disorders associated with muscular spasticity including tremors, epilepsy, convulsions; cognitive disorders including dementia (associated with Alzheimer's disease, ischemia, trauma, vascular problems or stroke, HIV disease, Parkinson's disease, Huntington's disease, Pick's disease, Creutzfeldt-Jacob disease, perinatal hypoxia, other general medical conditions or substance abuse); delirium, amnestic disorders or age related cognitive decline; schizophrenia or psychosis including schizophrenia (paranoid, disorganized, catatonic or undifferentiated), schizophreniform disorder, schizoaffective disorder, delusional disorder, brief psychotic disorder, shared psychotic disorder, psychotic disorder due to a general medical condition and substance-induced psychotic disorder; substance-related disorders and addictive behaviors (including substance-induced delirium, persisting dementia, persisting amnestic disorder, psychotic disorder or anxiety disorder; tolerance, addictive feeding, dependence or withdrawal from substances including alcohol, amphe
  • dystonia including generalized dystonia such as iodiopathic dystonia, drug-induced dystonia, symptomatic dystonia and paroxymal dystonia, and focal dystonia such as blepharospasm, oromandibular dystonia, spasmodic dysphonia, spasmodic torticollis, axial dystonia, dystonic writer's cramp and hemiplegic dystonia); attention deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD);
  • generalized dystonia such as iodiopathic dystonia, drug-induced dystonia, symptomatic dystonia and paroxymal dystonia, and focal dystonia such as blepharospasm, oromandibular dystonia, spasmodic dysphonia, spasmodic torticollis, axial dystonia, dystonic writer's cramp and hemiplegic dystonia
  • ADHD attention deficit/hyperactivity disorder
  • migraine including migraine headache
  • substance tolerance including, substances such as opiates, nicotine, tobacco products, alcohol, benzodiazepines, cocaine, sedatives, hypnotics, etc.
  • psychosis including, depression, anxiety, depression, etc.
  • schizophrenia including generalized anxiety disorder, panic disorder, and obsessive compulsive disorder
  • mood disorders including depression, mania, bipolar disorders
  • retinopathy macular degeneration of the eye; emesis; brain edema; pain, including acute and chronic pain states, severe pain, intractable pain, inflammatory pain, neuropathic pain, post- traumatic pain, bone and joint pain (osteoarthritis), repetitive motion pain, dental pain, cancer pain, myofascial pain (muscular injury, fibromyalgia), perioperative pain (general surgery, gynecological), chronic pain, neuropathic pain, post-traumatic pain, trigeminal neuralgia, migraine and migraine headache.
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, head ache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease.
  • the disease, disorder, or medical condition is substance addiction (including relapse), panic disorder, anxiety, post-traumatic stress disorder, pain, depression, seasonal affective disorder, an eating disorder, or hypertension.
  • the present application provides methods for: enhancing the quality of sleep; augmenting sleep maintenance; increasing REM sleep; increasing stage 2 sleep; decreasing fragmentation of sleep patterns; treating insomnia; enhancing cognition;
  • antagonism of orexin-1 is medically indicated for the treatment of the above-listed conditions.
  • antagonism is meant blocking a receptor, in this case an orexin receptor, without causing it to transduce a signal. That is, antagonism results in blocking an endogenous or exogenous ligand from activating, or causing antagonism, of the receptor.
  • the application comprises a method for conducting a
  • the method further includes providing a sales group for marketing the preparation to healthcare providers.
  • the application relates to a method for conducting a
  • Healthcare providers refers to individuals or organizations that provide healthcare services to a person, community, etc.
  • Examples of “healthcare providers” include doctors, hospitals, continuing care retirement communities, skilled nursing facilities, subacute care facilities, clinics, multispecialty clinics, freestanding ambulatory centers, home health agencies, and HMO's.
  • the compounds of the present application may be used in pharmaceutical compositions or methods in combination with one or more additional active ingredients in the treatment of the diseases and disorders described herein.
  • Further additional active ingredients include other therapeutics or agents that mitigate adverse effects of therapies for the intended disease targets.
  • Such combinations may serve to increase efficacy, ameliorate other disease symptoms, decrease one or more side effects, or decrease the required dose of an inventive compound.
  • such combination provides an additive effect, wherein an additive effect refers to the sum of each of the effects of individual administration of the compound of the application and one or more additional therapeutic agent(s).
  • such combination provides a synergistic effect, in which the therapeutic effect exceeds the sum of each of the effects of individual administration of the compound of the application and one or more additional therapeutic agent(s).
  • the additional active ingredients may be administered in a separate pharmaceutical composition from a compound of the present application or may be included with a compound of the present application in a single pharmaceutical composition.
  • the additional active ingredients may be administered simultaneously with, prior to, or after administration of a compound of the present application.
  • Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions may be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active ingredient that is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular subject, such as a patient, composition, and mode of administration, without being toxic to the subject.
  • Combination agents include additional active ingredients are those that are known or discovered to be effective in treating the diseases and disorders described herein, including those active against another target associated with the disease.
  • compositions and formulations of the application, as well as methods of treatment can further comprise other drugs or pharmaceuticals, e.g., other active agents useful for treating or palliative for the target diseases or related symptoms or conditions.
  • additional active ingredients include those that are known to be useful for enhancing sleep quality and preventing and treating sleep disorders and sleep disturbances, anti-diabetic agents, cardiovascular therapies, anti-obesity agents, other orexin receptor antagonists, pain medications, anti-depressants, anti-anxiety agents, cognition-enhancing agents, anti-Alzheimer’s Disease therapies, and other active ingredients.
  • Exemplary active pharmaceutical ingredients and other therapies that are suitable for
  • compositions of the any compound described herein may additional comprise one or more of such active agents, and methods of treatment may additionally comprise administering an effective amount of one or more of such active agents.
  • Each of the reactions depicted in the general schemes is preferably run at a temperature from about 0 °C to the reflux temperature of the organic solvent used.
  • the variables are as defined above in reference to Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va).
  • Isotopically labeled compounds as described herein are prepared according to the methods described below, using suitably labeled starting materials. Such materials are generally available from commercial suppliers of radiolabeled chemical reagents.
  • LiHMDS lithium bis(trimethylsilyl)amide
  • compounds of formula (I), (Ia), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) of the application wherein X is F, X’ is H and Z is NR 2 , can be prepared according to the genera synthetic scheme shown in Scheme 2.
  • compounds of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) of the application wherein X is F, X’ is H or halogen, such as F, and Z is O, can be prepared according to the general synthetic scheme shown in Scheme 3.
  • reaction mixture was filtered and washed with i-PrOH (100 mL) to yield a colorless solid ( ⁇ 40 g, ee ⁇ 94%). Recrystallization from IPA/MeOH afforded a colorless solid (36g, >99%ee, 38%).
  • Exemplary carboxylic acids include compounds aa-cv.
  • the mixture was then slowly poured into 2N HCl solution to bring the pH 2 ⁇ 3.
  • the reaction mixture was diluted with EtOAc and the layers were separated.
  • the aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x).
  • the combined organic extracts were washed with brine, dried (Na 2 SO 4 ) and concentrated to provide the crude boronic acid as a brown solid that was used without further purification.
  • Step 5 tert-butyl 4-(5-fluoropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
  • (3-(methoxycarbonyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for (3-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate.
  • Step 3 methyl 4-(5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
  • Step 1 methyl 1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
  • Step 1 methyl 1-methyl-4-(pyridin-3-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
  • Step 1 tert-butyl 4-bromo-1,5-dimethyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
  • Step 2 methyl 5-(5-fluoropyridin-2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylate
  • Compound be: 2-methyl-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)thiazole-4-carboxylic acid
  • Step 1 ethyl 5-bromo-2-methyloxazole-4-carboxylate
  • the acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described 5-chloro-2-(2-methyl- 2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid in step 1, using 5-chloro-2-methylbenzoic acid .
  • Step 5 methyl (Z)-2-((((1-aminoethylidene)amino)oxy)carbonyl)-5-chlorobenzoate 4-chloro-2- (methoxycarbonyl)benzoate
  • Step 6 methyl 5-chloro-2-(3-methyl-1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl)benzoate
  • Step 1 methyl 4-bromo-1-ethyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
  • Step 2 methyl 1-ethyl-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3- carboxylate
  • the acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid in Compound az using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine and methyl 5-bromo-2-methyl-2H-1,2,3-triazole-4-carboxylate in Step 2.
  • ESI-MS m/z: 204.97 [M+1] + .
  • Step 1 1-methyl-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
  • Step 1 (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate.
  • Step 2 N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin- 2-amine hydrobromide.
  • Step 3 ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-fluoro-2-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)phenyl)methanone.
  • Step 1 (2S,3R)-benzyl 2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3- methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate.
  • Step 2 5-chloro-N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)pyrimidin-2-amine
  • Step 3 ((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1- l 5-fluoro-2- 2H-123-triazol-2- l hen l methanone
  • Step 1 (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl mino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
  • Step 2 ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(6'-methyl-[2,3'-bipyridin]-2'-yl)methanone
  • Step 1 (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)- 5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)methanone
  • Step 2 ((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1- yl)(6-methyl-3-(pyrimidin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
  • Step 1 (2-bromo-5-methylphenyl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl mino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Neurology (AREA)
  • Neurosurgery (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Addiction (AREA)
  • Psychiatry (AREA)
  • Pain & Pain Management (AREA)
  • Child & Adolescent Psychology (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)
  • Rheumatology (AREA)
  • Reproductive Health (AREA)
  • Hospice & Palliative Care (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Obesity (AREA)
  • Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
  • Heart & Thoracic Surgery (AREA)
  • Cardiology (AREA)
  • Endocrinology (AREA)
  • Psychology (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Anesthesiology (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Hydrogenated Pyridines (AREA)
  • Plural Heterocyclic Compounds (AREA)

Abstract

The present application relates to certain halo-substituted piperidine compounds, pharmaceutical compositions containing them, and methods of using them, including methods for treating substance addiction, panic disorder, anxiety, post-traumatic stress disorder, pain, depression, seasonal affective disorder, an eating disorder, or hypertension.

Description

HALO-SUBSTITUTED PIPERIDINES AS OREXIN RECEPTOR
MODULATORS
Related Applications
This application claims the benefit of priority to U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 62/294,940, filed February 12, 2016, and U.S. Provisional Patent Application No.62/336,102, filed May 13, 2016, which applications are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety. Statement of Government Support
This invention was made with government support under Grant Numbers 1
P01DA033622 and 1 U01 NS083614 awarded by the National Institutes of Health.
The government has certain rights in this invention.
Background
Orexins are a family of homologous peptides including species orexin A, or OR-A, and orexin B, or OR-B. Orexin A is a 33 amino acid peptide and orexin B is a 28 amino acid peptide (Sakurai T. et al., Cell (1998), 92, 573-585). Orexins are produced in neurons of the lateral hypothalamus and bind to at least two distinct G-protein-coupled receptors, termed OX1 and OX2 receptors. The OX1 receptor is selective for OR-A, while the OX2 receptor can bind both OR-A and OR-B. Orexins are found to stimulate food consumption, regulate states of sleep and wakefulness, and may be involved in neural mechanisms of drug abuse and addiction.
Orexin receptors are suitable targets for the development of drug candidates for the treatment of a variety of Orexin-related pathologies or symptoms, such as, but not limited to, sleep/wake disorders, anxiety, and obesity. Numerous modulators of OX1, OX2, or both, have been developed to date [J. Med. Chem.2016, 59(2), 504-530]. However, many of the reported Orexin receptor modulators, such as antagonist ligands, have suboptimal metabolic stabilities. This translates into short half-lives and high observed clearance in in vivo pharmacokinetic experiments (ChemMedChem, 2012, 7, 415-424; Bioorganic&Medicinal Chemistry Letters 2012, 22, 3890-3894; Bioorganic&Medicinal Chemistry Letters, 2015, 25, 1884-1891; J. Med. Chem.2015, 58, 5620-5636.). There remains a need for small molecule modulators of Orexin receptors with desirable pharmaceutical properties.
Summary of the Application
This application provides a compound of formula (I),
Figure imgf000003_0001
or its pharmaceutically acceptable salt hereof, wherein:
X is halogen, such as F;
X’ is H or halogen, such as F;
Z is NR2 or O;
A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NRaRb;, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl; -N(Ra)CO2alkyl; -N(Ra)SO2alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRaRb; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NRaRb; wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH2CF3, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or–Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NRcRd; -N(Rc)C(O) alkyl; - N(Rc)CO2alkyl; -N(Rc)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRcRd; -SO2alkyl; and– SO2NRcRd; wherein Rc and Rd are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NReRf; -N(Re)C(O) alkyl; -N(Re)CO2alkyl; -N(Re)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONReRf; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NReRf; wherein Re and Rf are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
n is 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl); and
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl).
In certain embodiments, A is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1- 4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NRaRb;, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl; -N(Ra)CO2alkyl; - N(Ra)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRaRb; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NRaRb;
wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
In certain embodiments, n is 1.
In certain embodiments, X’ is halogen, such as F.
In certain embodiments, the com ound of formula I can be represented by formula (Ia),
Figure imgf000004_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein
X is halogen, such as F;
X’ is H or halogen, such as F;
Z is NR2 or O;
A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NRaRb;, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl; -N(Ra)CO2alkyl; -N(Ra)SO2alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRaRb; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NRaRb; wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH2CF3, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NRcRd; -N(Rc)C(O) alkyl; - N(Rc)CO2alkyl; -N(Rc)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRcRd; -SO2alkyl; and– SO2NRcRd; wherein Rc and Rd are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NReRf; -N(Re)C(O) alkyl; -N(Re)CO2alkyl; -N(Re)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONReRf; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NReRf; wherein Re and Rf are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; n is 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl); and
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl).
In certain embodiments, A is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1- 4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NRaRb;, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl; -N(Ra)CO2alkyl; - N(Ra)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRaRb; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NRaRb;
wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
In certain embodiments, n is 1.
In certain embodiments, X’ is halogen, such as F.
In certain embodiments, the com ound of formula I can be represented by formula (Ib),
Figure imgf000005_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein
Z is NR2 or O;
A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NRaRb;, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl; -N(Ra)CO2alkyl; -N(Ra)SO2alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRaRb; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NRaRb; wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH2CF3, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NRcRd; -N(Rc)C(O) alkyl; - N(Rc)CO2alkyl; -N(Rc)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRcRd; -SO2alkyl; and– SO2NRcRd; wherein Rc and Rd are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NReRf; -N(Re)C(O) alkyl; -N(Re)CO2alkyl; -N(Re)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONReRf; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NReRf; wherein Re and Rf are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
n is 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl); and
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl).
In certain embodiments, A is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1- 4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NRaRb;, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl; -N(Ra)CO2alkyl; - N(Ra)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRaRb; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NRaRb;
wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
In certain embodiments, n is 1.
In certain embodiments the com ound of formula I can be represented by formula (II):
Figure imgf000006_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
m=1, 2, or 3; and
R5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRjRk, -N(Rj)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rj)CO2alkyl, -N(Rj)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRjRk, -SO2alkyl, or– SO2NRjRk; wherein Rj and Rk are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
X, X’, Z, B, E, n, R1 and R2 are as defined herein.
In certain such embodiments, the compound of formula (II) can be represented by formula (IIa),
Figure imgf000006_0002
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. In certain such embodiments, X and X’ are both F. In certain embodiments, the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (III):
Figure imgf000007_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; wherein:
m=1, 2, 3, or 4; and
R5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRjRk, -N(Rj)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rj)CO2alkyl, -N(Rj)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRjRk, -SO2alkyl, or– SO2NRjRk; wherein Rj and Rk are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
X, X’, Z, B, E, n, R1 and R2 are as defined herein.
In certain such embodiments, the compound of formula (III) can be represented by formula (IIIa),
Figure imgf000007_0002
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. In certain such embodiments, X and X’ are both F.
In certain embodiments, the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (IV):
Figure imgf000007_0003
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; wherein:
R6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRoRp, -N(Ro)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rp)CO2alkyl, -N(Ro)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRoRp, -SO2alkyl, or– SO2NRoRp; wherein Ro and Rp are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
X, X’, Z, A, E, n, R1 and R2 are as defined herein. In certain such embodiments, the compound of formula (IV) can be represented by formula (IVa),
Figure imgf000008_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. In certain such embodiments, X and X’ are both F.
In certain embodiments, the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (V):
Figure imgf000008_0002
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; wherein:
R6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRoRp, -N(Ro)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rp)CO2alkyl, -N(Ro)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRoRp, -SO2alkyl, or– SO2NRoRp; wherein Ro and Rp are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
X, X’, Z, A, E, n, R1 and R2 are as defined herein.
In certain such embodiments, the compound of formula (V) can be represented by formula (Va),
Figure imgf000008_0003
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. In certain such embodiments, X and X’ are both F.
In certain embodiments, the compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) is a compound selected from those species described or exemplified in the detailed description below. In certain embodiments, this application provides a pharmaceutical composition, comprising at least one compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. Pharmaceutical compositions as described herein may further comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient. In certain embodiments, this application also describes a compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising of any of the foregoing for use as a medicament.
In another aspect, this application provides methods of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition mediated by orexin receptor activity a subject in need of such treatment, such as those described herein, comprising administering to the subject, such as a patient, an effective amount of at least one compound described herein or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof in a dose, at a frequency, and for a duration to provide a beneficial effect to the subject. The orexin receptor can be OX1, OX2, or both.
In some embodiments, this application provides methods of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a subject in need, such as a patient, comprising administering to the subject, such as a patient, an effective amount of at least one compound described herein or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof in a dose, at a frequency, and for a duration to provide a beneficial effect to the subject.
In certain embodiments, this application provides the use of a compound described herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising of any of the foregoing in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of diseases, disorders, and medical conditions regulated by orexin receptor activity, and the use of such compounds and salts for treatment of such diseases and medical conditions.
In certain embodiments, this application provides the use of a compound described herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising of any of the foregoing in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of diseases, disorders, and medical conditions, and the use of such compounds and salts for treatment of such diseases, disorder, and medical conditions.
In certain embodiments, this application provides a method of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a subject, such as a patient, comprising modulating an orexin receptor, wherein the modulating an orexin receptor comprises administering to the subject at least one compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising of any of the foregoing, in a dose, at a frequency, and for a duration to provide a beneficial effect to the subject patient.
In certain embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, head ache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease. In certain embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder,
schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, pain, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, and psychosexual disorder. In certain embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
In certain embodiments, drug abuse and addiction can include abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine.
In certain embodiments, this application provides a method of modulating the activity of an orexin receptor, such as one or both of OX1 or OX2, comprising contacting a cell comprising the orexin receptor with an effective amount of at least one compound described herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a composition comprising any one of the foregoing.
In certain embodiments, this application describes a method of modulating the activity of an orexin receptor, such as one or both of OX1 or OX2, comprising contacting a cell comprising the orexin receptor with an effective amount of at least one compound of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or with at least one compound or pharmaceutical composition as described herein. In certain embodiments of the foregoing, the contacting is in vitro, ex vivo, or in vivo. Additional embodiments, features, and advantages of the invention will be apparent from the following detailed description and through practice of the embodiments described in this application.
Detailed Description
The present application provides a compound of formula (I),
Figure imgf000011_0002
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
X is halogen, such as F;
X’ is H or halogen, such as F;
Z is NR2 or O;
A is optionally substituted aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl;
B is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl;
E is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl;
n is 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl); and
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl).
In certain embodiments, the compound of formula (I) can be represented by Formula (Ia):
Figure imgf000011_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein
X is halogen, such as F;
X’ is H or halogen, such as F;
Z is NR2 or O;
A is optionally substituted aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl;
B is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl; E is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl;
n = 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl); and
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl).
In certain embodiments, the com ound of formula I can be represented by formula (Ib),
Figure imgf000012_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein
Z is NR2 or O;
A is optionally substituted aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl;
B is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl;
E is optionally substituted aryl or heteroaryl;
n is 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl); and
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl).
In certain embodiments of the compound of formula (I), (Ia), or (Ib), A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NRaRb;, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl; - N(Ra)CO2alkyl; -N(Ra)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRaRb; -SO2alkyl; and– SO2NRaRb; wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl. In certain such embodiments, A is aryl or heteroaryl.
In certain embodiments of the compound of formula (I), (Ia), or (Ib), B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl,(e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH2CF3, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NRcRd; -N(Rc)C(O) alkyl; -N(Rc)CO2alkyl; -N(Rc)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRcRd; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NRcRd; wherein Rc and Rd are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl. In certain embodiments of the compound of formula (I), (Ia), or (Ib), E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NReRf; -N(Re)C(O) alkyl; - N(Re)CO2alkyl; -N(Re)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONReRf; -SO2alkyl; and– SO2NReRf; wherein Re and Rf are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
In certain embodiments, the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (II) or (IIa):
Figure imgf000013_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; wherein:
X is halogen, such as F;
X’ is H or halogen, such as F;
Z is NR2 or O;
M is1, 2, or 3;
B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH2CF3, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or–Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NRcRd; -N(Rc)C(O) alkyl; - N(Rc)CO2alkyl; -N(Rc)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRcRd; -SO2alkyl; and– SO2NRcRd; wherein Rc and Rd are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NReRf; -N(Re)C(O) alkyl; -N(Re)CO2alkyl; -N(Re)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONReRf; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NReRf; wherein Re and Rf are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
n is 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl);
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl); and R5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRjRk, -N(Rj)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rj)CO2alkyl, -N(Rj)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRjRk, -SO2alkyl, or– SO2NRjRk; wherein Rj and Rk are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
In certain embodiments, the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (III) or (IIIa):
Figure imgf000014_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; wherein:
X is halogen, such as F;
X’ is H or halogen, such as F;
Z is NR2 or O;
m is 1, 2, 3, or 4;
B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH2CF3, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or–Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); - OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NRcRd; -N(Rc)C(O) alkyl; - N(Rc)CO2alkyl; -N(Rc)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRcRd; -SO2alkyl; and– SO2NRcRd; wherein Rc and Rd are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NReRf; -N(Re)C(O) alkyl; -N(Re)CO2alkyl; -N(Re)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONReRf; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NReRf; wherein Re and Rf are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
n is 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl);
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl); and
R5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRjRk, -N(Rj)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rj)CO2alkyl, -N(Rj)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRjRk, -SO2alkyl, or– SO2NRjRk; wherein Rj and Rk are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl. In certain embodiments, the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (IV) or (IVa):
Figure imgf000015_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
X is halogen, such as F;
X’ is H or halogen, such as F;
Z is NR2 or O;
A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NRaRb;, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl; -N(Ra)CO2alkyl; -N(Ra)SO2alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRaRb; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NRaRb; wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NReRf; -N(Re)C(O) alkyl; -N(Re)CO2alkyl; -N(Re)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONReRf; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NReRf; wherein Re and Rf are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
n is 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl);
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl);
R6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRoRp, -N(Ro)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rp)CO2alkyl, -N(Ro)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRoRp, -SO2alkyl, or– SO2NRoRp; wherein Ro and Rp are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
In certain embodiments, the compound of formula (I) can be represented by formula (V) or (Va):
Figure imgf000016_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; wherein:
X is halogen, such as F;
X’ is H or halogen, such as F;
Z is NR2 or O;
A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g.,- Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NRaRb;, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl; -N(Ra)CO2alkyl; -N(Ra)SO2alkyl; - C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRaRb; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NRaRb; wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or–Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy; -CN; -NReRf; -N(Re)C(O) alkyl; -N(Re)CO2alkyl; -N(Re)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; - CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONReRf; -SO2alkyl; and–SO2NReRf; wherein Re and Rf are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
n is 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl);
R2 is H or alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl (e.g., methyl); and
R6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRoRp, -N(Ro)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rp)CO2alkyl, -N(Ro)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRoRp, -SO2alkyl, or– SO2NRoRp; wherein Ro and Rp are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
In certain embodiments, compounds of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, are further characterized as follows.
In certain embodiments, A is aryl or heteroaryl.
In certain embodiments, n is 1. In certain embodiments, X’ is halogen, such as F.
In certain embodiments, Z is NR2.
In certain embodiments, R2 is hydrogen.
In certain other embodiments, R2 is methyl.
In certain embodiments, each occurrence of X is -F.
In certain embodiments, R1 is C1-4alkyl, such as methyl.
In certain embodiments, A is an optionally substituted monocyclic or bicyclic heteroaryl. In certain such embodiments, A is selected from the list consisting of pyridinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, and benzoxazolyl. In certain embodiments, A is pyridinyl. In certain embodiments, A is pyrimidinyl. In certain embodiments, A is pyrazinyl. In certain embodiments, A is pyridazinyl.
In certain embodiments, A is unsubstituted. In other embodiments, A is optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, such as ethyl, -CHF2, or -CF3; alkoxy, such as methoxy; or halo, such as -Cl. In certain such embodiments, A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of–F, -Br, -Cl, -CHF2, -CF3, methyl, ethyl, and methoxy. In other embodiments, A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of–F, -Br, -Cl, -CF3, methyl, ethyl, and methoxy.
In certain embodiments, A is monosubstituted. In certain such embodiments, A is substituted with -CHF2 or -CF3, such as -CF3.
In certain embodiments, B is an optionally substituted aryl, such as phenyl.
In certain embodiments, B is an optionally substituted monocyclic heteroaryl or bicyclic heteroaryl. In certain such embodiments, B selected from the list consisting of pyridinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, imidazolyl, triazolyl, thiazolyl, thiophenyl, pyrazolyl, and benzoimidazolyl, such as pyridinyl, thiophenyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, pyrazolyl, triazolyl or benzoimidazolyl. In certain embodiments, B is pyridinyl. In certain embodiments, B is thiophenyl. In certain embodiments, B is oxazolyl. In certain embodiments, B is thiazolyl. In certain embodiments, B is pyrazolyl. In certain embodiments, B is triazolyl. In certain embodiments, B is benzoimidazolyl.
In certain embodiments, B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of an alkyl, such as methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, - CHF2, -CF3, or -CH2CF3; halo, such as -F or–Cl; alkoxy, such as methoxy; and–CN. In certain embodiments, B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of -F, -Cl, -Br, -CN, methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CF3, -CHF2, -CH2CF3, isopropoxy, and methoxy. In other embodiments, B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of -F, -Cl, -Br, -CN, methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CF3, -CH2CF3, isopropoxy, and methoxy. In certain such embodiments, B is optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, such as methyl.
In certain embodiments, B is monosubstituted. In certain such embodiments, B is substituted with an alkyl, such as methyl.
In certain embodiments, E is an optionally substituted phenyl.
In certain embodiments, E is an optionally substituted monocyclic heteroaryl, such as triazoyl, tetrazolyl, pyrazolyl, pyridinyl, oxadiazolyl, pyrazinyl, or pyrimidinyl. In certain embodiments, E is triazoyl. In certain embodiments, E is tetrazolyl. In certain embodiments, E is pyrazolyl. In certain embodiments, E is pyridinyl. In certain embodiments, E is oxadiazolyl. In certain embodiments, E is pyrimidinyl. In certain embodiments, E is pyrazinyl.
In certain embodiments, E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as methyl, ethyl, -CHF2, or– CF3, e.g., methyl, halo, such as–F, -Br, or–Cl, e.g., -F or -Cl,; and alkoxy, such as methoxy. In other embodiments, E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, such as methyl, ethyl, or–CF3, e.g., methyl, halo, such as–F, -Br, or–Cl, e.g., -F or -Cl,; and alkoxy, such as methoxy. In further such
embodiments, E is optionally substituted with one or more substituent independently selected from methyl or -F.
In certain embodiments, E is monosubstituted. In other embodiments, E is unsubstituted. In certain embodiments, the fragment -B-E in the compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib),
(II), (IIa), (III), or (IIIa) can be represented by
Figure imgf000018_0001
, wherein:
Y, independently for each occurrence, represents CH or N; and
R3 represents alkyl, such as C1-4alkyl(e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH2CF3, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NRgRh; -N(Rg)C(O) alkyl; -N(Rg)CO2alkyl; -N(Rg)SO2alkyl; -C(O)alkyl; -CO2H; -CO2alkyl; -CONRgRh; -SO2alkyl; or–SO2NRgRh; wherein Rg and Rh are each independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
Figure imgf000019_0006
In certain such embodiments the structure is selected from the following:
Figure imgf000019_0001
For example, in certain embodiments, the fragment -B-E is
Figure imgf000019_0002
In certain such embodiments, R3 is alkyl, such as -CH3 or -CF3; or alkoxy, such as methoxy.
In other embodiments, the fragment -B-E is
Figure imgf000019_0003
. In certain such embodiments, R3 is halo, such as -F or -Cl; or alkyl, such as methyl; or -CN.
In certain embodiments, the fragment -B-E in the compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib),
Figure imgf000019_0004
(II), (IIa), (III), or (IIIa) forms a hetero-aromatic ring structure of , wherein:
, independently for each occurrence, represents a single or double bond;
W, independently for each occurrence, represents N, S, O, or CH;
V represents N or C; and
R4 represents alkyl, , such as C1-4alkyl(e.g., methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CH2CF3, or -CF3); cycloalkyl; halo, such as -F, -Cl, or -Br (e.g., -F or -Cl); -OH; alkoxy, such as methoxy or isopropoxy (e.g., methoxy); -CN; -NRiRj, -N(Ri)C(O) alkyl, -N(Ri)CO2alkyl, -N(Ri)SO2alkyl, - C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRiRj, -SO2alkyl, or–SO2NRiRj; wherein Ri and Rj are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
In certain such embodiments, the structure
Figure imgf000019_0005
is selected from the following: . In certain embodiments, the structure
Figure imgf000020_0001
iments, R4 is C1-4alkyl, such as methyl. In
certain other embodiments, the structure
Figure imgf000020_0002
. In certain such embodiments, R4 is C1-4alkyl, such as methyl.
In certain embodiments, Z is O. In other embodiments, Z is NR2.
In certain embodiments, n = 1.
In certain embodiments, the compound of formula (I) is selected from the compounds provided in Table 1, and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
Table 1. Halo-Substituted Piperidine Derivatives as Orexin Antagonists
Figure imgf000020_0003
Figure imgf000021_0001
Figure imgf000022_0001
Figure imgf000023_0001
Figure imgf000024_0001
Figure imgf000025_0001
Figure imgf000026_0001
Figure imgf000027_0001
Figure imgf000028_0001
Figure imgf000029_0001
Figure imgf000030_0001
Figure imgf000031_0001
Figure imgf000032_0001
Figure imgf000033_0001
Figure imgf000034_0001
Figure imgf000035_0001
Figure imgf000036_0001
Figure imgf000037_0001
Figure imgf000038_0001
Figure imgf000039_0001
Figure imgf000040_0001
Figure imgf000041_0001
Figure imgf000042_0001
In certain embodiments, this application relates to a pharmaceutical composition comprising (a) a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; and (b) a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
In certain embodiments, this application relates to a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising any one of the foregoing, for use as a medicament.
In certain embodiments, this application relates to a method of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition mediated by orexin receptor activity in a subject in need of such treatment, comprising administering to the subject an effective amount of at least one compound according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising any one of the foregoing.
In certain embodiments, this application relates to a method of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a subject in need of such treatment, comprising administering to the subject an effective amount of at least one compound according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising any one of the foregoing. In certain such
embodiments, the disease, disorder or medical condition mediated by orexin receptor activity is eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder,
schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, headache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease. In certain such embodiments, the drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine.
In certain embodiments, this application relates to the use of a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of the foregoing, in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of diseases, disorders, and medical conditions regulated by orexin receptor activity, and the use of such compounds for treatment of such diseases and medical conditions.
In certain embodiments, this application relates to the use of a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of the foregoing, in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of diseases, disorders, and medical conditions, and the use of such compounds for treatment of such diseases, disorder, and medical conditions. In certain such embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post- traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, headache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease. In certain such embodiments, the drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine. In certain such embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease,
Huntington’s chorea, pain, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, and psychosexual disorder. In certain embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune- related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine- related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
As discussed above, there is a need in the field for compounds with more favorable metabolic stability and half lives. Certain embodiments of this application provide compounds found to have such advantages.
In certain embodiments, this application relates to a method of modulating the activity of an orexin receptor OX1, OX2, or both, comprising contacting a cell comprising the orexin receptor with an effective amount of at least one compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of the foregoing. In certain such embodiments, the contacting is in vitro, ex vivo, or in vivo.
In certain embodiments, this application relates to a method of treating a disease or disorder in a subject, (e.g., a patient) in need thereof, comprising administering a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of the foregoing, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post- traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, headache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease. In certain such embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, pain, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, and psychosexual disorder. In certain such embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is selected from the group consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea,
gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
In certain such embodiments, disease or disorder is selected from the group consisting of drug abuse or addiction, panic disorder, anxiety, post-traumatic stress disorder, pain, depression, seasonal affective disorder, an eating disorder, and hypertension. In certain such embodiments, the drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine.
Those skilled in the art will recognize that the species listed or illustrated herein are not exhaustive, and that additional species within the scope of these defined terms may also be selected.
The application also includes pharmaceutically acceptable prodrugs, salts, solvates, such as hydrates, of the compounds represented by Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), preferably of those described above and of the specific compounds exemplified herein, and pharmaceutical compositions comprising such prodrugs, salts, or solvates, such as hydrates, and methods of using such salts or hydrates.
The present application also relates to pharmaceutically active metabolites of compounds described herein, and uses of such metabolites in the methods of the application.
Definitions
The definitions set forth in this application are intended to clarify terms used throughout this application. Unless defined otherwise, all technical and scientific terms used herein have the same meaning as is commonly understood by one of ordinary skill in the art to which this invention belongs. All patents, applications, published applications and other publications referred to herein are incorporated by reference in their entireties to disclose and describe the methods and/or materials in connection with which the publications are cited. If a definition set forth in this section is contrary to or otherwise inconsistent with a definition set forth in a patent, application, or other publication that is herein incorporated by reference, the definition set forth in this section prevails over the definition incorporated herein by reference. Although any methods and materials similar or equivalent to those described herein can also be used in the practice or testing of the embodiments in present application, the preferred methods and materials are now described.
To provide a more concise description, some of the quantitative expressions given herein are not qualified with the term“about.” It is understood that, whether the term“about” is used explicitly or not, every quantity given herein is meant to refer to the actual given value, and it is also meant to refer to the approximation to such given value that would reasonably be inferred based on the ordinary skill in the art, including equivalents and approximations due to the experimental and/or measurement conditions for such given value. Whenever a yield is given as a percentage, such yield refers to a mass of the entity for which the yield is given with respect to the maximum amount of the same entity that could be obtained under the particular
stoichiometric conditions. Concentrations that are given as percentages refer to mass ratios, unless indicated differently.
Except as otherwise noted, the methods and techniques of the present embodiments are generally performed according to conventional methods well known in the art and as described in various general and more specific references that are cited and discussed throughout the present specification. See, e.g., Loudon, Organic Chemistry, Fourth Edition, New York: Oxford University Press, 2002, pp.360-361, 1084-1085; Smith and March, March’s Advanced Organic Chemistry: Reactions, Mechanisms, and Structure, Fifth Edition, Wiley-Interscience, 2001.
The nomenclature used herein to name the subject compounds is illustrated in the Examples herein. This nomenclature has generally been derived using the commercially- available ChemBioDraw Ultra software (Cambridgesoft/Perkin Elmer), Version 12.0.
It is to be understood that the present description is not limited to particular embodiments described, as such may, of course, vary. It is also to be understood that the terminology used herein is for the purpose of describing particular embodiments only, and is not intended to be limiting, since the scope of the present application will be limited only by the appended claims.
It is appreciated that certain features of the application, which are, for clarity, described in the context of separate embodiments, may also be provided in combination in a single embodiment. Conversely, various features of the application, which are, for brevity, described in the context of a single embodiment, may also be provided separately or in any suitable subcombination. All combinations of the embodiments pertaining to the chemical groups represented by the variables are specifically embraced by the present application and are disclosed herein just as if each and every combination was individually and explicitly disclosed, to the extent that such combinations embrace compounds that are stable compounds (i.e., compounds that can be isolated, characterized, and tested for biological activity). In addition, all subcombinations of the chemical groups listed in the embodiments describing such variables are also specifically embraced by the present application and are disclosed herein just as if each and every such sub-combination of chemical groups was individually and explicitly disclosed herein.
Any formula depicted herein is intended to represent a compound of that structural formula as well as certain variations or forms. For example, a formula given herein is intended to include a racemic form, or one or more enantiomeric, diastereomeric, or geometric isomers, or tautomeric forms, or a mixture thereof. Additionally, any formula given herein is intended to refer also to a solvate, such as a hydrate, solvate, or polymorph of such a compound, or a mixture thereof. Any formula given herein is intended to refer to amorphous and/or crystalline physical forms of the compound. The compounds described herein may be analytically pure, or a mixture in which the compound comprises at least 50%, at least 70%, at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, or at least 98% by weight of the mixture.
In addition, where features or aspects of the embodiments of this application are described in terms of Markush groups, those skilled in the art will recognize that embodiments described herein is also thereby described in terms of any individual member or subgroup of members of the Markush group. For example, if X is described as selected from the group consisting of bromine, chlorine, and iodine, claims for X being bromine and claims for X being bromine and chlorine are fully described.
The term "herein" refers to the entire application.
As used herein, the singular forms“a,”“an,” and“the” include plural referents unless the context clearly dictates otherwise. It is further noted that the claims may be drafted to exclude any optional element. As such, this statement is intended to serve as antecedent basis for use of such exclusive terminology as“solely,”“only” and the like in connection with the recitation of claim elements, or use of a“negative” limitation.
As used herein, the terms“including,”“containing,” and“comprising” are used in their open, non-limiting sense.
As used herein,“subject” (as in the subject of the treatment) refers to both mammals and non-mammals. Mammals include, for example, humans; non-human primates, e.g. apes and monkeys; and non-primates, e.g. mice, rats, rabbits, dogs, cats, cattle, horses, sheep, and goats. Non-mammals include, for example, worms, fish and birds. In some embodiments, the subject is a human.
"Substantially" as the term is used herein refers to being completely or almost completely; for example, a composition that is "substantially free" of a component either has none of the component or contains such a trace amount that any relevant functional property of the composition is unaffected by the presence of the trace amount, or a compound is
"substantially pure" is there are only negligible traces of impurities present.
The term“acyl” is art-recognized and refers to a group represented by the general formula hydrocarbylC(O)-, preferably alkylC(O)-.
The term“acylamino” is art-recognized and refers to an amino group substituted with an acyl group and may be represented, for example, by the formula hydrocarbylC(O)NH-.
The term“acyloxy” is art-recognized and refers to a group represented by the general formula hydrocarbylC(O)O-, preferably alkylC(O)O-.
The term“alkoxy” refers to an alkyl group, preferably a lower alkyl group, having an oxygen attached thereto. Representative alkoxy groups include methoxy, ethoxy, propoxy, tert- butoxy and the like.
The term“alkoxyalkyl” refers to an alkyl group substituted with an alkoxy group and may be represented by the general formula alkyl-O-alkyl.
The term“alkenyl”, as used herein, refers to an aliphatic group containing at least one double bond and is intended to include both "unsubstituted alkenyls" and "substituted alkenyls", the latter of which refers to alkenyl moieties having substituents replacing a hydrogen on one or more carbons of the alkenyl group. Such substituents may occur on one or more carbons that are included or not included in one or more double bonds. Moreover, such substituents include all those contemplated for alkyl groups, as discussed below, except where stability is prohibitive. For example, substitution of alkenyl groups by one or more alkyl, carbocyclyl, aryl,
heterocyclyl, or heteroaryl groups is contemplated.
The term“alkynyl”, as used herein, refers to an aliphatic group containing at least one triple bond and is intended to include both "unsubstituted alkynyls" and "substituted alkynyls", the latter of which refers to alkynyl moieties having substituents replacing one or more hydrogens on one or more carbons of the alkynyl group. Such substituents may occur on one or more carbons that are included or not included in one or more triple bonds. Moreover, such substituents include all those contemplated for alkyl groups, as discussed above, except where stability is prohibitive. For example, substitution of alkynyl groups by one or more alkyl, carbocyclyl, aryl, heterocyclyl, or heteroaryl groups is contemplated.
An“alkyl” group or“alkane” is a straight chained or branched non-aromatic
hydrocarbon which is completely saturated. Typically, a straight chained or branched alkyl group has from 1 to about 20 carbon atoms, such as from 1 to 12 carbon atoms, preferably from 1 to about 10, more preferably from 1 to 4, unless otherwise defined. Examples of straight chained and branched alkyl groups include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, sec-butyl, tert-butyl, pentyl, isopentyl, tert-pentyl, hexyl, isohexyl, pentyl and octyl. A C1-C6 straight chained or branched alkyl group is also referred to as a "lower alkyl" group.
Moreover, the term "alkyl" (or "lower alkyl") as used throughout the specification, examples, and claims is intended to include both "unsubstituted alkyls" and "substituted alkyls", the latter of which refers to alkyl moieties having substituents replacing a hydrogen or more hydrogens on one or more carbons of the hydrocarbon backbone. Such substituents, if not otherwise specified, can include, for example, a halogen (such as F, Cl, Br, or I), a hydroxyl, a carbonyl (such as a carboxyl, an alkoxycarbonyl, a formyl, or an acyl), a thiocarbonyl (such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate), an alkoxyl, a phosphoryl, a phosphate, a phosphonate, a phosphinate, an amino, an amido, an amidine, an imine, a cyano, a nitro, an azido, a sulfhydryl, an alkylthio, a sulfate, a sulfonate, a sulfamoyl, a sulfonamido, a sulfonyl, a heterocyclyl, an aralkyl, or an aromatic or heteroaromatic moiety. It will be understood by those skilled in the art that the moieties substituted on the hydrocarbon chain can themselves be substituted, if appropriate. For instance, the substituents of a substituted alkyl may include substituted and unsubstituted forms of amino, azido, imino, amido, phosphoryl (including phosphonate and phosphinate), sulfonyl (including sulfate, sulfonamido, sulfamoyl and sulfonate), and silyl groups, as well as ethers, alkylthios, carbonyls (including ketones, aldehydes, carboxylates, and esters), haloalkyls (such as -CF3, -CHF2, -CH2F,), -CN, and the like. Exemplary substituted alkyls are described below. Cycloalkyls can be further substituted with alkyls, alkenyls, alkoxys, alkylthios, aminoalkyls, carbonyl-substituted alkyls, haloalkyls (such as -CF3, -CHF2, -CH2F), -CN, and the like.
The term“(ATOM)i-j” with j > i, when used in conjunction with a chemical moiety, such as, acyl, acyloxy, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, or alkoxy is meant to include groups that contain from i to j (including i and j) atoms. For example, the term“Cx-yalkyl” refers to substituted or unsubstituted saturated hydrocarbon groups, including straight-chain alkyl and branched-chain alkyl groups that contain from x to y carbons in the chain, including haloalkyl groups such as - CF3, -CHF2, -CH2F, or 2,2,2-tirfluoroethyl, etc. C0 alkyl refers to a hydrogen atom where the group is in a terminal position, a bond if internal. Similarly, for example, C3-6cycloalkyl refers to a cycloalkyl as defined herein that has 3 to 6 carbon ring atoms. The terms“C2-yalkenyl” and “C2-yalkynyl” refer to substituted or unsubstituted unsaturated aliphatic groups analogous in length and possible substitution to the alkyls described above, but that contain at least one double or triple bond respectively.
The term“alkylamino”, as used herein, refers to an amino group substituted with at least one alkyl group.
The term“alkylthio”, as used herein, refers to a thiol group substituted with an alkyl group and may be represented by the general formula alkylS-.
The term“hydrocarbyl”, as used herein, refers to a group that is bonded through a carbon atom that does not have a =O or =S substituent, and typically has at least one carbon-hydrogen bond and a primarily carbon backbone, but may optionally include heteroatoms. Thus, groups like methyl, ethoxyethyl, 2-pyridyl, and trifluoromethyl are considered to be hydrocarbyl for the purposes of this application, but substituents such as acetyl (which has a =O substituent on the linking carbon) and ethoxy (which is linked through oxygen, not carbon) are not. Hydrocarbyl groups include, but are not limited to aryl, heteroaryl, carbocycle, heterocyclyl, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and combinations thereof.
The terms“amine” and“amino” are art-recognized and refer to both unsubstituted and substituted amines and salts thereof, e.g., a moiety that can be represented by
Figure imgf000051_0001
wherein each R30 independently represents a hydrogen or a hydrocarbyl group, or two R30 are taken together with the N atom to which they are attached complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
The term“aminoalkyl”, as used herein, refers to an alkyl group substituted with an amino group.
The term“amide”, as used herein, refers to a group:
Figure imgf000051_0002
, wherein each R30 independently represent a hydrogen or hydrocarbyl group, or two R30 are taken together with the N atom to which they are attached complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
“carbamate” is art-recognized and refers to a group
Figure imgf000051_0003
wherein R29 and R30 independently represent hydrogen or a hydrocarbyl group, such as an alkyl group, or R29 and R30 taken together with the intervening atom(s) complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
The term“halogen,” or“halide” represents chlorine, fluorine, bromine, or iodine. The term“halo” represents fluoro, chloro, bromo, or iodo.
The term“haloalkyl”, as used herein, refers to an alkyl group with one or more halo substituents, or one, two, or three halo substituents. Examples of haloalkyl groups include–CF3, -CH2F, -CHF2, -CH2Br, -CH2CF3, and–CH2CH2F.
The term“heteroatom”, as used herein, refers to an atom of any element other than carbon or hydrogen. Exemplary heteroatoms include but are not limited to nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur.
The term“heteroalkyl”, as used herein, refers to a saturated or unsaturated chain of carbon atoms and at least one heteroatom, wherein no two heteroatoms are adjacent.
The term“aryl”, as used herein, includes substituted or unsubstituted monocyclic aromatic rings in which each atom of the ring is carbon. Preferably the ring is a 5- to 7- membered ring, more preferably a 6-membered ring. The term“aryl” also includes polycyclic ring systems having two or more cyclic rings in which two or more carbons are common to two adjoining rings wherein at least one of the rings is aromatic, e.g., the other cyclic rings can be cycloalkyls, cycloalkenyls, cycloalkynyls, aryls, heteroaryls, and/or heterocyclyls. Aryl groups include benzene, naphthalene, phenanthrene, phenol, aniline, and the like.
The term“aralkyl”, as used herein, refers to an alkyl group substituted with an aryl group.
An“aroyl” group, as the term is used herein, refers to an aryl group bonded via an exocyclic carbonyl group, such as a benzoyl group.
The term“heteroaryl” , as used herein, includes substituted or unsubstituted monocyclic aromatic ring system, preferably 5- to 7-membered aromatic rings, more preferably 5- to 6- membered rings, whose ring structures include at least one heteroatom, preferably one to four heteroatoms, more preferably one to two heteroatoms. For example, a 5-membered heteroaryl is furan, thiophene, pyrrole, oxazole, isoxazole, thiazole, isothiazole, pyrazole, imidazole, oxadiazole, thiadiazole, triazole, or tetrazole. In another example, a 6-membered heteroaryl is pyridine, pyrazine, pyrimidine, pyridazine, or triazine. The term“heteroaryl” also include substituted or unsubstituted“polycyclic” ring systems having two or more cyclic rings in which two or more carbons are common to two adjoining rings wherein at least one of the rings is heteroaromatic, e.g., the other cyclic rings can be cycloalkyls, cycloalkenyls, cycloalkynyls, aryls, heteroaryls, and/or heterocyclyls.
Illustrative examples of heteroaryl groups include but are not limited to the following entities, in the form of properly bonded moieties:
Figure imgf000052_0001
The term“heteroaralkyl” or“hetaralkyl”, as used herein, refers to an alkyl group substituted with a heteroaryl group. A“heteroaroyl” group, as the term is used herein, refers to a heteroaryl group bonded via an exocyclic carbonyl group, analogous to a benzoyl group but wherein the phenyl ring of the benzoyl group is replaced by a heteroaryl group.
The terms“heterocyclyl”,“heterocycle”, and“heterocyclic”, as used herein, refer to substituted or unsubstituted non-aromatic ring structures, preferably 3- to 10-membered rings, more preferably 3- to 7-membered rings, whose ring structures include at least one heteroatom, preferably one to four heteroatoms, more preferably one or two heteroatoms. The terms “heterocyclyl” and“heterocyclic” also include substituted or unsubstituted polycyclic ring systems having two or more cyclic rings in which two or more carbons are common to two adjoining rings wherein at least one of the rings is heterocyclic, e.g., the other cyclic rings can be cycloalkyls, cycloalkenyls, cycloalkynyls, aryls, heteroaryls, and/or heterocyclyls. Heterocyclyl groups include, for example, piperidine, piperazine, pyrrolidine, morpholine, lactones, lactams, and the like.
The term“heterocyclylalkyl”, as used herein, refers to an alkyl group substituted with a heterocycle group which is optionally substituted.
The terms“carbocycle”, and“carbocyclic”, as used herein, refers to a saturated or unsaturated ring in which each atom of the ring is carbon. The term carbocycle includes both aromatic carbocycles and non-aromatic carbocycles. Non-aromatic carbocycles include both cycloalkane rings, in which all carbon atoms are saturated, and cycloalkene rings, which contain at least one double bond.“Carbocycle” includes 5-7 membered monocyclic and 8-12 membered bicyclic rings. Each ring of a bicyclic carbocycle may be selected from saturated, unsaturated and aromatic rings. Carbocycle includes bicyclic molecules in which one, two or three or more atoms are shared between the two rings. The term“fused carbocycle” refers to a bicyclic carbocycle in which each of the rings shares two adjacent atoms with the other ring. Each ring of a fused carbocycle may be selected from saturated, unsaturated and aromatic rings. In an exemplary embodiment, an aromatic ring, e.g., phenyl, may be fused to a saturated or unsaturated ring, e.g., cyclohexane, cyclopentane, or cyclohexene. Any combination of saturated, unsaturated and aromatic bicyclic rings, as valence permits, is included in the definition of carbocyclic. Exemplary“carbocycles” include cyclopentane, cyclohexane, bicyclo[2.2.1]heptane, 1,5-cyclooctadiene, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphthalene, bicyclo[4.2.0]oct-3- ene, naphthalene and adamantane. Exemplary fused carbocycles include decalin, naphthalene, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydronaphthalene, bicyclo[4.2.0]octane, 4,5,6,7-tetrahydro-1H-indene and bicyclo[4.1.0]hept-3-ene.“Carbocycles” may be susbstituted at any one or more positions capable of bearing a hydrogen atom.
A“cycloalkyl” group, as used herein, refers to a cyclic hydrocarbon which is completely saturated.“Cycloalkyl” includes monocyclic and bicyclic rings. Typically, a monocyclic cycloalkyl group has from 3 to about 10 carbon atoms, more typically 3 to 8 carbon atoms unless otherwise defined. The second ring of a bicyclic cycloalkyl may be selected from saturated, unsaturated and aromatic rings. Cycloalkyl includes bicyclic molecules in which one, two or three or more atoms are shared between the two rings. The term“fused cycloalkyl” refers to a bicyclic cycloalkyl in which each of the rings shares two adjacent atoms with the other ring. The second ring of a fused bicyclic cycloalkyl may be selected from saturated, unsaturated and aromatic rings.
The term“carbocyclylalkyl”, as used herein, refers to an alkyl group substituted with a carbocycle group.
A“cycloalkenyl” group, as used herein, refers to a cyclic hydrocarbon containing one or more double bonds. A“cycloalkynyl” group is a cyclic hydrocarbon containing one or more triple bonds.
The terms“polycyclyl”,“polycycle”, and“polycyclic”, as used herein, refer to two or more rings (e.g., cycloalkyls, cycloalkenyls, cycloalkynyls, aryls, heteroaryls, and/or heterocyclyls) in which two or more atoms are common to two adjoining rings, e.g., the rings are“fused rings”. Each of the rings of the polycycle can be substituted or unsubstituted. In certain embodiments, each ring of the polycycle contains from 3 to 10 atoms in the ring, preferably from 5 to 7.
The term“carbonate” is art-recognized and refers to a group -OCO2-R30, wherein R30 represents a hydrocarbyl group.
The term“carboxy”, as used herein, refers to a group represented by the formula -CO2H. The term“ester”, as used herein, refers to a group -C(O)OR30 wherein R30 represents a hydrocarbyl group.
The term“ether,” as used herein, refers to a hydrocarbyl group linked through an oxygen to another hydrocarbyl group. Accordingly, an ether substituent of a hydrocarbyl group may be hydrocarbyl-O-. Ethers may be either symmetrical or unsymmetrical. Examples of ethers include, but are not limited to, heterocycle-O-heterocycle and aryl-O-heterocycle. Ethers include “alkoxyalkyl” groups, which may be represented by the general formula alkyl-O-alkyl. The term“sulfate” is art-recognized and refers to the group -OSO3H, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
The term“sulfonamide” is art-recognized and refers to the group represented by the
general formulae
Figure imgf000055_0001
, wherein R29 and R30 independently represents hydrogen or hydrocarbyl, such as alkyl, or R29 and R30 taken together with the intervening atom(s) complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
The term“sulfoxide” is art-recognized and refers to the group -S(O)-R30, wherein R30 represents a hydrocarbyl.
The term“sulfonate” is art-recognized and refers to the group SO3H, or a
pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
The term“sulfone” is art-recognized and refers to the group -S(O)2-R30, wherein R30 represents a hydrocarbyl.
The term“thioalkyl”, as used herein, refers to an alkyl group substituted with a thiol group.
The term“thioester”, as used herein, refers to a group -C(O)SR30 or -SC(O)R30 wherein R30 represents a hydrocarbyl.
The term“thioether”, as used herein, is equivalent to an ether, wherein the oxygen is replaced with asulfur.
The term“urea” is art-recognized and may be represented by the general formula
Figure imgf000055_0002
, wherein R29 and R30 independently represent hydrogen or a hydrocarbyl, such as alkyl, or either occurrence of R29 taken together with R30 and the intervening atom(s) complete a heterocycle having from 4 to 8 atoms in the ring structure.
The term“substituted”, as used herein, refers to moieties having substituents replacing one or more hydrogens on one or more carbons of the backbone. It will be understood that “substitution” or“substituted with” includes the implicit proviso that such substitution is in accordance with permitted valence of the substituted atom and the substituent, and that the substitution results in a stable compound, e.g., which does not spontaneously undergo transformation such as by rearrangement, cyclization, elimination, etc. As used herein, the term “substituted” is contemplated to include all permissible substituents of organic compounds. In a broad aspect, the permissible substituents include acyclic and cyclic, branched and unbranched, carbocyclic and heterocyclic, aromatic and non-aromatic substituents of organic compounds. The permissible substituents can be one or more and the same or different for appropriate organic compounds. For purposes of this application, the heteroatoms such as nitrogen may have hydrogen substituents and/or any permissible substituents of organic compounds described herein which satisfy the valences of the heteroatoms. In some embodiments,“substituted” means that the specified group or moiety bears one, two, or three substituents. In other embodiments, “substituted” means that the specified group or moiety bears one or two substituents. In still other embodiments,“substituted” refers to the specified group or moiety bears one substituent.
Substituents can include any substituents described herein, for example, a halogen, a hydroxyl, a carbonyl (such as a carboxyl, an alkoxycarbonyl, a formyl, or an acyl), a
thiocarbonyl (such as a thioester, a thioacetate, or a thioformate), an alkoxyl, a phosphoryl, a phosphate, a phosphonate, a phosphinate, an amino, an amido, an amidine, an imine, a cyano, a nitro, an azido, a sulfhydryl, an alkylthio, a sulfate, a sulfonate, a sulfamoyl, a sulfonamido, a sulfonyl, a heterocyclyl, an aralkyl, or an aromatic or heteroaromatic moiety. It will be understood by those skilled in the art that substituents can themselves be substituted, if appropriate.
Unless specifically stated as“unsubstituted,” references to chemical moieties herein are understood to include substituted variants. For example, reference to an“aryl” group or moiety implicitly includes both substituted and unsubstituted variants. The term“unsubstituted” refers to that the specified group bears no substituents.
The term“optionally substituted”, as used herein, means that substitution is optional and therefore it is possible for the designated atom or moiety to be unsubstituted.
Any disubstituent referred to herein is meant to encompass the various attachment possibilities when more than one of such possibilities are allowed. For example, reference to disubstituent -A-B-, where A≠ B, refers herein to such disubstituent with A attached to a first substituted member and B attached to a second substituted member, and it also refers to such disubstituent with A attached to the second substituted member and B attached to the first substituted member.
“Protecting group”, as used herein, refers to a group of atoms that, when attached to a reactive functional group in a molecule, mask, reduce or prevent the reactivity of the functional group. Typically, a protecting group may be selectively removed as desired during the course of a synthesis. Examples of protecting groups can be found in Greene and Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry, 3rd Ed., 1999, John Wiley & Sons, NY and Harrison et al., Compendium of Synthetic Organic Methods, Vols.1-8, 1971-1996, John Wiley & Sons, NY. Representative nitrogen protecting groups include, but are not limited to, formyl, acetyl, trifluoroacetyl, benzyl, benzyloxycarbonyl (“CBZ”), tert-butoxycarbonyl (“Boc”), trimethylsilyl (“TMS”), 2- trimethylsilyl-ethanesulfonyl (“TES”), trityl and substituted trityl groups, allyloxycarbonyl, 9- fluorenylmethyloxycarbonyl (“FMOC”), nitro-veratryloxycarbonyl (“NVOC”) and the like. Representative hydroxylprotecting groups include, but are not limited to, those where the hydroxyl group is either acylated (esterified) or alkylated such as benzyl and trityl ethers, as well as alkyl ethers, tetrahydropyranyl ethers, trialkylsilyl ethers (e.g., TMS or TIPS groups), glycol ethers, such as ethylene glycol and propylene glycol derivatives and allyl ethers.
The term "pharmaceutically acceptable" is employed herein to refer to those compounds, materials, compositions, and/or dosage forms which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of human beings and animals without excessive toxicity, irritation, allergic response, or other problem or complication, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
A“pharmaceutically acceptable salt” is intended to mean a salt of a free acid or base of a compound represented herein that is non-toxic, biologically tolerable, or otherwise biologically suitable for administration to the subject. See, generally, S.M. Berge, et al.,“Pharmaceutical Salts,” J. Pharm. Sci., 1977, 66, 1-19. Preferred pharmaceutically acceptable salts are those that are pharmacologically effective and suitable for contact with the tissues of subjects without undue toxicity, irritation, or allergic response. A compound described herein may possess a sufficiently acidic group, a sufficiently basic group, both types of functional groups, or more than one of each type, and accordingly react with a number of inorganic or organic bases, and inorganic and organic acids, to form a pharmaceutically acceptable salt.
For a compound described herein that contains a basic group, such as an amine, a pharmaceutically acceptable salt may be prepared by any suitable method available in the art, for example, treatment of the free base with an inorganic acid, such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, sulfamic acid, nitric acid, boric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like, or with an organic acid, such as acetic acid, phenylacetic acid, propionic acid, stearic acid, lactic acid, ascorbic acid, maleic acid, hydroxymaleic acid, isethionic acid, succinic acid, valeric acid, fumaric acid, malonic acid, pyruvic acid, oxalic acid, glycolic acid, salicylic acid, oleic acid, palmitic acid, lauric acid, a pyranosidyl acid, such as glucuronic acid or galacturonic acid, an alpha-hydroxy acid, such as mandelic acid, citric acid, or tartaric acid, an amino acid, such as aspartic acid or glutamic acid, an aromatic acid, such as benzoic acid, 2-acetoxybenzoic acid, naphthoic acid, or cinnamic acid, a sulfonic acid, such as laurylsulfonic acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, methanesulfonic acid, or ethanesulfonic acid, or any compatible mixture of acids such as those given as examples herein, and any other acid and mixture thereof that are regarded as equivalents or acceptable substitutes in light of the ordinary level of skill in this technology.
For a compound described herein that contains an acidic group, such as a carboxylic acid group, base addition salts can be prepared by any suitable method available in the art, for example, treatment of such compound with a sufficient amount of the desired the desired base, either neat or in a suitable inert solvent. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable base addition salts include, but are not limited to, lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, ammonium, zinc, or magnesium salt, or other metal salts; organic amino salts, such as, alkyl, dialkyl, trialkyl, or tetra-alkyl ammonium salts.
Other examples of pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, but are not limited to, camsylate, sulfates, pyrosulfates, bisulfates, sulfites, bisulfites, phosphates, monohydrogen- phosphates, dihydrogenphosphates, metaphosphates, pyrophosphates, chlorides, bromides, iodides, acetates, propionates, decanoates, caprylates, acrylates, formates, isobutyrates, caproates, heptanoates, propiolates, oxalates, malonates, succinates, suberates, sebacates, fumarates, maleates, butyne-1,4-dioates, hexyne-1,6-dioates, benzoates, chlorobenzoates, methylbenzoates, dinitrobenzoates, hydroxybenzoates, methoxybenzoates, phthalates, sulfonates, methylsulfonates, propylsulfonates, besylates, xylenesulfonates, naphthalene-1- sulfonates, naphthalene-2-sulfonates, phenylacetates, phenylpropionates, phenylbutyrates, citrates, lactates, γ-hydroxybutyrates, glycolates, tartrates, and mandelates. Lists of other suitable pharmaceutically acceptable salts are found in Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 17th Edition, Mack Publishing Company, Easton, Pa., 1985.
The neutral forms of the compounds are preferably regenerated by contacting the salt with a base or acid and isolating the parent compound in the conventional manner. The parent form of the compound differs from the various salt forms in certain physical properties, such as solubility in polar solvents, but otherwise the salts are equivalent to the parent form of the compound for the purposes of the present application. The term“prodrug” is intended to encompass compounds which, under physiologic conditions, are converted into the therapeutically active agents of the present application, e.g., a compound of described herein. A common method for making a prodrug is to include one or more selected moieties which are hydrolyzed under physiologic conditions to yield the desired molecule. In certain embodiments, the prodrug is converted by an enzymatic activity of the host animal. For example, a prodrug with a nitro group on an aromatic ring could be reduced by reductase to generate the desired amino group of the corresponding active compound in vivo. In another example, functional groups such as a hydroxyl, carbonate, or carboxylic acid in the parent compound are presented as an ester, which could be cleaved by esterases. Additionally, amine groups in the parent compounds are presented in, but not limited to, carbamate, N- alkylated or N-acylated forms (Simplício et al,“Prodrugs for Amines,” Molecules, (2008), 13:519-547). In certain embodiments, some or all of the compounds of described herein in a formulation represented above can be replaced with the corresponding suitable prodrug.
A "pharmaceutically acceptable prodrug” is a prodrug that is non-toxic, biologically tolerable, and otherwise biologically suitable for administration to the subject. Illustrative procedures for the selection and preparation of suitable prodrug derivatives are described, for example, in“Design of Prodrugs”, ed. H. Bundgaard, Elsevier, 1985.
A“pharmaceutically active metabolite” or“metabolite” refers to a pharmacologically active product of metabolism/biochemical modification of a compound described herein, e.g., a compound of Formula (I), (Ia), or (Ib) or salt thereof, under physiological conditions, e.g., through certain enzymatic pathway. For example, an oxidative metabolite is formed by oxidation of the parent compound during metabolism, such as the oxidation of a pyridine ring to pyridine-N-oxide. In another example, an oxidative metabolite is formed by demethylation of a methoxy group to result in a hydroxyl group.
Prodrugs and active metabolites of a compound may be determined using routine techniques known or available in the art. See, e.g., Bertolini et al., J. Med. Chem.1997, 40, 2011-2016; Shan et al., J. Pharm. Sci.1997, 86 (7), 765-767; Bagshawe, Drug Dev. Res.1995, 34, 220-230; Bodor, Adv. Drug Res.1984, 13, 255-331; Bundgaard, Design of Prodrugs (Elsevier Press, 1985); and Larsen, Design and Application of Prodrugs, Drug Design and Development (Krogsgaard-Larsen et al., eds., Harwood Academic Publishers, 1991).
Compounds of formulae (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), and (Va), as disclosed herein, can also exist as various“solvates” or“hydrates.” A“hydrate” is a compound that exists in a composition with water molecules. The composition can include water in stoichiometric quantities, such as a monohydrate or a dihydrate, or can include water in random amounts. A“solvate” is a similar composition except that a solvent other that water, such as with methanol, ethanol, dimethylformamide, diethyl ether and the like replaces the water. For example, methanol or ethanol can form an“alcoholate,"” which can again be stoichiometic or non- stoichiometric. Mixtures of such solvates or hydrates can also be prepared. The source of such solvate or hydrate can be from the solvent of crystallization, inherent in the solvent of preparation or crystallization, or adventitious to such solvent.
The compounds of the application, including their pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs, can exist as various polymorphs, pseudo-polymorphs, or in amorphous state. The term “polymorph”, as used herein, refers to different crystalline forms of the same compound and other solid state molecular forms including pseudo-polymorphs, such as hydrates, solvates, or salts of the same compound. Different crystalline polymorphs have different crystal structures due to a different packing of molecules in the lattice, as a result of changes in temperature, pressure, or variations in the crystallization process. Polymorphs differ from each other in their physical properties, such as x-ray diffraction characteristics, stability, melting points, solubility, or rates of dissolution in certain solvents. Thus crystalline polymorphic forms are important aspects in the development of suitable dosage forms in pharmaceutical industry.
The present application further embraces isolated compounds according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va). The term“isolated compound” refers to a preparation of a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a mixture of compounds according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), wherein the isolated compound has been separated from the reagents used, and/or byproducts formed, in the synthesis of the compound or compounds.“Isolated” does not mean that the preparation is technically pure (homogeneous), but it is sufficiently pure to compound in a form in which it can be used therapeutically. Preferably an“isolated compound” refers to a preparation of a compound of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) or a mixture of compounds according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), which contains the named compound or mixture of compounds according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) in an amount of at least 10 percent by weight of the total weight. Preferably the preparation contains the named compound or mixture of compounds in an amount of at least 50% by weight of the total weight; more preferably at least 80% by weight of the total weight; and most preferably at least 90%, at least 95% or at least 98% by weight of the total weight of the preparation.
The compounds of the application and intermediates may be isolated from their reaction mixtures and purified by standard techniques such as filtration, liquid-liquid extraction, solid phase extraction, distillation, recrystallization or chromatography, including flash column chromatography, or HPLC.
Isomerism and Tautomerism in Described Compounds
Tautomerism
Within the present application it is to be understood that a compound described herein or a salt thereof may exhibit the phenomenon of tautomerism whereby two chemical compounds that are capable of facile interconversion by exchanging a hydrogen atom between two atoms, to either of which it forms a covalent bond. Since the tautomeric compounds exist in mobile equilibrium with each other they may be regarded as different isomeric forms of the same compound. It is to be understood that the formulae drawings within this specification can represent only one of the possible tautomeric forms. However, it is also to be understood that the application encompasses any tautomeric form, and is not to be limited merely to any one tautomeric form utilized within the formulae drawings. The formulae drawings within this specification can represent only one of the possible tautomeric forms and it is to be understood that the specification encompasses all possible tautomeric forms of the compounds drawn not just those forms which it has been convenient to show graphically herein. For example, tautomerism may be exhibited by a pyrazolyl group bonded as indicated by the wavy line. While both substituents would be termed a 4-pyrazolyl group, it is evident that a different nitrogen atom bears the hydrogen atom in each structure.
Figure imgf000061_0001
Such tautomerism can also occur with substituted pyrazoles such as 3-methyl, 5-methyl, or 3,5-dimethylpyrazoles, and the like. Another example of tautomerism is amido-imido (lactam-lactim when cyclic) tautomerism, such as is seen in heterocyclic compounds bearing a ring oxygen atom adjacent to a ring nitrogen atom. For example, the equilibrium:
Figure imgf000062_0001
is an example of tautomerism. Accordingly, a structure depicted herein as one tautomer is intended to also include the other tautomer.
Optical Isomerism
It will be understood that when compounds of the present application contain one or more chiral centers, the compounds may exist in, and may be isolated as pure enantiomeric or diastereomeric forms or as racemic mixtures. The present application therefore includes any possible enantiomers, diastereomers, racemates in their pure forms or mixtures thereof, and salts thereof, of the compounds of the application.
The isomers resulting from the presence of a chiral center comprise a pair of
non-superimposable isomers that are called“enantiomers.” Single enantiomers of a pure compound are optically active, i.e., they are capable of rotating the plane of plane polarized light. Single enantiomers are designated according to the Cahn-Ingold-Prelog system. The priority of substituents is ranked based on atomic weights, a higher atomic weight, as determined by the systematic procedure, having a higher priority ranking. Once the priority ranking of the four groups is determined, the molecule is oriented so that the lowest ranking group is pointed away from the viewer. Then, if the descending rank order of the other groups proceeds clockwise, the molecule is designated (R) and if the descending rank of the other groups proceeds counterclockwise, the molecule is designated (S). In the example in Scheme 14, the Cahn-Ingold-Prelog ranking is A > B > C > D. The lowest ranking atom, D is oriented away from the viewer.
Figure imgf000062_0002
(R) configuration (S) configuration
In certain embodiments, the therapeutic preparation may be enriched to provide predominantly one enantiomer of a compound (e.g., of formula (I), (Ia), or (Ib)). An
enantiomerically enriched mixture may comprise, for example, at least 60 mol percent of one enantiomer, or more preferably at least 75, 90, 95, or even 99 mol percent. In certain
embodiments, a compound of the invention may have greater than 30% ee, 40% ee, 50% ee, 60% ee, 70% ee, 80% ee, 90% ee, or even 95% or greater ee. In certain embodiments, the compound enriched in one enantiomer is substantially free of the other enantiomer, wherein substantially free means that the substance in question makes up less than 10%, or less than 5%, or less than 4%, or less than 3%, or less than 2%, or less than 1% as compared to the amount of the other enantiomer, e.g., in the composition or compound mixture. For example, if a composition or compound mixture contains 98 grams of a first enantiomer and 2 grams of a second enantiomer, it would be said to contain 98 mol percent of the first enantiomer and only 2% of the second enantiomer.
In certain embodiments, compounds of the application may have more than one stereocenter. In certain such embodiments, compounds of the application may be enriched in one or more diastereomer. For example, a compound of the application may have greater than 30% de, 40% de, 50% de, 60% de, 70% de, 80% de, 90% de, or even 95% or greater de.
Isolated optical isomers may be purified from racemic mixtures by well-known chiral separation techniques, such as but not limited to, normal and reverse phase chromatography, and crystallization. According to one such method, a racemic mixture of a compound of the application, or a chiral intermediate thereof, is separated using a chiral salt or carried out on a Chiralcell OD column. The column is operated according to the manufacturer’s instructions.
Isolated optical isomers (enantiomerically pure compounds) can also be prepared by the use of chiral intermediates or catalysts in synthesis. When a chiral synthetic intermediate is used, the optical center (chiral center) can be preserved without racemization throughout the remainder of the preparative procedure, as is well known in the art. Chiral catalyst can be used to impart at least some degree of enantiomeric purity to products of reactions catalyzed by the chiral catalyst. And, in some cases, compounds having at least some degree of enantiomeric enrichment can be obtained by physical processes such as selective crystallization of salts or complexes formed with chiral adjuvants.
A variety of compounds in the present application may exist in particular geometric or stereoisomeric forms. The present application takes into account all such compounds, including tautomers, cis- and trans-isomers, R- and S-enantiomers, diastereomers, (D)-isomers, (L)- isomers, the racemic mixtures thereof, and other mixtures thereof, as being covered within the scope of this application. All tautomeric forms are encompassed in the present application.
Additional asymmetric carbon atoms may be present in a substituent such as an alkyl group. All such isomers, as well as mixtures thereof, are intended to be included in this application, unless the stereochemistry or isomeric form is specifically indicated. Rotational Isomerism
It is understood that due to chemical properties (i.e., resonance lending some double bond character to the C-N bond) of restricted rotation about the amide bond linkage (as illustrated below) it is possible to observe separate rotamer species and even, under some circumstances, to isolate such species (see below). It is further understood that certain structural elements, including steric bulk or substituents on the amide nitrogen, may enhance the stability of a rotamer to the extent that a compound may be isolated as, and exist indefinitely, as a single stable rotamer. The present application therefore includes any possible stable rotamers of formula (I) which are biologically active in the treatment of cancer or other proliferative disease states.
Regioisomerism
Figure imgf000064_0001
The preferred compounds of the present application have a particular spatial arrangement of substituents on the aromatic rings, which are related to the structure activity relationship demonstrated by the compound class. Often such substitution arrangement is denoted by a numbering system; however, numbering systems are often not consistent between different ring systems. In six-membered aromatic systems, the spatial arrangements are specified by the common nomenclature“para” for 1,4-substitution,“meta” for 1,3-substitution and“ortho” for 1,2-substitution as shown below.
Figure imgf000064_0002
Isotopical Labeling in Described Compounds
The present application further includes all pharmaceutically acceptable isotopically labeled compound [e.g., of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va)]. An "isotopically" or "radio-labeled" compound is a compound where one or more atoms are replaced or substituted by an atom having an atomic mass or mass number different from the atomic mass or mass number typically found in nature (i.e., naturally occurring). For example, in certain embodiments, in compounds [e.g., of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va)], hydrogen atoms are replaced or substituted by one or more deuterium or tritium (e.g., hydrogen atoms on a C1-6 alkyl or a C1-6 alkoxy are replaced with deuterium, such as d3-methoxy or 1,1,2,2-d4-3-methylbutyl).
Certain isotopically labeled compounds [e.g., compounds of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va)], for example, those incorporating a radioactive isotope, are useful in drug and/or substrate tissue distribution studies. The radioactive isotopes tritium, i.e., 3H, and carbon 14, i.e., 14C, are particularly useful for this purpose in view of their ease of incorporation and ready means of detection.
Such isotopically labeled compounds are useful in metabolic studies (preferably with 14C), reaction kinetic studies (with, for example 2H or 3H), detection or imaging techniques [such as positron emission tomography (PET) or single-photon emission computed tomography (SPECT)] including drug or substrate tissue distribution assays, or in radioactive treatment of patients. Further, substitution with heavier isotopes such as deuterium (i.e., 2H) may afford certain therapeutic advantages resulting from greater metabolic stability, for example increased in vivo half-life or reduced dosage requirements.
Substitution with positron emitting isotopes, such as 11C, 18F, 15O, and 13N, can be useful in Positron Emission Topography (PET) studies for examining substrate receptor occupancy.
Isotopically labeled compounds [e.g., of formula (I), (Ia), or (Ib)] or their corresponding prodrugs can generally be prepared by conventional techniques known to those skilled in the art or by processes analogous to those described in the accompanying examples using an
appropriate isotopically labeled reagent in place of the non-labeled reagent previously employed. Suitable isotopes that may be incorporated in compounds of the present application include but are not limited to isotopes of hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, fluorine, chlorine, and iodine, such as 2H (also written as D for deuterium), 3H (also written as T for tritium), 11C, 13C,14C, 13N, 15N, 15O, 17O, 18O, 18F, 35S, 36Cl , 82B r, 75Br, 76B r, 77Br, 123I, 124I, 125I, 131I, 31P, and 32P.
Isotopically labeled compounds of this application and prodrugs thereof can generally be prepared by carrying out the procedures disclosed in the schemes or in the examples and preparations described below by substituting a readily available isotopically labeled reagent for a non-isotopically labeled reagent.
Provisos may apply to any of the disclosed categories or embodiments such that specific embodiments or species may be excluded from such categories or embodiments. In various embodiments, the compound or set of compounds, such as are used in the inventive methods, can be any one of any of the combinations and/or sub-combinations of the above-listed embodiments.
Pharmaceutical Compositions
The compositions and methods of the present application may be utilized to treat a subject, such as a mammal, e.g., human, or a non-human mammal, in need thereof. When administered to an animal, such as a human, the composition or the compound is preferably administered as a pharmaceutical composition comprising, for example, a compound of the application and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In certain embodiments, the application relates to a pharmaceutical composition comprising as active ingredient a therapeutically effective amount of a compound according to formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or prodrug thereof, in association with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, excipient, or diluent.
The term "pharmaceutically acceptable carrier", as used herein, refers to a
pharmaceutically acceptable material, composition or vehicle, such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, solvent or encapsulating material, which can act, for example, to stabilize, increase solubility or to increase the absorption of a compound such as a compound of the application. Each carrier must be "acceptable" in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not injurious to the patient.
Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers are well known in the art. For example, some examples of materials which can serve as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers include, but are not limited to: (1) sugars, such as lactose, glucose, sucrose or dextrans; (2) starches, such as corn starch and potato starch; (3) cellulose, and its derivatives, such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; (4) powdered tragacanth; (5) malt; (6) gelatin; (7) talc; (8) excipients, such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; (9) oils, such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; (10) glycols, such as glycerol or propylene glycol; (11) polyols, such as glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; (12) esters, such as ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; (13) agar; (14) buffering agents, such as magnesium hydroxide and aluminum hydroxide; (15) alginic acid; (16) pyrogen-free water; (17) isotonic saline; (18) Ringer's solution; (19) ethyl alcohol; (20) phosphate buffer solutions; (21) antioxidants, such as ascorbic acid or glutathione; and (22) other non-toxic compatible substances employed in pharmaceutical formulations, such as chelating agents, low molecular weight proteins or other stabilizers or excipients.
The choice of a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, including a physiologically acceptable agent, depends, for example, on the route of administration of the composition. The pharmaceutical composition can be a self-emulsifying or a self-microemulsifying drug delivery system. The pharmaceutical composition also can be a liposome or other polymer matrix, which can have incorporated therein. Liposomes, for example, which comprise phospholipids or other lipids, are nontoxic, physiologically acceptable and metabolizable carriers that are relatively simple to make and administer.
Wetting agents, emulsifiers and lubricants, such as sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium stearate, as well as coloring agents, release agents, coating agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present in the compositions. Such liquid compositions may optionally contain: pharmaceutically-acceptable excipients such as suspending agents (for example, sorbitol, methyl cellulose, sodium alginate, gelatin, hydroxyethylcellulose, carboxymethylcellulose, aluminum stearate gel and the like); non- aqueous vehicles, e.g., oil (for example, almond oil or fractionated coconut oil), propylene glycol, ethyl alcohol, or water; preservatives (for example, methyl or propyl p-hydroxybenzoate or sorbic acid); wetting agents such as lecithin; and, if desired, flavoring or coloring agents.
Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable antioxidants include: (1) water-soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbic acid, cysteine hydrochloride, sodium bisulfate, sodium
metabisulfite, sodium sulfite and the like; (2) oil-soluble antioxidants, such as ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT), lecithin, propyl gallate, alpha-tocopherol, and the like; and (3) metal-chelating agents, such as citric acid, ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA), sorbitol, tartaric acid, phosphoric acid, and the like.
A pharmaceutical composition can be administered to a subject by any of a number of routes of administration including, but not limited to, for example, orally [for example, drenches as in aqueous or non-aqueous solutions or suspensions, tablets, pills, capsules (including sprinkle capsules and gelatin capsules), boluses, powders, granules, pastes for application to the tongue]; absorption through the oral mucosa (e.g., sublingually); anally, rectally or vaginally (for example, as a pessary, cream or foam); parenterally (including intramuscularly,
intravenously, subcutaneously or intrathecally as, for example, a sterile solution or suspension); nasally; intraperitoneally; subcutaneously; transdermally (for example as a patch applied to the skin); and topically (for example, as a cream, ointment or spray applied to the skin, or as an eye drop). The composition or compound may also be formulated for inhalation. In certain embodiments, the composition or compound may be simply dissolved or suspended in sterile water. Details of appropriate routes of administration and compositions suitable for same can be found in, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos.6,110,973, 5,763,493, 5,731,000, 5,541,231, 5,427,798, 5,358,970 and 4,172,896, as well as in patents cited therein. Sterile compositions are also contemplated by the application, including compositions that are in accord with national and local regulations governing such compositions. Preferably, the compositions are formulated for intravenous or oral administration.
For oral administration, the compounds the application may be provided in a solid form, such as a tablet, pills, dragees, powers, granules, or capsule, or as a solution, emulsion, or suspension. To prepare the oral compositions, the active ingredient is mixed with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate, and/or any of the following: (1) fillers or extenders, such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol, and/or silicic acid; (2) binders, such as, for example, carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, sucrose and/or acacia; (3) humectants, such as glycerol; (4) disintegrating agents, such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates, and sodium carbonate; (5) solution retarding agents, such as paraffin; (6) absorption accelerators, such as quaternary ammonium compounds; (7) wetting agents, such as, for example, cetyl alcohol and glycerol monostearate; (8) absorbents, such as kaolin and bentonite clay; (9) lubricants, such a talc, calcium stearate, magnesium stearate, solid polyethylene glycols, sodium lauryl sulfate, and mixtures thereof; (10) complexing agents, such as, modified and unmodified cyclodextrins; (11) coloring agents; (12) emulsifying and suspending agents, such as, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol, sorbitan esters,
microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar, and tragacanth; and (13) other non-toxic compatible substances employed in pharmaceutical formulations, such as, without limitation, , buffering agents, perfuming and preservative agents, sweetening agents, flavoring agents.
Oral tablets may be made by compression or molding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients, such as diluents, disintegrating agents, binding agents, lubricating agents, sweetening agents, flavoring agents, coloring agents and preservative agents. Suitable inert fillers include sodium and calcium carbonate, sodium and calcium phosphate, lactose, starch, sugar, glucose, methyl cellulose, magnesium stearate, mannitol, sorbitol, and the like.
Exemplary liquid oral excipients include ethanol, glycerol, water, and the like. Starch, polyvinyl-pyrrolidone (PVP), sodium starch glycolate, microcrystalline cellulose, and alginic acid are exemplary disintegrating agents. Binding agents may include hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose, starch and gelatin. The lubricating agent, if present, may be magnesium stearate, stearic acid, or talc. If desired, the tablets may be coated with a material such as glyceryl monostearate or glyceryl distearate to delay absorption in the gastrointestinal tract, or may be coated with an enteric coating.
Other solid dosage forms of the pharmaceutical compositions, such as dragees, capsules (including sprinkle capsules and gelatin capsules), pills and granules, may optionally be scored or prepared with coatings and shells, such as enteric coatings and other coatings well known in the pharmaceutical-formulating art. For example, to prepare hard gelatin capsules, active ingredient(s) may be mixed with a solid, semi-solid, or liquid diluent. Soft gelatin capsules may be prepared by mixing the active ingredient with water, oil such as peanut oil or olive oil, liquid paraffin, a mixture of mono and di-glycerides of short chain fatty acids, polyethylene glycol 400, or propylene glycol.
The pharmaceutical compositions may also be formulated so as to provide slow or controlled release of the active ingredient therein using, for example, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose in varying proportions to provide the desired release profile, other polymer matrices, liposomes and/or microspheres. They may be sterilized by, for example, filtration through a bacteria-retaining filter, or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions that can be dissolved in sterile water, or some other sterile injectable medium immediately before use. These compositions may also optionally contain opacifying agents and may be of a composition that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain portion of the gastrointestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner. Examples of embedding compositions that can be used include polymeric substances and waxes. The active ingredient can also be in micro-encapsulated form, if appropriate, with one or more of the above-described excipients.
Liquid dosage forms useful for oral administration include pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, lyophiles for reconstitution, microemulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs, or may be lyophilized or presented as a dry product for reconstitution with water or other suitable vehicle before use. In addition to the active ingredient, the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art, such as, for example, water or other solvents, cyclodextrins and derivatives thereof, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers, such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan, and mixtures thereof.
In addition, formulations of the pharmaceutical compositions for administration to the mouth may be presented as a mouthwash, or an oral spray, or an oral ointment.
The phrases“parenteral administration” and“administered parenterally”, as used herein, means modes of administration other than enteral and topical administration, usually by injection, and includes, without limitation, intravenous, intramuscular, intraarterial, intrathecal, intracapsular, intraorbital, intracardiac, intradermal, intranasal, intraperitoneal, transtracheal, subcutaneous, subcuticular, intraarticular, subcapsular, subarachnoid, intraspinal, and
intrasternal injection and infusion.
For parenteral use, the agents of the application may be provided in sterile aqueous solutions or suspensions, buffered to an appropriate pH and isotonicity or in parenterally acceptable oil. Suitable aqueous vehicles include Ringer's solution and isotonic sodium chloride. Such forms may be presented in unit-dose form such as ampoules or disposable injection devices, in multi-dose forms such as vials from which the appropriate dose may be withdrawn, or in a solid form or pre-concentrate that can be reconstituted into a sterile injectable
formulation, such as solutions or dispersions just prior to use, which may contain antioxidants, buffers, bacteriostats, solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient or suspending or thickening agents. Illustrative infusion doses range from about 1 to 1000 μg/kg/minute of agent admixed with a pharmaceutical carrier over a period ranging from several minutes to several days.
Examples of suitable aqueous and nonaqueous carriers that may be employed in the pharmaceutical compositions of the application include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof, vegetable oils, such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters, such as ethyl oleate. Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions, and by the use of surfactants. These compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents. Prevention of the action of microorganisms may be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid, and the like. It may also be desirable to include isotonic agents, such as sugars, sodium chloride, and the like into the compositions.
In some cases, in order to prolong the effect of a drug, it is desirable to slow the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material having poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon its rate of dissolution, which, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally administered drug form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsulated matrices of the subject compounds in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending on the ratio of drug to polymer, and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of drug release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions that are compatible with body tissue.
In a preferred embodiment, when such pharmaceutical compositions are for human administration, particularly for invasive routes of administration (i.e., routes, such as injection or implantation, that circumvent transport or diffusion through an epithelial barrier), the aqueous solution is pyrogen-free, or substantially pyrogen-free. The excipients can be chosen, for example, to effect delayed release of an agent or to selectively target one or more cells, tissues or organs.
For rectal, vaginal, or urethral administration, formulations of the pharmaceutical compositions may be presented as a suppository, which may be prepared by mixing one or more active compounds with one or more suitable nonirritating excipients or carriers comprising, for example, cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol, a suppository wax or a salicylate, and which is solid at room temperature, but liquid at body temperature and, therefore, will melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound. Formulations which are suitable for vaginal administration also include pessaries, tampons, creams, gels, pastes, foams or spray formulations containing such carriers as are known in the art to be appropriate. For topical applications or transdermal administration, the active compounds of the present application may be mixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and with any preservatives, buffers, excipients, or propellants, such as animal and vegetable fats, oils, waxes, paraffins, starch, tragacanth, cellulose derivatives, polyethylene glycols, silicones, bentonites, silicic acid, talc and zinc oxide, or mixtures thereof. Dosage forms for the topical include powders, sprays, ointments, pastes, creams, lotions, gels, solutions, patches and inhalants.
The active compounds may be mixed with a pharmaceutical carrier at a concentration of about 0.1% to about 10% of drug to vehicle.
Powders and sprays can contain, in addition to an active compound, excipients such as lactose, talc, silicic acid, aluminum hydroxide, calcium silicates and polyamide powder, or mixtures of these substances. Sprays can additionally contain customary propellants, such as chlorofluorohydrocarbons and volatile unsubstituted hydrocarbons, such as butane and propane.
Transdermal patches have the added advantage of providing controlled delivery of a compound of the present application to the body. Such dosage forms can be made by dissolving or dispersing the active compound in the proper medium. Absorption enhancers can also be used to increase the flux of the compound across the skin. The rate of such flux can be controlled by either providing a rate controlling membrane or dispersing the compound in a polymer matrix or gel.
Ophthalmic formulations, eye ointments, powders, solutions and the like, are also contemplated as being within the scope of this application. Exemplary ophthalmic formulations are described in U.S. Publication Nos.2005/0080056, 2005/0059744, 2005/0031697 and 2005/004074 and U.S. Patent No.6,583,124, the contents of which are incorporated herein by reference. If desired, liquid ophthalmic formulations have properties similar to that of lacrimal fluids, aqueous humor or vitreous humor or are compatible with such fluids. A preferred route of administration is local administration (e.g., topical administration, such as eye drops, or administration via an implant).
Alternatively or additionally, compositions can be formulated for delivery via a catheter, stent, wire, or other intraluminal device. Delivery via such devices may be especially useful for delivery to the bladder, urethra, ureter, rectum, or intestine.
Methods of introduction may also be provided by rechargeable or biodegradable devices. Various slow release polymeric devices have been developed and tested in vivo in recent years for the controlled delivery of drugs, including proteinacious biopharmaceuticals. A variety of biocompatible polymers (including hydrogels), including both biodegradable and non- degradable polymers, can be used to form an implant for the sustained release of a compound at a particular target site.
A physician or veterinarian having ordinary skill in the art can readily determine and prescribe the therapeutically effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition required. The term“therapeutically effective amount” or“dose”, or“dosage”, as used herein, refers to an amount or dose sufficient to generally bring about the desired therapeutic benefit or an amount sufficient to modulate the biological activity of the target receptor in subjects needing such treatment.
Effective amounts or dosages of the compounds of the application may be ascertained by routine methods, such as modeling, dose escalation, or clinical trials, taking into account routine factors. Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions may be varied. In general, a suitable daily dose of an active compound used in the compositions and methods of the application will be that amount of the compound that is the lowest dose effective to produce a therapeutic effect.
The selected dosage level will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the particular compound or combination of compounds employed, or the salts, solvate, and prodrug thereof, the route of administration, the time of administration, the rate of excretion of the particular compound(s) being employed, the duration of the treatment, other drugs, compounds and/or materials used in combination with particular compound(s) employed, age, sex, weight, condition, general health, prior medical history of the patient being treated, and the preference and experience of the physician or veterinarian in charge, and like factors well known in the medical arts.
For example, in choosing a regimen for a subject, such as a patient, it can frequently be necessary to begin with a higher dosage and when the condition is under control to reduce the dosage. In another example, it is also possible to start at a dosage of the pharmaceutical composition for compound at levels lower than that required in order to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and gradually increase the dosage until the desired effect is achieved.
The compounds of the application are effective over a wide dosage range. For example, in the treatment of adult humans, dosages from about 0.05 to about 5000 mg, preferably from about 1 to about 2000 mg, and more preferably between about 2 and about 2000 mg per day can be used. A typical dosage is about 10 mg to about 1000 mg per day, or 25 to 200 mg per day, or 50 to 100 mg per day, or less than 100 mg per day.
In some embodiments, the compounds of the application are dispensed in unit dosage form including from about 0.05 mg to about 1000 mg of active ingredient together with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier per unit dosage. In other embodiments, a unit dosage form includes from about 10 to about 200 mg of active ingredient. In other embodiments, dosage forms suitable for oral, nasal, pulmonal or transdermal administration include from about 125 µg to about 1250 mg, preferably from about 250 µg to about 500 mg, and more preferably from about 2.5 mg to about 250 mg, of the compounds admixed with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent. Methods to determine efficacy and dosage are known to those skilled in the art (Isselbacher et al. (1996) Harrison’s Principles of Internal Medicine 13ed., 1814-1882, herein incorporated by reference).
Dosage forms can be administered daily or more than once a day, such as twice or thrice daily. Alternatively dosage forms can be administered less frequently than daily, such as every other day, or weekly, if found to be advisable by a prescribing physician. A larger dosage can be delivered by multiple administrations of the agent. In some embodiments, dosage forms are administered once, twice, or thrice daily. In preferred embodiments, the active compound will be administered once daily. Once improvement of the patient’s disease has occurred, the dose may be adjusted for maintenance treatment. For example, the dosage or the frequency of
administration, or both, may be reduced as a function of the symptoms, to a level at which the desired therapeutic or prophylactic effect is maintained. Of course, if symptoms have been alleviated to an appropriate level, treatment may cease. Patients may, however, require intermittent treatment on a long-term basis upon any recurrence of symptoms. Patients may also require chronic treatment on a long-term basis.
Methods and Uses
In various embodiments, compounds of the application can be used to modulate, such as to activate (agonist), or to block activation of (antagonist), an orexin receptor. Accordingly, in various embodiments, the application provides a method of modulating an orexin receptor comprising contacting the receptor with an effective amount or concentration of a compound of the application. The orexin receptor can be OX1 or OX2. In various embodiments, the compound of the application is an antagonist of an orexin receptor such as OX1 or OX2, or both, and can be a selective inhibitor of one or the other. In various embodiments, contacting can take place in vivo within tissues of a patient, such as a human patient. In various embodiments, modulation of an orexin receptor, for example, antagonism of orexin-1, by a compound of the application can be used to treat a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a patient, as described herein.
In various embodiments, the application provides a method of treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a patient, such as treating a disease, disorder, or medical condition in which modulation of an orexin receptor is medically indicating, comprising administering to the subject, such as a patient, a compound of the application in a dose, at a frequency, and for duration to provide a beneficial effect to the subject. Modulation, such as agonism or antagonism, of an orexin receptor can be medically indicated in treatment of a disease, disorder, or medical condition wherein the orexin receptor plays a metabolic or regulatory role. Certain such conditions can be treated by selective modulation of a single class of orexin receptor, such as modulation of OX1 while OX2 is not influenced by administration of the compound of the application at the dose provided. In various embodiments, compounds of the application can be orexin-1 antagonists, and some of those are selective orexin-1 antagonists with respect to orexin-2. By“selective” is meant that one receptor is modulated at
concentrations of the compound at least 10 times lower than the concentrations at which the comparative receptor is modulated by that compound. Accordingly, in various embodiments, the compound of the application can be a selective modulator, e.g., an antagonist, of orexin receptor OX1. In other embodiments, the compound of the application can be a selective modulator (e.g., antagonist) of an orexin receptor OX2. In further embodiments, the compound of the application can further modulate other types or classes of receptors having affinity for one of more forms of the orexin class of natural peptidic ligands.
In various embodiments, the application provides a use of a compound of the application for treatment of a disease, disorder, or medical condition in a patient. For example, a compound of the application can be used in the preparation of a medicament for administration to a patient suffering from a disease, disorder, or medical condition. More specifically, the disease, disorder, or medical condition can comprise an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, aggression associated with neurological disorders such as Alzheimer's disease, and aggression associated with neurodevelopmental disorders such as autism, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, head ache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune- related diseases, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease. Drug or substance abuse or addiction includes relapse. These may include abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, nicotine, alcohol, cannabis, heroin, and/or any other drug of abuse.
In other embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is narcolepsy, insomnia, learning disorders, memory disorders, depression, anxiety, addiction, obsessive compulsive disorder, affective neurosis, depressive neurosis, anxiety neurosis, dysthymic disorder, behavior disorder, mood disorder, sexual dysfunction, psychosexual dysfunction, sex disorder, schizophrenia, manic depression, delirium, dementia, severe mental retardation or dyskinesias (such as Huntington’s Disease or Tourette Syndrome), eating disorders (such as anorexia, bulimia, cachexia, or obesity), addictive feeding behaviors, binge/purge feeding behaviors, cardiovascular diseases, diabetes, appetite/taste disorders, emesis, vomiting, nausea, asthma, cancer, Parkinson’s Disease, Cushing’s Syndrome/Disease, basophile adenoma, prolactinoma, hyperprolactinemia, hypophysis tumor/adenoma, hypothalamic diseases, inflammatory bowel disease, gastric dyskinesia, gastric ulcers, Froehlich’s Syndrome, adrenohypophysis disease, hypophysis diseases, adrenohypophysis hypofunction,
adrenohypophysis hyperfunction, hypothalamic hypogonadism, Kallman’s syndrome (anosmia, hyposmia), functional or psychogenic amenorrhea, hypopituitarism, hypothalamic
hypothyroidism, hypothalamic-adrenal dysfunction, idiopathic hyperprolactinemia,
hypothalamic disorders of growth hormone deficiency, idiopathic growth deficiency, dwarfism, gigantism, acromegaly, disturbed biological and circadian rhythms, sleep disturbances associated with disease such as neurological disorders, neuropathic pain, diabetic neuropathy, and restless leg syndrome, heart and lung diseases, acute and congestive heart failure, hypotension, hypertension, urinary retention, osteoporosis, angina pectoris, myocardial infarction, ischemic or hemorrhagic stroke, subsrachnoic hemorrhage, ulcers, allergies, benign prostatic hypertrophy, chronic renal failure, renal disease, impaired glucose tolerance, migraine, episodic migraine, headache disorders (such as tension-type headache, cluster headache, other trigeminal autonomic cephalalgias, other primary headaches such as hemicranias continua, secondary headaches, cranial neuralgia, or central or primary facial pain), hyperalgesia, pain, enhanced or exaggerated sensitivity to pain such as hyperalgesia, causalgia, or allodynia, acute pain, burn pain, atypical facial pain, neuropathic pain, back pain, complex regional pain syndrome I or II, arthritic pain, sports injury pain, pain related to infection (e.g., HIV), post- chemotherapy pain, post-stroke pain, post-operative pain, neuralgia, emesis, nausea, vomiting, conditions associated with visceral pain (such as irritable bowel syndrome or angina), urinary bladder incontinence (e.g., urge incontinence), tolerance to narcotics or withdrawal from narcotics, sleep disorders, sleep apnea, parasomnia, jet lag syndrome, neurodegenerative disorders, disinhibition-dementia-parkinsonism-amyotrophy complex, pallido-ponto-nigral degeneration, epilepsy, seizure disorders, or other diseases related to general orexin system dysfunction.
In still other embodiments, the compounds described herein are useful in a method of treating disorders including, but not limited to, sleep disorders, sleep disturbances, including enhancing sleep quality, improving sleep quality, increasing sleep efficiency, augmenting sleep maintenance; increasing the ratio of the time that a subject sleeps relative to the time that a subject is attempting to sleep; improving sleep initiation; decreasing sleep latency or onset (the time it takes to fall asleep); decreasing difficulties in falling asleep; increasing sleep continuity; decreasing the number of awakenings during sleep; decreasing intermittent wakings during sleep; decreasing nocturnal arousals; decreasing the time spent awake following the initial onset of sleep; increasing the total amount of sleep; reducing the fragmentation of sleep; altering the timing, frequency, or duration of REM sleep bouts; altering the timing, frequency, or duration of slow wave (such as stages 3 or 4) sleep bouts; increasing the amount and percentage of stage 2 sleep; promoting slow wave sleep; enhancing EEG-delta activity during sleep; decreasing nocturnal arousals, especially early morning awakenings; increasing daytime alertness; reducing daytime drowsiness; treating or reducing excessive daytime sleepiness; increasing satisfaction with the intensity of sleep; increasing sleep maintenance; idiopathic insomnia; sleep problems; insomnia, hypersomnia, idiopathic hypersomnia, repeatability hypersomnia, intrinsic
hypersomnia, narcolepsy, interrupted sleep, sleep apnea, wakefulness, nocturnal myoclonus, REM sleep interruptions, jet-lag, shift workers' sleep disturbances, dyssomnias, night terror, insomnias associated with depression, emotional/mood disorders, Alzheimer's disease, or cognitive impairment, as well as sleep walking and enuresis, and sleep disorders that accompany aging; Alzheimer's sundowning; conditions associated with circadian rhythmicity as well as mental and physical disorders associated with travel across time zones and with rotating shift- work schedules, conditions due to drugs that cause reductions in REM sleep as a side effect; fibromyalgia; syndromes that are manifested by non-restorative sleep and muscle pain; sleep apnea that is associated with respiratory disturbances during sleep; conditions that result from a diminished quality of sleep; increasing learning; augmenting memory; increasing retention of memory; eating disorders associated with excessive food intake and complications associated therewith, compulsive eating disorders, obesity (due to any cause, whether genetic or environmental), obesity-related disorders including overeating and bulimia nervosa,
hypertension, diabetes, elevated plasma insulin concentrations and insulin resistance, dyslipidemias, hyperlipidemia, endometrial, breast, prostate and colon cancer, osteoarthritis, obstructive sleep apnea, cholelithiasis, gallstones, heart disease, abnormal heart rhythms and arrythmias, myocardial infarction, congestive heart failure, coronary heart disease, sudden death, stroke, polycystic ovary disease, craniopharyngioma, the Prader-Willi Syndrome, Frohlich's syndrome, GH-deficient subjects, normal variant short stature, Turner's syndrome, and other pathological conditions showing reduced metabolic activity or a decrease in resting energy expenditure as a percentage of total fat-free mass, e.g., children with acute lymphoblastic leukemia, metabolic syndrome, also known as syndrome X, insulin resistance syndrome, reproductive hormone abnormalities, sexual and reproductive dysfunction, such as impaired fertility, infertility, hypogonadism in males and hirsutism in females, fetal defects associated with maternal obesity, gastrointestinal motility disorders, such as obesity-related gastro- esophageal reflux, respiratory disorders, such as obesity-hypoventilation syndrome (Pickwickian syndrome), breathlessness, cardiovascular disorders, inflammation, such as systemic
inflammation of the vasculature, arteriosclerosis, hypercholesterolemia, hyperuricaemia, lower back pain, gallbladder disease, gout, kidney cancer, increased anesthetic risk, reducing the risk of secondary outcomes of obesity, such as reducing the risk of left ventricular hypertrophy; diseases or disorders where abnormal oscillatory activity occurs in the brain, including depression, migraine, neuropathic pain, Parkinson's disease, psychosis, or schizophrenia, as well as diseases or disorders where there is abnormal coupling of activity, particularly through the thalamus; enhancing cognitive function; enhancing memory; increasing memory retention;
increasing immune response; increasing immune function; hot flashes; night sweats; extending life span; schizophrenia; muscle-related disorders that are controlled by the excitation/relaxation rhythms imposed by the neural system such as cardiac rhythm and other disorders of the cardiovascular system; conditions related to proliferation of cells such as vasodilation or vasorestriction and blood pressure; cancer; cardiac arrhythmia; hypertension; congestive heart failure; conditions of the genital/urinary system; disorders of sexual function and fertility;
adequacy of renal function; responsivity to anesthetics; mood disorders, such as depression or more particularly depressive disorders, for example, single episodic or recurrent major depressive disorders and dysthymic disorders, or bipolar disorders, for example, bipolar I disorder, bipolar II disorder, and cyclothymic disorder, mood disorders due to a general medical condition, and substance-induced mood disorders; anxiety disorders including acute stress disorder, agoraphobia, generalized anxiety disorder, obsessive-compulsive disorder, panic attack, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, separation anxiety disorder, social phobia, specific phobia, substance-induced mood disorders; anxiety disorders including acute stress disorder, agoraphobia, generalized anxiety disorder, obsessive-compulsive disorder, panic attack, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, separation anxiety disorder, social phobia, specific phobia, substance-induced anxiety disorder and anxiety due to a general medical condition; acute neurological and psychiatric disorders such as cerebral deficits subsequent to cardiac bypass surgery and grafting, stroke, ischemic stroke, cerebral ischemia, spinal cord trauma, head trauma, perinatal hypoxia, cardiac arrest, hypoglycemic neuronal damage;
Huntington's Chorea; amyotrophic lateral sclerosis; multiple sclerosis; ocular damage;
retinopathy; cognitive disorders; idiopathic and drug-induced Parkinson's disease; muscular spasms and disorders associated with muscular spasticity including tremors, epilepsy, convulsions; cognitive disorders including dementia (associated with Alzheimer's disease, ischemia, trauma, vascular problems or stroke, HIV disease, Parkinson's disease, Huntington's disease, Pick's disease, Creutzfeldt-Jacob disease, perinatal hypoxia, other general medical conditions or substance abuse); delirium, amnestic disorders or age related cognitive decline; schizophrenia or psychosis including schizophrenia (paranoid, disorganized, catatonic or undifferentiated), schizophreniform disorder, schizoaffective disorder, delusional disorder, brief psychotic disorder, shared psychotic disorder, psychotic disorder due to a general medical condition and substance-induced psychotic disorder; substance-related disorders and addictive behaviors (including substance-induced delirium, persisting dementia, persisting amnestic disorder, psychotic disorder or anxiety disorder; tolerance, addictive feeding, dependence or withdrawal from substances including alcohol, amphetamines, cannabis, cocaine, hallucinogens, inhalants, nicotine, opioids, phencyclidine, sedatives, hypnotics, or anxiolytics); movement disorders, including akinesias and akinetic-rigid syndromes (including Parkinson's disease, drug- induced parkinsonism, postencephalitic parkinsonism, progressive supranuclear palsy, multiple system atrophy, corticobasal degeneration, parkinsonism-ALS dementia complex and basal ganglia calcification), chronic fatigue syndrome, fatigue, including Parkinson's fatigue, multiple sclerosis fatigue, fatigue caused by a sleep disorder or a circadian rhythm disorder, medication- induced parkinsonism (such as neuroleptic-induced parkinsonism, neuroleptic malignant syndrome, neuroleptic-induced acute dystonia, neuroleptic-induced acute akathisia, neuroleptic- induced tardive dyskinesia and medication-induced postural tremor), Gilles de la Tourette's syndrome, epilepsy, and dyskinesias including tremor (such as rest tremor, essential tremor, postural tremor and intention tremor), chorea (such as Sydenham's chorea, Huntington's disease, benign hereditary chorea, neuroacanthocytosis, symptomatic chorea, drug-induced chorea and hemiballism), myoclonus (including generalised myoclonus and focal myoclonus), tics
(including simple tics, complex tics and symptomatic tics), restless leg syndrome and dystonia (including generalized dystonia such as iodiopathic dystonia, drug-induced dystonia, symptomatic dystonia and paroxymal dystonia, and focal dystonia such as blepharospasm, oromandibular dystonia, spasmodic dysphonia, spasmodic torticollis, axial dystonia, dystonic writer's cramp and hemiplegic dystonia); attention deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD);
conduct disorder; migraine (including migraine headache); urinary incontinence; substance tolerance, substance withdrawal (including, substances such as opiates, nicotine, tobacco products, alcohol, benzodiazepines, cocaine, sedatives, hypnotics, etc.); psychosis;
schizophrenia; anxiety (including generalized anxiety disorder, panic disorder, and obsessive compulsive disorder); mood disorders (including depression, mania, bipolar disorders);
trigeminal neuralgia; hearing loss; tinnitus; neuronal damage including ocular damage;
retinopathy; macular degeneration of the eye; emesis; brain edema; pain, including acute and chronic pain states, severe pain, intractable pain, inflammatory pain, neuropathic pain, post- traumatic pain, bone and joint pain (osteoarthritis), repetitive motion pain, dental pain, cancer pain, myofascial pain (muscular injury, fibromyalgia), perioperative pain (general surgery, gynecological), chronic pain, neuropathic pain, post-traumatic pain, trigeminal neuralgia, migraine and migraine headache.
In other embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease, Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, head ache, migraine, pain, gastrointestinal diseases, epilepsy, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, psychosexual disorder, and renal disease.
In still other embodiments, the disease, disorder, or medical condition is substance addiction (including relapse), panic disorder, anxiety, post-traumatic stress disorder, pain, depression, seasonal affective disorder, an eating disorder, or hypertension.
Thus, in specific embodiments the present application provides methods for: enhancing the quality of sleep; augmenting sleep maintenance; increasing REM sleep; increasing stage 2 sleep; decreasing fragmentation of sleep patterns; treating insomnia; enhancing cognition;
increasing memory retention; treating or controlling obesity; treating or controlling depression; treating, controlling, ameliorating or reducing the risk of epilepsy, including absence epilepsy; treating or controlling pain, including neuropathic pain; treating or controlling Parkinson's disease; treating or controlling psychosis; or treating, controlling, ameliorating or reducing the risk of schizophrenia, in a subject in need thereof which comprises administering to the patient a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the present application.
It is believed that antagonism of orexin-1 is medically indicated for the treatment of the above-listed conditions. By antagonism is meant blocking a receptor, in this case an orexin receptor, without causing it to transduce a signal. That is, antagonism results in blocking an endogenous or exogenous ligand from activating, or causing antagonism, of the receptor.
It is within ordinary skill to evaluate any compound disclosed and claimed herein for effectiveness in modulation of an orexin receptor and in the various cellular assays using the procedures described above or found in the scientific literature. Accordingly, the person of ordinary skill can prepare and evaluate any of the claimed compounds without undue
experimentation.Any compound found to be an effective modulator, agonist or antagonist, can likewise be tested in animal models and in human clinical studies using the skill and experience of the investigator to guide the selection of dosages and treatment regimens.
In certain embodiments, the application comprises a method for conducting a
pharmaceutical business, by determining an appropriate formulation and dosage of a compound of the application for treating or preventing any of the diseases or conditions as described herein, conducting therapeutic profiling of identified formulations for efficacy and toxicity in animals, and providing a distribution network for selling an identified preparation as having an acceptable therapeutic profile. In certain embodiments, the method further includes providing a sales group for marketing the preparation to healthcare providers.
In certain embodiments, the application relates to a method for conducting a
pharmaceutical business by determining an appropriate formulation and dosage of a compound of the application for treating or preventing any of the disease or conditions as described herein, and licensing, to a third party, the rights for further development and sale of the formulation.
The term "healthcare providers" refers to individuals or organizations that provide healthcare services to a person, community, etc. Examples of "healthcare providers" include doctors, hospitals, continuing care retirement communities, skilled nursing facilities, subacute care facilities, clinics, multispecialty clinics, freestanding ambulatory centers, home health agencies, and HMO's.
Drug Combinations
The compounds of the present application may be used in pharmaceutical compositions or methods in combination with one or more additional active ingredients in the treatment of the diseases and disorders described herein. Further additional active ingredients include other therapeutics or agents that mitigate adverse effects of therapies for the intended disease targets. Such combinations may serve to increase efficacy, ameliorate other disease symptoms, decrease one or more side effects, or decrease the required dose of an inventive compound. In certain embodiments, such combination provides an additive effect, wherein an additive effect refers to the sum of each of the effects of individual administration of the compound of the application and one or more additional therapeutic agent(s). In other embodiments, such combination provides a synergistic effect, in which the therapeutic effect exceeds the sum of each of the effects of individual administration of the compound of the application and one or more additional therapeutic agent(s).
The additional active ingredients may be administered in a separate pharmaceutical composition from a compound of the present application or may be included with a compound of the present application in a single pharmaceutical composition. The additional active ingredients may be administered simultaneously with, prior to, or after administration of a compound of the present application. Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions may be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active ingredient that is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular subject, such as a patient, composition, and mode of administration, without being toxic to the subject.
Combination agents include additional active ingredients are those that are known or discovered to be effective in treating the diseases and disorders described herein, including those active against another target associated with the disease. For example, compositions and formulations of the application, as well as methods of treatment, can further comprise other drugs or pharmaceuticals, e.g., other active agents useful for treating or palliative for the target diseases or related symptoms or conditions. For example, additional active ingredients include those that are known to be useful for enhancing sleep quality and preventing and treating sleep disorders and sleep disturbances, anti-diabetic agents, cardiovascular therapies, anti-obesity agents, other orexin receptor antagonists, pain medications, anti-depressants, anti-anxiety agents, cognition-enhancing agents, anti-Alzheimer’s Disease therapies, and other active ingredients. Exemplary active pharmaceutical ingredients and other therapies that are suitable for
combination with the presently described compounds include those listed in PCT Publ. No. WO2008/147518 at pages 23-29, which is hereby incorporated by reference. The pharmaceutical compositions of the any compound described herein may additional comprise one or more of such active agents, and methods of treatment may additionally comprise administering an effective amount of one or more of such active agents.
Examples
The following examples are offered to illustrate but not to limit the application. One of skill in the art will recognize that the following synthetic reactions and schemes may be modified by choice of suitable starting materials and reagents in order to access other compounds of Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
Example 1: Synthetic Protocols
Exemplary chemical entities useful in methods of the application will now be described by reference to illustrative synthetic schemes for their general preparation below and the specific examples that follow. Artisans will recognize that, to obtain the various compounds herein, starting materials may be suitably selected so that the ultimately desired substituents will be carried through the reaction scheme with or without protection as appropriate to yield the desired product. Alternatively, it may be necessary or desirable to employ, in the place of the ultimately desired substituent, a suitable group that may be carried through the reaction scheme and replaced as appropriate with the desired substituent. Furthermore, one of skill in the art will recognize that the transformations shown in the schemes below may be performed in any order that is compatible with the functionality of the particular pendant groups. Each of the reactions depicted in the general schemes is preferably run at a temperature from about 0 °C to the reflux temperature of the organic solvent used. Unless otherwise specified, the variables are as defined above in reference to Formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va). Isotopically labeled compounds as described herein are prepared according to the methods described below, using suitably labeled starting materials. Such materials are generally available from commercial suppliers of radiolabeled chemical reagents.
Terms and abbreviations:
ACN acetonitrile;
aq aqueous;
Atm atmospheric pressure;
Boc t-butoxycarbonyl;
Borax di-sodium tetraborate or sodium borate or sodium tetraborate;
Cbz benzyloxycarbonyl;
CDI 1,1'-carbonyldiimidazole;
DAST Diethylaminosulfur trifluoride
dba dibenzylideneacetone;
DCM dichloromethane;
DEA diethylamine;
DIBAL-H diisobutylaluminium hydride;
DIPEA diisopropylethylamine;
DME 1,2-dimethoxyethane;
DMF N,N-dimethyl formamide;
DMSO dimethyl sulfoxide;
Et2O diethyl ether;
EtOAc ethyl acetate;
EtOH ethanol;
eq. or equiv. equivalent;
h hour(s); HATU 2-(7-aza-1H-benzotriazole-1-yl)-1,1,3,3-tetramethyluronium
hexafluorophosphate;
HBTU O-benzotriazole-N,N,N',N'-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate
HPLC high performance liquid chromatography;
LCMS liquid chromatography mass spectrometry;
LDA lithium diisopropylamide;
LiHMDS lithium bis(trimethylsilyl)amide;
MeOH methanol;
min minute(s);
MS mass spectrometry;
MW microwave(s);
NH4OAc ammonium acetate;
NMR nuclear magnetic resonance;
ox oxidation;
Psi pounds per square inch;
quant. quantitative;
RCM ring closing metathesis;
r.t. room temperature;
sat. saturated;
SFC supercritical fluid chromatography;
T3P propylphosphonic anhydride;
TFA trifluoroacetic acid;
THF tetrahydrofuran;
TLC thin layer chromatography;
TMEDA tetramethylethylenediamine;
UPLC ultra performance liquid chromatography.
General Synthetic Scheme
In some embodiments, compounds of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) of the application, wherein both X and X’ are F and Z is NR2, can be prepared according to the general synthetic scheme shown in Scheme 1. Scheme 1
Figure imgf000086_0001
In some embodiments, compounds of formula (I), (Ia), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) of the application, wherein X is F, X’ is H and Z is NR2, can be prepared according to the genera synthetic scheme shown in Scheme 2.
Figure imgf000087_0001
Scheme 2
In some embodiments, compounds of formula (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va) of the application, wherein X is F, X’ is H or halogen, such as F, and Z is O, can be prepared according to the general synthetic scheme shown in Scheme 3.
Figure imgf000088_0001
Synthesis of Compounds (b)-(u)
3-Methylpiperidine-2-carboxylic acid hydrochloride (b)
PtO2 (10 g, 44.0 mol) was added to the mixture of 3-Methylpicolinic acid (100 g, 730 mmol) in 2 L of EtOH/ H2O (1/1) with 200 mL of conc. HCl (36%wt). The reaction was stirred at RT under a hydrogen atmosphere at 3MPa for 25 h, 1H-NMR indicated completion of reaction. The reaction was filtered through diatomaceous earth (ca.1 cm) and concentrated to yield the title compound as a white solid (131 g, 730 mmol, 100%), which was used for next step without further purification.1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 4.13-4.11 (m, 1H), 3.40-3.33 (m, 1H), 3.05-2.99 (m, 1H), 2.61-2.58 (m, 1H), 1.92-1.72 (m, 4H), 1.09 (d, J = 7.0 Hz, 3H). 1-(Benzyloxycarbonyl)-3-methylpiperidine-2-carboxylic acid (c)
Compound b (79 g, 0.44 mol) was dissolved in 2 M NaOH/THF (1/1 v/v, 1500 mL) and cooled to 0 °C. Benzyl chloroformate (113 g, 0.67 mol) was then added dropwise and the reaction was stirred at RT for 48h. The reaction was concentrated to remove the THF, and then extracted with toluene (3x100 mL) to remove excess CbzCl and benzyl alcohol. The organic layer was discarded. The aqueous layer was acidified (pH ~ 2) with conc. HCl and the product was extracted with EtOAc (150 mL x 4), dried over MgSO4, filtered, and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting colorless oil slowly solidified (103 g, 84%) and was used in the next step without further purification.1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 7.40–7.37 (m, 5H), 5.19 (m, 2H), 4.95-4.72 (m, 1H), 4.14-4.03 (m, 1H), 3.36-3.25 (m, 1H), 1.93-1.53 (m, 5H), 1.20-1.05 (m, 3H). ESI-MS (m/z): 263.93 [M+1]+.
(2S,3R)-1-(Benzyloxycarbonyl)-3-methylpiperidine-2-carboxylic acid (d) Compound c (55 g, 0.20 mmol) was dissolved in i-PrOH (400 mL). D-Tyrosine Hydrazide (23 g, 0.12 mol) was added to give a heterogenous mixture which was heated to reflux. MeOH was added in 100 mL portions until a homogenous solution was formed. The reaction was stirred for 1 h at this temperature evaporating off some of the MeOH in the process. When the reaction just becomes cloudy, heating was turned off, and the reaction was allowed to cool to rt with vigorous stirring which yielded a thick slurry. The reaction mixture was filtered and washed with i-PrOH (100 mL) to yield a colorless solid (~40 g, ee ~94%). Recrystallization from IPA/MeOH afforded a colorless solid (36g, >99%ee, 38%).
The colorless solid was dissolved in EtOAc (400 mL) and washed with 1 M HCl (100mL x 3), brine (100 mL) and dried over MgSO4. Removal of solvent under reduced pressure afforded a colorless oil as compound d (>99.% ee, 21g) which slowly solidified.
(2S,3R)-3-methylpiperidine-2-carboxylic acid (e)
To a solution of compound d (51 g, 0.18 mol) in EtOAc under argon was added cat. 10%Pd/C. The reaction was evacuated and purged with hydrogen (2x) from a balloon, and then stirred under a balloon of H2 until starting material was consumed as judged by reverse-phase analytical HPLC (~30h). The reaction mixture was filtered through celite. The celite was washed well with hot MeOH. The combined filtrates were concentrated in vacuo to yield the title compound e as a near colorless solid (25.5g , 99%) which was used without further purification. 1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 3.58 (d, 1H), 3.3 (m, 1H), 2.95-2.85 (m, 1H), 2.60-2.50 (m, 1H), 1.91-1.62 (m, 4H), 1.16 (d, 3H).
(2S,3R)-methyl 3-methylpiperidine-2-carboxylate, chloride salt (f)
Excess HCl in MeOH (from AcCl and MeOH) was added to the crude amino acid compound e (25.5 g) from the previous step and the solution was warmed to reflux until starting material was consumed. An aliquot was removed after 12 h and concentrated in vacuo- crude 1H-NMR indicated complete conversion. The reaction was then concentrated in vacuo to afford the title compound as a pale yellow solid (34 g, 100% yield) which was used without further purification.1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 4.22 (m, 1H), 3.9 (s, 3H), 3.42-3.38 (m, 1H), 3.10- 3.0 (m, 1H), 2.63-2.55 (m, 1H), 1.97-1.70 (m, 4H), 1.03 (d, 3H).
(2S,3R)-1-tert-Butyl 2-methyl 3-methylpiperidine-1,2-dicarboxylate (g)
To a solution of the crude salt compound f (34 g, 0.176mol) from the previous step in THF (350 mL) / H2O (250 mL) at 0 ̊C was added DIEA (92 mL, 3 eq) followed by BOC2O (76 g, 2eq). The reaction was allowed to warm to rt O/N and stirred for ~24h. The reaction was then concentrated to remove the THF, and then diluted with EtOAc, and washed with 1M HCl (3x), NaHCO3 (1x), brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The resulting crude colorless oil was contaminated with BOC2O, but was used without further purification.1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 4.65 (br s, 1.0H), 4.0-3.9 (m, 1.0H), 3.69 (s, 3.0H), 3.3-3.15 (m, 1.0H), 1.9-1.8 (m, 1.0H), 1.8-1.65 (m, 1.0H), 1.65-1.5 (m, 3.0H), 1.44 (s, 9.0H), 1.01 (d, 3.0H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 280.89 [M+Na]+.
(2S,3R)-1-tert-Butyl 2-methyl 3-methyl-6-oxopiperidine-1,2-dicarboxylate (h)
To a 0̊C solution of the crude carbamate compound g from the previous step and RuCl3 (400 mg, 1 mol %) in CH3CN (150 mL) was added dropwise a solution of NaBrO3 (42 g, 0.28 mol) in water (250mL). The reaction was stirred at rt for 6h, and was then diluted with EtOAc and water. The layers were separated and the aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organics were washed with sat aq. NaHSO3, brine, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo. The crude oil was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to afford the title compound as a colorless solid (39.2g, ~79% from e).1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 4.45 (d, 1H), 3.7 (s, 3H), 2.6-2.5 (m, 1H), 2.41-2.23 (m, 2H), 1.7-1.62 (m, 1H), 1.55-1.45 (m, 1H), 1.42 (s, 9H), 0.96 (d, 3H).
(2S,3R)-1-tert-Butyl 2-methyl 3-methyl-3,4-dihydropyridine-1,2(2H)- dicarboxylate (i) To the solution of compound h (39.2 g, 0.145 mol) in THF (400 mL) at -78̊C was added LiBEt3H (1.0 M in THF, 1.1 eq) dropwise. The reaction was stirred at -78 ̊C for 2 h, and then quenched with sat. aq NH4Cl and warmed to rt and diluted with EtOAc. The layers were separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organics were washed with brine, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated.
To a solution of the resulting crude colorless oil in CH2Cl2 (1 L) at -78 ̊C was added DIEA (101 mL, 4eq) followed by the dropwise addition of TFAA (41 mL, 2eq). The reaction was stirred at -78̊C for 3h, and then slowly warmed to rt and monitored for disappearance of sm by tlc analysis. When the reaction was judged complete, it was cooled to 0 ̊C and quenched with sat. aq NaHCO3. The layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo. Purification on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) afforded the title compound as a near colorless oil which solidified (33g, 89%).1H NMR (D6-DMSO, 400 MHz) δ 6.7 (br dd, 1H), 4.85 (dt, 1H), 4.52 (dd, 1H), 3.67 (s, 1.6H), 3.63 (s, 1.4H), 2.15-2.06 (m, 1H), 2.02-1.94 (m, 1H), 1.7-1.6 (m, 1H), 1.45 (s, 4.5H), 1.4 (s, 4.5H), 1.05 (dd, 3H).
(2S, 3R)-1-tert-Butyl 2-methyl 5, 6-dihydroxy-3-methylpiperidine-1, 2-dicarboxylate (j) To a 0̊C solution of enamide compound i (33 g, 0.13 mol) and NMO (23g, 0.19 mol) in acetone (300 mL) and H2O (200 mL) was added OsO4 (4%wt in H2O, 1 mol%). The reaction was allowed to warm to rt O/N whereupon the reaction was judged complete by tlc analysis. The reaction was quenched with sat aq NaHSO3 and diluted with EtOAc. The layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organics were washed with sat aq NaHSO3, brine, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated to give crude diol as a near colorless solid which was used without further purification (35.9 g).1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz) δ 5.86 (br s, 1.0H), 5.37 (br s, 1.0H), 4.67 (d, 1.0H), 4.05 (d, 1.0H), 3.90-3.83 (m, 1.0H), 3.62 (s, 3.0H), 2.67 (br s, 1.0H), 1.58-1.51 (m, 1.0H), 1.41-1.36 (m, 1.0H), 1.35 (s, 9.0H), 0.88 (d, 3.0H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 312.90 [M+Na]+.
(2S, 3R)-1-tert-Butyl 2-methyl 3-methyl-5-oxopiperidine-1,2–dicarboxylate (k)
To a solution of crude diol compound j in CHCl3 (0.8 L) was added p-TsOH (200 mg,). The reaction was warmed to 60̊C and monitored for disappearance of sm by tlc analysis (1-3 h). The reaction was cooled to rt, and washed with sat aq NaHCO3 (2x), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo. The crude ketone was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a pale yellow oil (31.1g, 88% for 2 steps).1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 4.8 (br s, 0.6H), 4.6 (br s, 0.4H), 4.20-4.10 (m, 2H), 3.83 (s, 3H), 2.60-2.3 (m, 3H), 1.48 (br s, 9H).1.12 (br s, 3H).
(2S, 3R)-1-tert-Butyl 2-methyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidine-1,2–dicarboxylate (l)
DAST (64 g, 0.4 mol) was added to a solution of compound k (31.1 g, 0.11 mol) in CH2Cl2 (110 mL) at 0 oC. After stirring overnight at RT, the reaction was carefully quenched into a 0 oC mixture of CH2Cl2/sat aq NaHCO3 and then warmed to rt. The layers were separated and the organic layer was washed with sat aq NaHCO3, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a near colorless oil (26.8 g, 79%).1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 4.9 (br s, 0.6H), 4.65 (br s, 0.4H), 4.33-4.18 (m, 1H), 3.75 (s, 3H), 3.7-3.55 (m, 1H), 2.283 (br s, 1H), 2.1-1.86 (m, 2H), 1.49 (s, 9H).1.2 (d, 3H).
(2S, 3R)-Methyl 5, 5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidine-2-carboxylate (m)
To a solution of compound l (10g, 0.034 mol) in CH2Cl2 (150 mL) at 0 oC was added TFA (50 mL). The reaction was allowed to warm to rt and monitored for disappearance of sm by tlc analysis (3-4h). When complete, the reaction was concentrated in vacuo to give an oil which was used without further purification.1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 4.22 (m, 1H), 3.9 (s, 3H), 3.42-3.38 (m, 1H), 3.10-3.0 (m, 1H), 2.63-2.55 (m, 1H), 1.97-1.70 (m, 4H), 1.03 (d, 3H).
(2S, 3R)-1-Benzyl 2-methyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidine-1,2-dicarboxylate (n)
To a 0 oC solution of crude compound m in THF/sat aq NaHCO3 (400 mL, 1:1 v/v) was added CbzCl (14.6 g, 0.085 mol). The reaction was allowed to warm to rt O/N, and was then diluted with EtOAc. The layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organics were washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a near colorless oil (10.7 g, 96% 2 steps).1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 7.5-7.3 (m, 5H), 5.3-5.1 (m, 2H), 5.0-4.9 (m, 0.6H), 4.85-4.75 (m, 0.4H, 4.5-4.35 (m, 1H), 3.8-3.8 (m, 3H), 3.7- 3.5 (m, 1H), 2.4-2.25 (m, 1H), 2.2-1.9 (m, 2H), 1.15-1.0 (m, 3H).
(2S, 3R)-1-(Benzyloxycarbonyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidine-2-carboxylic acid (o) To a 0 oC solution of compound n (10.7 g) in THF (150 mL) was added 1M LiOH (100 mL). The reaction was allowed to warm to rt O/N. The reaction was diluted with EtOAc, and acidified with 1M HCl until pH ~3. The layers were separated, and the organic phase was washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to give a near colorless oil. The crude acid (9.8 g, 96%) was used without further purification.1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 7.4-7.3 (m, 5H), 5.3-5.1 (m, 2H), 4.85-4.75 (m, 1H), 4.3-4.2 (m, 1H), 3.78-3.5 (m, 1H), 2.35-2.2 (m, 1H), 2.15-2.02 (m, 1H), 2.0-1.85 (m, 1H), 1.15 (t, 3H).
(2S, 3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-2-(hydroxymethyl)-3-methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate (p) To a 0 oC solution of compound o (9.8 g, 0.031mol) in THF (100 mL) was added BH3/THF (1.0 M, 47 mL). The reaction was allowed to warm to rt and monitored by reverse- phase HPLC. Additional BH3/THF (15 mL) was added. After an additional 6 h, sm was consumed by HPLC. The reaction was quenched with MeOH, and concentrated in vacuo. The crude colorless oil was taken up in EtOAc and washed with 1M HCl (2x), brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated to give the title compound (8.8 g, 94%) as a colorless oil, which was used without further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 300.29 [M+1]+.1H NMR (D6-DMSO, 400 MHz) δ 7.4-7.3 (m, 5H), 5.2-5.1 (q, 2H), 4.85-4.7 (m, 1H), 4.5 (d, 0.36H), 4.25-4.1 (m, 1.64H), 3.8-3.7 (m, 1H), 3.6-3.5 (m, 1H), 3.5-3.2 (m, 1H), 2.1-1.9 (m, 2H), 1.0 (br s, 3H).
(2S, 3R)-benzyl 2-((1,3-dioxoisoindolin-2-yl)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidine-1- carboxylate (q)
To a solution of crude compound p (8.8 g, 0.03 mol) in dry toluene (100 mL) was added ADDP (14.9g, 0.059 mol) followed by PBu3 (17.9 g, 0.089 mol). After stirring at rt for 45 min, phthalimide (6.5 g, 0.044 mol) was added and the reaction mixture was warmed to 80 ̊C O/N. After 12 h, starting alcohol compound p was consumed as judged by reverse-phase analytical HPLC analysis. The reaction mixture was cooled to rt, filtered through a SiO2 pad (washing with toluene), and concentrated in vacuo. The resulting crude oil was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to afford the title compound (11 g, ~87 %) contaminated by phthalimide. [The phthalimide could be removed by dissolving in EtOAc and washing with 1M NaOH, but it is also removed in the next step.] ESI-MS (m/z): 429.40 [M+1]+.1H NMR (D6-DMSO, 400 MHz) δ 7.9-7.8 (m, 4H), 7.35-7.2 (m, 2H), 7.18-7.1 (m, 1H), 7.1-7.0 (m, 1H), 6.9 (d, 1H), 4.85- 4.7 (m, 1.5H), 4.5 (d, 1H), 4.48-4.35 (m, 0.5H), 4.25-4.1 (m, 2H), 3.7-3.45 (m, 2H), 2.25-2.0 (m, 3H), 1.1 (t, 3H).
(2S,3R)-Benzyl 2-(aminomethyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate (r)
Hydrazine (6.2 mL, 5 eq) was added to a solution of compound q (11 g, 23 mmol) in MeOH (150 mL). The reaction was warmed to 80 ̊C for 2h wherein sm was consumed as judged by reverse-phase analytical HPLC analysis. The reaction mixture was cooled and concentrated in vacuo. The crude residue was taken up in EtOAc and washed with sat aq NaHCO3 (4x), brine, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound (6.9 g, 90%) as a pale yellow oil which was used without further purification. %). ESI-MS (m/z): 299.3 [M+1]+.
(2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate (s)
(Synthetic procedure is given for the compound in which ArX is 2-Cl-5-CF3- pyrimidine.) To a mixture of the crude amine compound r (2.2 g, 7.4 mmol) and K2CO3 (2g, 14.8 mmol) in DMF (20 mL) was added 2-Cl-5-CF3-pyrimidine (2 g, 11.1mmol). The reaction was warmed to 80 ̊C for 2h wherein the starting material was judged consumed as indicated by reverse-phase analytical HPLC. The reaction was cooled, and diluted with EtOAc, and water. The layers were separated, and the organic phase was washed with water (3x), brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on SiO2
(EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a pale yellow solid (2.4g, 75%). ESI-MS (m/z): 445.4 [M+1]+.
(2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-ium bromide (t)
(Synthetic procedure is given for the compound in which Ar is 5-CF3-pyrimidine.) Carbamate compound s (2.4 g, 5.4 mmol) was added to 30%HBr in HOAc (15 mL). The reaction was stirred at rt (1-3 h) until sm was consumed as judged by HPLC analysis. The reaction was concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound as a pale yellow foam (2.1 g, ~100 %) and was used without purification.1H NMR (D6-DMSO, 400 MHz) δ 9.7 (br s, 1H), 9.15 (br s, 1H), 8.7 (s, 2H), 8.15 (t, 1H), 3.92-3.7 (m, 1H), 3.7-3.5 (m, 4H), 2.4-2.05 (m, 3H), 1.1 (d, 3H).
Compound (u)
To a solution of compound t, HATU (1.5 eq), and a carboxylic acid (1.2 eq) in DMF was added DIEA (3 eq). When the starting amine was consumed as judged by HPLC (anywhere from 30min to 24h depending on the acid used), the reaction was diluted with EtOAc, and washed with sat aq NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to give the desired compound.
Exemplary carboxylic acids include compounds aa-cv.
Compound aa: 4-(5-fluoropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000094_0001
Step 1: ethyl 4-iodo-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000094_0002
To a solution of ethyl 1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate (2 g, 14.3 mol, 1.0 eq) and I2 (3.6 g, 14.3 mmol, 1.0 eq) in ACN (14 mL) was added CAN (1.6 g, 2.86 mmol, 0.2 eq) at RT. The reaction mixture was stirred at RT overnight, and was monitored by reverse-phase analytical HPLC. When starting material was consumed, the reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo to afford a crude solid which was slowly poured into a saturated Na2S2O3 solution and H2O (1:1) with stirring. The light-yellow suspension was filtered and the filter cake was washed with H2O. The resulting near colorless solid was dried under vacuum and used without further purification.1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.86 (s, 1H), 4.46 (q, J=7.2Hz, 2H), 1.45 (t, J=7.2 Hz, 3H).
Step 2: 4-iodo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000095_0001
NaH (60% dispersion in mineral oil, 0.72 g, 18 mmol, 1.2 eq) was added in portions to a mixture of ethyl 4-iodo-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate (4.2 g, 15 mmol, 1.0 eq) and anhydrous THF (15 mL) at 0°C. Once addition of NaH was complete, the mixture was stirred for an additional 30 min at 0°C and 1h at RT. The mixture was re-cooled to 0°C and then MeI (1.0 mL, 16.5 mmol, 1.1 eq) was added. When the reaction mixture solidified, the cold bath was removed and the mixture was maintained at RT for 1h. When the starting material was consumed as judged by analytical HPLC, H2O (0.5 mL) was added slowly to quench the reaction and then NaOH solution (2 M, 1.0 eq) was added slowly with stirring. The mixture was stirred at rt until hydrolysis of the ester was complete (~1-2 h). The light-yellow suspension was filtered and the resulting yellow solid was collected. The filtrate was concentrated in vacuo and then washed with hexanes to remove the mineral oil. The resulting aqueous layer and solid were combined and acidified with 6N HCl to pH 1~2. The aqueous was extracted with EtOAc (3x). The combined organics were washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated to afford the title acid as a pale yellow solid that was used without further purification.
Step 3: tert-butyl 4-iodo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000095_0002
To a mixture of crude 4-iodo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid (3.1 g, 12.5 mmol) and THF (15 mL) was added tert-BuOH (1.2 mL, 12.5 mol, 1.0 eq) and DMAP (0.30 g, 2.5 mmol, 0.2 eq) followed by (Boc)2O (3.5 g, 16.2 mol, 1.3 eq) in portions. The mixture was stirred overnight at RT, and the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When the acid was consumed, the reaction was concentrated in vacuo to afford a crude solid which was dissolved in EtOAc. The resulting organic solution was washed with 2N HCl (3x), H2O, brine and dried (Na2SO4). The solvent was removed in vacuo to obtain the title compound as a pale yellow solid which was used without further purification.1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.50 (s, 1H), 3.96 (s, 3H), 1.65 (s,9H).
Step 4: (3-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid
Figure imgf000096_0001
To a solution of crude tert-butyl 4-iodo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate (1.6 g, 5.1 mmol, 1.0 eq) and B(Oi-Pr)3 (1.8 mL, 7.7 mmol, 1.5 eq) in anhydrous THF (6 mL) at -78°C under argon, was added n-BuLi (2.5M, 3.6 mL, 9.2 mmol) dropwise. The reaction was stirred at -78°C and monitored by analytical HPLC for disappearance of starting material. When complete (1-2 h), H2O (5 mL) was added slowly to quench the reaction and the resulting mixture was slowly warmed to RT. The mixture was then slowly poured into 2N HCl solution to bring the pH 2~3. The reaction mixture was diluted with EtOAc and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organic extracts were washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to provide the crude boronic acid as a brown solid that was used without further purification.
Step 5: tert-butyl 4-(5-fluoropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000096_0002
To the crude boronic acid obtained from previous step was added DMF/H2O (5:1, 9 mL), K2CO3 (1.0 g, 7.7 mmol, 1.5 eq) and 2-chloro-5-fluoropyrimidine (0.76 mL, 6.1 mmol, 1.2 eq). The mixture was degassed, and then Pd(PPh3)4 (0.18 g, 0.13 mmol, 0.025 eq) was added. The mixture was degassed and then heated overnight in an 80°C oil bath under argon. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT, and filtered through a celite pad to remove K2CO3 and Pd. The filter cake was washed with toluene. The filtrate was diluted with toluene was washed with H2O and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with toluene (2x). The combined organic layers were dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to provide the crude as an amber oil that was used without further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 278.58 [M+1]+.
Step 6: 4-(5-fluoropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000097_0001
To a solution of the crude tert-butyl ester obtained from the previous step in DCM (2 mL) was added TFA (1.5 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at RT monitoring by analytical HPLC for disappearance of starting material (3-4 h). When complete, the reaction was concentrated in vacuo to obtain the crude as a dark oil. Toluene was added and the reaction was concentrated in vacuo to remove residual TFA. The crude oil was cooled to 0°C and MeOH was added with stirring. A suspension quickly formed and was stirred for an additional 1h. The suspension was filtered and washed with cold MeOH to give the title compound as a near colorless solid.1H NMR (400 MHz, d-DMSO) δ 14.80 (broad, 1H), 9.10 (s, 2H), 8.55 (s, 1H), 4.00 (s, 3H); ESI- MS (m/z): 222.79 [M+1]+.
Compound ab: 4-(5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000097_0002
Step 1: methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000097_0003
NaH (60% dispersion in mineral oil, 11.3 g, 282 mmol, 3.0 eq) was added in portions to a mixture of 4-bromo-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid (18 g, 94.2 mmol, 1.0 eq) in ) anhydrous DMF (200 mL) at 0 °C under argon protection. Once addition of NaH was complete, the mixture was stirred for an additional 30 min at 0°C and 1h at RT. The mixture was re-cooled to 0°C and then MeI (24 mL, 377 mmol, 4.0 eq) was added. The reaction mixture was diluted with EtOAc and washed with Sat’d NaHCO3, brine and dried over Na2SO4. The organic layers were concentrated to provide the crude as solid that was used without further purification. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.87 (s, 1H), 3.96 (s, 3H), 3.88 (s, 3H).
Step 2: (3-(methoxycarbonyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid
Figure imgf000098_0001
(3-(methoxycarbonyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for (3-(tert-butoxycarbonyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate.
Step 3: methyl 4-(5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000098_0002
To the crude boronic acid (0.86 g, 4.14 mmol) obtained from previous step was added dioxane/H2O (4:1, 42 mL), K2CO3 (1.714 g, 12.41 mmol, 3.0 eq) and 2,5-dichloropyrimidine (0.74 g, 4.14 mmol, 1.2 eq). The mixture was degassed, and then Pd(PPh3)4 (0.48 g, 0.41 mmol, 0.1 eq) was added. The mixture was degassed and then heated overnight in an 80°C oil bath under argon. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT, and filtered through a celite pad to remove K2CO3 and Pd. The filter cake was washed with EtOAc. The filtrate was diluted with EtOAc and washed with H2O and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organic layers were concentrated to provide the crude which was purified by column chromatography on silica gel to obtain the desired product. ESI-MS (m/z): 252.97
[M+1]+.
Step 4: 4-(5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000098_0003
Methyl 4-(5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate (0.22 g, 0.873 mmol) in THF (5 mL) was added NaOH (1.0 M,4 mL, 5.0 eq). The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was acidified to pH~2. The solvent was removed in vacuo. The crude was extracted with MeOH. The solvent was removed and the obtained acid was dried in vacuum for next step with no further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 239.03 [M+1]+.
Compound ac: 1-methyl-4-(4-methylpyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000099_0001
The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for 4-(5- chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using (3-(methoxycarbonyl)-1- methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid and 2-chloro-4-methylpyrimidine. ESI-MS (m/z): 219.0 [M+1]+.
Compound ad: 1-methyl-4-(5-methylpyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000099_0002
The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for 4-(5- chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using (3-(methoxycarbonyl)-1- methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid and 2-chloro-5-methylpyrimidine. ESI-MS (m/z): 219.0 [M+1]+.
Compound ae: 1-methyl-4-(5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000099_0003
The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for 4-(5- chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using (3-(methoxycarbonyl)-1- methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid and 2-chloro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidine. ESI-MS (m/z): 272.95 [M+1]+.
Compound af: 1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000100_0001
Step 1: methyl 1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000100_0002
A mixture of methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate (1.5 g, 6.84 mmol, 1.0 eq), 2-(tributylstannyl)pyrimidine (2.4 mL, 7.52 mmol, 1.1 eq), CsF (2.1 g, 13.67 mmol, 2.0 eq), Pd(PPh3)4 (0.79 g, 0.68 mmol, 0.1 eq) and CuI (0.13 g, 0.68 mmol, 0.1 eq) in DMF (120 mL) was degassed for 10 min and then heated overnight at oil bath at 110°C. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the mixture was cooled and concentrated. The crude was dissolved with EtOAc and washed with Sat’d NaHCO3 and brine. The solvent was removed to obtain the crude, which was purified by silica gel to obtain the desired product. ESI-MS (m/z): 218.99 [M+1]+.
Step 2: 1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000100_0003
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 4-(5- chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using methyl 1-methyl-4- (pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate. ESI-MS (m/z): 204.96 [M+1]+.
Compound ag: 1-methyl-4-(pyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000100_0004
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 203.93 [M+1]+.
Compound ah: 4-(5-fluoropyridin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000101_0001
Ste 1: General Procedure for stannane s nthesis: 5-fluoro-2- tribut lstann l ridine
Figure imgf000101_0002
To a solution of 2-bromo-5-fluoropyridine (2.42 g, 13.75 mmol, 1.0 eq) in THF (30 mL) was added n-BuLi (2.5 M in hexane, 5.5 mL, 13.75 mmol, 1.0 eq) and the mixture was stirred at -78 °C for 30 min under nitrogen atmosphere. n-Bu3SnCl (4 mL, 14.58 mmol, 1.05 eq) was added and the mixture was stirred at the same temperature for another 2 h. Saturated ammonium chloride solution (150 mL) was added to the solution and extracted with ethyl acetate (150 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The crude 5-fluoro-2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine as a yellow oil was used without further purification.
Step 2: 4-(5-fluoropyridin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000101_0003
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 5-fluoro-2- (tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 221.95 [M+1]+.
Compound ai: 4-(3-fluoropyridin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000101_0004
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 3-fluoro-2- (tributylstannyl)pyridine ESI-MS (m/z): 221.95 [M+1]+.
Compound aj: 1-methyl-4-(3-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000102_0001
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 3-methyl-2- (tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 217.92 [M+1]+.
Compound ak: 1-methyl-4-(4-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000102_0002
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 4-methyl-2- (tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 217.92 [M+1]+.
Compound ak: 1-methyl-4-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000102_0003
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 5-methyl-2- (tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 217.92 [M+1]+.
Compound am: 1-methyl-4-(6-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000102_0004
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 2-methyl-6- (tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 217.92 [M+1]+.
Compound an: 4-(6-methoxypyridin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000103_0001
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 2-methoxy-6- (tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 233.94 [M+1]+.
Compound ao: 1-methyl-4-(pyridin-3-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000103_0002
Step 1: methyl 1-methyl-4-(pyridin-3-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000103_0003
The mixture of methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate (0.15 g, 0.684 mmol, 1.0 eq), pyridin-3-ylboronic acid (0.11 g, 0.89 mmol, 1.3 eq) and K2CO3 (0.28 g, 2.05 mmol, 3.0 eq) in dioxane/H2O (4:1, 3 mL was degassed, and then Pd(PPh3)4 (0.08 g, 0.07 mmol, 0.1 eq) was added. The mixture was degassed and then heated for 30 min at 120°C in a microwave reactor. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT and diluted with EtOAc and washed with H2O and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organic layers were concentrated to provide the crude which was purified by column chromatography on silica gel to obtain the desired product. ESI-MS (m/z): 218.08 [M+1]+.
Step 2: 1-methyl-4-(pyridin-3-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000103_0004
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 4-(5- chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using methyl 1-methyl-4- (pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate. ESI-MS (m/z): 203.93 [M+1]+. Compound ap: 4-(2-fluorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000104_0001
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and (2-fluorophenyl)boronic acid ESI-MS (m/z): 220.84 [M+1]+.
Compound aq: 4-(3-fluorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000104_0002
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and (3-fluorophenyl)boronic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 220.84 [M+1]+.
Compound ar: 1-methyl-4-(p-tolyl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000104_0003
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and p-tolylboronic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 216.83 [M+1]+.
Compound as: 1-methyl-4-(o-tolyl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000104_0004
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and o-tolylboronic acid ESI-MS (m/z): 216.83 [M+1]+.
Compound at: 1-methyl-4-(m-tolyl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000105_0001
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and m-tolylboronic acid. ESI- MS (m/z): 216.83 [M+1]+.
Compound au: 4-(3-methoxyphenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000105_0002
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and (3-methoxyphenyl)boronic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 232.84 [M+1]+.
Compound av: 4-(4-methoxyphenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000105_0003
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and (4-methoxyphenyl)boronic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 232.84 [M+1]+.
Compound aw: 4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000105_0004
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and (4-chlorophenyl)boronic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 236.86 [M+1]+.
Compound ax: 1-methyl-4-(6-methylpyridin-3-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000106_0001
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and (6-methylpyridin-3- yl)boronic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 217.92 [M+1]+.
Compound ay: 1,5-dimethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000106_0002
Step 1: tert-butyl 4-bromo-1,5-dimethyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000106_0003
To a mixture of 4-bromo-1,5-dimethyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid (1.0 g, 4.56 mmol, 1.0 eq) and t-BuOH ( 0.87 mL, 9.12 mmol, 2.0 eq) in DCM (15 mL) was added DMAP (0.11 g, 0.91 mmol, 0.2 eq) and DCC (1.13 g, 5.47 mmol, 1.2 eq). The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was diluted with DCM and washed with 0.5 N HCl, water, Sat’d NaHCO3 and brine. The combined organic layers were concentrated to provide the crude which was purified by column chromatography on silica gel to obtain the desired product.1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 3.95 (s, 3H), 2.27 (s, 3H), 1.65 (s,9H). Step 2: tert-butyl 1,5-dimethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000106_0004
The title compound was prepared following the same general protocol as described for
Compound sg using tert-butyl 4-bromo-1,5-dimethyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 2- (tributylstannyl)pyrimidine. ESI-MS (m/z): 274.99 [M+1]+.
Step 3: 1,5-dimethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000107_0001
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using tert-butyl 1,5-dimethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate. ESI-MS (m/z): 218.84 [M+1]+.
Compound az: 5-(5-fluoropyridin-2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000107_0002
Ste 1: 5-fluoro-2- tribut lstann l ridine
Figure imgf000107_0003
To a solution of 2-bromo-5-fluoropyridine (2.42 g, 13.75 mmol, 1.0 eq) in THF (30 mL) was added n-BuLi (2.5 M in hexane, 5.5 mL, 13.75 mmol, 1.0 eq) and the mixture was stirred at -78 °C for 30 min under nitrogen atmosphere. n-Bu3SnCl (4 mL, 14.58 mmol, 1.05 eq) was added and the mixture was stirred at the same temperature for another 2 h. Saturated ammonium chloride solution (150 mL) was added to the solution and extracted with ethyl acetate (150 mL x 3). The combined organic layers were dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The crude 5-fluoro-2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine as a yellow oil was used without further purification.
Step 2: methyl 5-(5-fluoropyridin-2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylate
Figure imgf000107_0004
A mixture of methyl methyl 5-bromo-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylate (0.15 g, 0.635 mmol, 1.0 eq), 5-fluoro-2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine (0.368 g, 0.95 mmol, 1.5 eq), CsF (0.193 g, 13.67 mmol, 2.0 eq), Pd(PPh3)4 (0.073 g, 0.064 mmol, 0.1 eq) and CuI (0.012 g, 0.064 mmol, 0.1 eq) in DMF (4 mL) was degassed for 5 min and then heated for 1h at 120°C in a microwave reactor. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the mixture was cooled and concentrated. The crude was dissolved with EtOAc and washed with Sat’d NaHCO3 and brine. The solvent was removed to obtain the crude, which was purified by silica gel to obtain the desired product. ESI-MS (m/z): 253.07 [M+1]+.
Step 3: 5-(5-fluoropyridin-2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000108_0001
methyl 5-(5-fluoropyridin-2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylate (0.16 g, 0.64 mmol, 1.0 eq) in THF (5 mL) was added NaOH (1M, 3 mL, 5.0 eq). The mixture was heat for 2h at 100°C at oil bath. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was acidified to pH~2. The solvent was removed in vacuo. The crude was purified by silica gel to obtain the desired acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 238.82 [M+1]+.
Compound ba: 5-(4-fluoropyridin-2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000108_0002
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid using 2-bromo-4-fluoropyridine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 238.82 [M+1]+.
Compound bb: 5-(5-methoxypyridin-2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000108_0003
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid using 2-bromo-5-methoxypyridine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 250.81 [M+1]+.
Compound bc: 5-(6-methoxypyridin-2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000109_0001
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid using 2-bromo-6-methoxypyridine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 250.81 [M+1]+.
Compound bd: 2-methyl-5-(3-methylpyridin-2-yl)thiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000109_0002
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid using 2-bromo-3-methylpyridine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 234.79 [M+1]+.
Compound be: 2-methyl-5-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)thiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000109_0003
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5- fluoropyridin-2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid using 2-bromo-5-methylpyridine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 234.79 [M+1]+.
Compound bf: 2-methyl-5-(6-methylpyridin-2-yl)thiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000109_0004
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid using 2-bromo-6-methylpyridine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 234.79 [M+1]+.
Compound bg: 2-methyl-5-(4-methylpyridin-2-yl)thiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000110_0001
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid using 2-bromo-4-methylpyridine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 234.79 [M+1]+.
Compound bh: 2-methyl-5-(pyridin-2-yl)thiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000110_0002
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine in Step 2. ESI-MS (m/z): 220.82 [M+1]+.
Compound bi: 2-methyl-5-(pyrimidin-2-yl)thiazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000110_0003
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyrimidine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 221.26 [M+1]+.
Compound bj: 5-methyl-2-(pyridin-2-yl)thiophene-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000110_0004
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid in Compound az using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine and ethyl 2-bromo-5-methylthiophene-3-carboxylate in Step 2. ESI-MS (m/z): 219.94 [M+1]+. Compound bk: 2-methyl-5-(pyridin-2-yl)oxazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000111_0001
Step 1: ethyl 5-bromo-2-methyloxazole-4-carboxylate
Figure imgf000111_0002
A mixture of tert-butyl nitrite (1.25 mL, 10.50 mmol, 2.0 eq) and CuBr2 (1.76 g, 7.87 mmol, 1.5 eq) in acetonitrile (15 mL) was stirred at 0°C and a solution of ethyl 5-amino-2-methyloxazole- 4-carboxylate (0.89 g, 5.248 mmol, 1.0 eq) in acetonitrile (20 mL) was added dropwise. The reaction mixture was stirred overnight at RT. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with water and brine, and concentrated in vacuo. The crude was purified by chromatography on silica gel to obtain the desired product.
Step 2: 2-methyl-5-(pyridin-2-yl)oxazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000111_0003
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid in Compound az using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine and ethyl 5-bromo-2-methyloxazole-4-carboxylate in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 204.93 [M+1]+.
Compound bl: 1-methyl-3-(pyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000111_0004
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid in Compound az using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine and ethyl 3-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-4-carboxylate in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 203.93 [M+1]+. Compound bm: 1-methyl-5-(pyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000111_0005
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid in Compound az using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine and ethyl 5-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-4-carboxylate in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 203.93 [M+1]+. Compound bn: 4-cyano-4'-fluoro-[1,1'-biphenyl]-2-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000112_0001
The mixture of 2-bromo-5-cyanobenzoic acid (0.2 g, 0.89 mmol, 1.0 eq), 2-(4-fluorophenyl)- 4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolane (0.39 g, 1.77 mmol, 2.0 eq) and K2CO3 (0.37 g, 2.655 mmol, 3.0 eq) in DMF( 4.5 Ml) was degassed, and then Pd(dppf)Cl2 (0.07 g, 0.09 mmol, 0.1 eq) was added. The mixture was degassed and then heated for 2h at 120°C in a microwave reactor. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT and acidified to pH5. The mixture was concentrated to provide the crude which was purified by column chromatography on silica gel to obtain the desired product. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.16 (d, J=1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.91 (dd, J =8.2 Hz, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.57 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.39 (m, 2H), 7.17 (m, 2H).
Compound bo: 5-fluoro-2-(2H-tetrazol-2-yl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000112_0002
To a 20 mL microwave tube was added 2-bromo-5-fluorobenzoic acid (1.08 g, 4.93 mmol, 1.0 eq), Cs2CO3 (3 g, 9.86 mmol, 2.0 eq), CuI (0.09 g, 0.49 mmol, 0.1 eq) and DMF (10 mL). N, N'- dimethylglycine (0.09 g, 0.99 mmol, 0.2 eq) was added and the mixture was irradiated at 120°C for 1h. The reaction mixture was cooled to RT and acidified to pH5. The mixture was concentrated to provide the crude which was purified by column chromatography on silica gel to obtain the desired product. ESI-MS (m/z): 208.88 [M+1]+.
Compound bp: 5-chloro-2-(2H-tetrazol-2-yl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000112_0003
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described 5-fluoro-2-(2H-tetrazol- 2-yl)benzoic acid using 5-chloro-2-iodobenzoic acid.1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 9.30 (s, 1H), 8.06 (d, J =1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.96 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 7.92 (d, J=8.2Hz, 1H). ESI-MS (m/z): 224.88 [M+1]+.
Compound bq: 5-chloro-2-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000113_0001
Step 1: methyl 2-bromo-5-chlorobenzoate
Figure imgf000113_0002
To a mixture of 2-bromo-5-chlorobenzoic acid (10.4 g, 44.16 mmol, 1.0 eq) in MeOH (250 mL) at ice bath was added slowly SOCl2 (4.8 mL, 66.24 mmol, 1.5 eq). The reaction mixture was warm to RT and heated at 80°C oil bath overnight. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT and concentrated. The crude was dissolved with EtOAc and washed with Sat’d NaHCO3, brine and dried over Na2SO4. The organic layer was concentrated to obtain the desired product for the next step with no further purification.
Step 2: methyl 5-chloro-2-cyanobenzoate
Figure imgf000113_0003
A mixture of methyl 2-bromo-5-chlorobenzoate (8.275 g, 33.17 mmol, 1.0 eq) and ZnCN (2.03 g, 17.25 mmol, 0.52 eq) in DMF( 40mL) was degassed, and then Pd(PPh3)4(0.767 g, 0.66 mmol, 0.02 eq) was added. The mixture was heated overnight at 90°C at oil bath. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT and concentrated to provide the crude which was purified by column chromatography on silica gel to obtain the desired product.
Step 3: methyl 5-chloro-2-(2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoate
Figure imgf000114_0001
A mixture of methyl 5-chloro-2-cyanobenzoate (5.31 g, 26.11 mmol, 1.0 eq), NaN3 (5.1 g, 78.33 mmol, 3.0 eq) and triethylamine hydrochloride (10.8 g, 78.33 mmol, 3.0 eq) in toluene (100 mL) was heated overnight at 100°C oil bath. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT and concentrated to provide the crude which was purified by column chromatography on silica gel to obtain the desired product. ESI-MS (m/z): 238.98 [M+1]+.
Step 4: methyl 5-chloro-2-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoate
Figure imgf000114_0002
To a mixture of methyl 5-chloro-2-(2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoate (1.411 g, 5.91 mmol, 1.0 eq) and K2CO3 (1.23 g, 8.87 mmol, 1.5 eq) in DMF (20 mL) was added MeI (0.55 mL, 8.87 mmol, 1.5 eq). The mixture was stirred overnight at 50°C oil bath. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT and concentrated to provide the crude, which was dissolved with EtOAc, washed with water, sat’d NaHCO3 and brine. The organic layer was concentrated to obtain the crude which was purified by column chromatography on silica gel to obtain the major fraction which is the desired product. ESI-MS (m/z): 252.92 [M+1]+.
Step 5: 5-chloro-2-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000114_0003
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid in Compound az in Step 2 using methyl 5-chloro-2-(2- methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoate. ESI-MS (m/z): 238.90 [M+1]+.
Compound br: 5-methyl-2-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000115_0001
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-chloro-2-(2- methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid in Compound bq using methyl 2-cyano-5-methylbenzoate. . ESI-MS (m/z): 218.90 [M+1]+.
Compound bs: 5: 5-methyl-2-(1-methyl-1H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000115_0002
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-chloro-2-(2- methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid in Compound bq using methyl 2-cyano-5-methylbenzoate and was the minor isomer isolated from the reaction.. ESI-MS (m/z): 218.9 [M+1]+.
Compound bt: 5-chloro-2-(3-methyl-1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000115_0003
Step 1: methyl 5-chloro-2-methylbenzoate
Figure imgf000115_0004
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described 5-chloro-2-(2-methyl- 2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid in step 1, using 5-chloro-2-methylbenzoic acid .
Step 2: methyl 2-(bromomethyl)-5-chlorobenzoate
Figure imgf000115_0005
A solution of compound 2 (6.95 g, 37.63, 1.0 eq mmol), N-bromosuccinimide (7.03 g, 39.51 mmol, 1.05 eq) and benzoyl peroxide (0.55 g, 2.26 mmol, 0.06 eq) in carbon tetrachloride (50 mL) was heated to reflux for overnight. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT and concentrated to provide the crude, which was dissolved with EtOAc, washed with sat’d NaHCO3, dried over sodium sulfate, concentrated and purified by flash column chromatography to afford the desired product.
Step 3: methyl 5-chloro-2-formylbenzoate
Figure imgf000116_0001
A mixture of methyl 2-(bromomethyl)-5-chlorobenzoate (9.9 g, 37.63 mmol, 1.0 eq) and N- methylmorpholine oxide (10.0 g, 94.08 mmol, 2.5 eq) in DMSO (40 mL) was stirred overnight at RT. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with sat’d NaHCO3, dried over sodium sulfate, concentrated and purified by flash column chromatography to afford the desired product.
Step 4: 4-chloro-2-(methoxycarbonyl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000116_0002
methyl 5-chloro-2-formylbenzoate (3.3 g, 16.60 mmol, 1.0 eq) was dissolved in t-BuOH (160 mL) and water (16 mL). Then 2-methyl-2-butene (8.8 mL, 83.0 mmol, 5 eq) and NaH2PO4 (2.0 g, 16.60 mmol, 1.0 eq) were added. To the stirred suspension was portionwise added
NaClO2 (3.8 g, 33.2 mmol, 2 eq.) at rt. After 1 hr at rt, the mixture was diluted with AcOEt and water, then acidified with aqueous KHSO4 solution to approximately pH 4. The organic extract was washed with brine, dried over Na2SO4 , filtered and concentrated to give crude which was used for next step without purification.
Step 5: methyl (Z)-2-((((1-aminoethylidene)amino)oxy)carbonyl)-5-chlorobenzoate 4-chloro-2- (methoxycarbonyl)benzoate
Figure imgf000116_0003
To a mixture of 4-chloro-2-(methoxycarbonyl)benzoic acid (0.414 g, 1.93 mmol, 1.0 eq) and DMF (1 drop) in DCM (10 mL) at 0 °C was added oxalyl chloride (0.18 mL, 2.10 mmol, 1.1 eq) dropwise. Gas evolution commenced immediately and after 5 min the ice bath was removed. When gas evolution had ceased and the mixture was stirred at RT for another hour and then concentrated. The crude was dissolved in fresh DCM (10 mL) and treated with N- hydroxyacetamidine (0.17 g, 2.31 mmol, 1.2 eq) in several portions followed by TEA (0.8 mL, 5.79 mmol, 3.0 eq). The mixture was stirred overnight at RT and then concentrated in vacuo to obtain the crude, which was purified by flash column chromatography to afford mixture of (Z)- isomer and (E)-isomer. ESI-MS (m/z): 270.92 [M+1]+.
Step 6: methyl 5-chloro-2-(3-methyl-1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl)benzoate
Figure imgf000117_0001
The mixture (obtained from the above step) in Toluene (10 mL) was refluxed overnight. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with sat’d NaHCO3, dried over sodium sulfate, concentrated and purified by flash column chromatography to afford the desired product. ESI-MS (m/z): 252.94 [M+1]+.
Step 7: 5-chloro-2-(3-methyl-1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000117_0002
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid Compound az in Step 2 using methyl 5-chloro-2-(3- methyl-1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl)benzoate. ESI-MS (m/z): 238.94 [M+1]+.
Compound bu: 1-ethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000117_0003
Step 1: methyl 4-bromo-1-ethyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate
Figure imgf000118_0001
A solution of methyl 4-bromo-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate (1eq), EtI (1.4eq) and triethylamine (3 eq) in dichloromethane (10 mL) was stirred at room temperature overnight. After removal of solvent under reduced pressure, the residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (10 mL) and washed with 1 M HCl (5 mL), brine (5 mL), dried over Na2SO4. Removal of solvent under reduced pressure afforded the title compound as a colorless oil. ESI-MS (m/z): 232.62 [M+H]+
Step 2: methyl 1-ethyl-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3- carboxylate
Figure imgf000118_0002
A mixture of methyl 4-bromo-1-ethyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate (1 eq), 4,4,4',4',5,5,5',5'- octamethyl-2,2'-bi(1,3,2-dioxaborolane) (1 eq), KOAc (2 eq) and Pd(dppf)Cl2 (5 mol%) in 1,4- dioxane (10 mL) was stirred at 100 oC overnight. The precipitate was removed by filtration and the filtrate was used for next step without further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 281.64 [M+H]+ Step 3: 1-ethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000118_0003
To the solution of methyl 1-ethyl-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole- 3-carboxylate from the last step were added 2-bromopyrimidine (1.1 eq), Na2CO3 (2 eq), Pd(PPh3)4 (10 mol%), 1,4-dioxane (20 mL) and H2O (5 mL). The mixture was stirred at 100 oC overnight. After removal of solvents under reduced pressure, the residue was purified by prep- HPLC to afford the title compound as a colorless solid. ESI-MS (m/z): 219.18 [M+H]+
Compound bv: 1-isopropyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000119_0001
The title compound was synthesized as a colorless solid following the same general protocol as described for 1-ethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using methyl 4-bromo- 1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 2-iodopropane. ESI-MS (m/z): 232.81 [M+H]+
Compound bw: 4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1-(2,2,2-trifluoroethyl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000119_0002
The title compound was synthesized as a colorless solid following the same general protocol as described for 1-ethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using methyl 4-bromo- 1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 2,2,2-trifluoroethyl trifluoromethanesulfonate. ESI-MS (m/z): 272.88 [M+H]+
Compound bx: 5-fluoro-2-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid
Figure imgf000119_0003
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-chloro-2-(2- methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid in Compound bq using methyl 2-cyano-5-fluorobenzoate. ESI-MS (m/z): 222.90 [M+1]+.
Compound by: 4-(5-chloropyridin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000119_0004
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 5-chloro-2- (tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 237.78 [M+1]+.
Compound bz: 4-(4-chloropyridin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000120_0001
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 4-chloro-2- (tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 237.78 [M+1]+.
Compound ca: 4-(5-methoxypyridin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000120_0002
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound af using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 4-methoxy-2- (tributylstannyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 233.94 [M+1]+.
Compound cb: 1-methyl-4-phenyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000120_0003
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and phenylboronic acid. ESI- MS (m/z): 202.86 [M+1]+.
Compound cc: 4-(4-fluorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000120_0004
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and (4-fluorophenyl)boronic acid ESI-MS (m/z): 220.84 [M+1]+.
Compound cd: 4-(3-chlorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000121_0001
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and (3-chlorophenyl)boronic acid ESI-MS (m/z): 236.86 [M+1]+.
Compound ce: 5-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-methyloxazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000121_0002
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using ethyl 5-bromo-2-methyloxazole-4-carboxylate and (4-fluorophenyl)boronic acid. ESI- MS (m/z): 221.86 [M+1]+.
Compound cf: 2-methyl-5-phenyloxazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000121_0003
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using ethyl 5-bromo-2-methyloxazole-4-carboxylate and phenylboronic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 203.87 [M+1]+.
Compound cg: 2-methyl-5-(pyridin-3-yl)oxazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000121_0004
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using ethyl 5-bromo-2-methyloxazole-4-carboxylate and 3-pyridylboronic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 204.93 [M+1]+.
Compound ch: 2-methyl-5-(pyridin-2-yl)-2H-1,2,3-triazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000122_0001
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-(5-fluoropyridin- 2-yl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid in Compound az using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyridine and methyl 5-bromo-2-methyl-2H-1,2,3-triazole-4-carboxylate in Step 2. ESI-MS (m/z): 204.97 [M+1]+.
Compound ci: 2-methyl-5-phenyl-2H-1,2,3-triazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000122_0002
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 5-bromo-2-methyl-2H-1,2,3-triazole-4-carboxylate and phenylboronic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 203.20 [M+1]+.
Compound cj: 5-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-methyl-2H-1,2,3-triazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000122_0003
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound ao using methyl 5-bromo-2-methyl-2H-1,2,3-triazole-4-carboxylate and (4-fluorophenyl)boronic acid ESI-MS (m/z): 221.19 [M+1]+.
Compound ck: 5-(5-chloropyridin-2-yl)-2-methyl-2H-1,2,3-triazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000122_0004
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 4-(5- fluoropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid in Compound aa using 5-bromo- 2-methyl-2H-1,2,3-triazole-4-carboxylic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 238.81 [M+1]+.
Compound cl: 6-methoxy-3-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)picolinic acid
Figure imgf000123_0001
Step 1: 5-bromo-2-methoxypyridine 1-oxide
Figure imgf000123_0002
To a solution of 5-bromo-2-methoxypyridine (1 eq) in CHCl3 was added MCPBA (4 eq). The reaction was warmed to 100 ˚C for 2h, and then cooled to room temperature. The reaction was cooled to 0 ˚C and quenched with aqueous Na2S2O3 solution and saturated aqueous NaHCO3. The layers were separated, and the organic layer was washed with sat. aq. NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated to give the title compound which was used without further purification.
Step 2: 3-bromo-6-methoxypicolinonitrile
Figure imgf000123_0003
To a solution of 5-bromo-2-methoxypyridine 1-oxide (1eq) in CH3CN was added TEA (3eq) followed by TMSCN (4eq). The reaction was warmed to 100 ˚C for 14h, and then cooled and quenched with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 and diluted with EtOAc. The layers were separated, and the organic layer was washed with sat. aq. NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound which was purified by chromatography on SiO2
(EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound. ESI-MS (m/z): 213.19 [M+1]+.
Step 3: 3-bromo-6-methoxypicolinic acid
Figure imgf000123_0004
To a solution of 3-bromo-6-methoxypicolinonitrile (1eq) in EtOH was added NaOH (3eq). The reaction was warmed to 100 ˚C for 12 h, and then cooled and acidified with 2M HCl until the pH ~4-5. The reaction was concentrated to remove the EtOH, and then diluted with EtOAc and water. The layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound which was used without further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 231.99 [M+1]+.
Step 4: 6-methoxy-3-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)picolinic acid
Figure imgf000124_0001
A mixture of 3-bromo-6-methoxypicolinic acid (1 eq), 1,2,3-triazole (2 eq), (1S,2S)-N1,N2- dimethylcyclohexane-1,2-diamine (0.2 eq), Cs2CO3 (2 eq) and CuI (0.5 mol%) in dioxane/H2O (200/1) was degassed and heated at 100 ˚C for 4h. The reaction was cooled to RT, diluted with MeOH, and acidified with AcOH to pH ~4-5. The solvent was removed in vacuo to obtain the crude which was purified by silica gel chromatography (0~100% DCM/EtOAc) to obtain the title compound. ESI-MS (m/z): 221.1, [M+1]+.
Compound cm: 3-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)-6-(trifluoromethyl)picolinic acid
Figure imgf000124_0002
The title compound was made following the same general protocol as described for Compound cl starting with 5-bromo-2-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 259.1 [M+1]+.
Compound cn: 6-methyl-3-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)picolinic acid
Figure imgf000124_0003
The acid was prepared following the same general protocol as described for 5-chloro-2-(2- methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)benzoic acid in Compound bq using methyl methyl 3-cyano-6- methylpicolinate. ESI-MS (m/z): 220.23 [M+1]+.
Compound co: 1-methyl-4-(6-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000124_0004
The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for 4-(5- chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using (3-(methoxycarbonyl)-1- methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid and 2-bromo-6-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 272.05 [M+1]+.
Compound cp: 1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-5-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000125_0001
The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for 4-(5- chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using (3-(methoxycarbonyl)-1- methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid and 5-bromopyrimidine. ESI-MS (m/z): 205.03 [M+1]+. Compound cq: 1-methyl-4-(pyrazin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000125_0002
The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for 4-(5- chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid using (3-(methoxycarbonyl)-1- methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)boronic acid and 2-bromopyrazine. ESI-MS (m/z): 205.11 [M+1]+. Compound cr: 1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-4-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000125_0003
Step 1: 1-methyl-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000125_0004
A mixture of methyl 4-bromo-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid (1eq), 4,4,4',4',5,5,5',5'- octamethyl-2,2'-bi(1,3,2-dioxaborolane) (1 eq), KOAc (2 eq) and Pd(dppf)Cl2 (5 mol%) in 1,4- dioxane (10 mL) was stirred at 100 oC overnight. The precipitate was removed by filtration and the filtrate was used for next step without further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 267.20 [M+1]+. Step 2: 1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-4-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000126_0001
To the solution of crude 1-methyl-4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole- 3-carboxylic acid from Step 1 were added 4-chloropyrimidine (1.1 eq), Na2CO3 (2 eq),
Pd(PPh3)4 (10 mol%), 1,4-dioxane (20 mL) and H2O (5 mL). The mixture was stirred at 100 oC overnight. After removal of solvents under reduced pressure, the residue was purified by prep- HPLC to afford the title compound as a colorless solid. ESI-MS (m/z): 205.17 [M+1]+.
Compound cs: 5,6'-dimethyl-[2,3'-bipyridine]-2'-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000126_0002
Step 1: 5,6'-dimethyl-[2,3'-bipyridine]-2'-carbonitrile
Figure imgf000126_0003
To a mixture of 3-bromo-6-methylpicolinonitrile (1.0 eq), (5-methylpyridin-2-yl)boronic acid (1.3 eq) and K2CO3 (3.0 eq) in dioxane/H2O (4:1) was added Pd(PPh3)4 (10mol %). The mixture was degassed and then heated for 30 min at 120°C in a microwave reactor. The completion of the reaction was monitored by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT and diluted with EtOAc and washed with H2O and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organic layers were concentrated to provide the crude which was purified by column chromatography on silica gel to obtain the desired product. ESI-MS (m/z): 210.09 [M+1]+.
Step 2: 5,6'-dimethyl-[2,3'-bipyridine]-2'-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000126_0004
A mixture of 5,6'-dimethyl-[2,3'-bipyridine]-2'-carbonitrile (1.0 eq) and NaOH (5eq) in
MeOH/H2O (1/1) was warmed to reflux overnight. After 12h, the reaction was concentrated to remove the MeOH. EtOAc was added, and 2M HCl was added until pH ~6. The layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organics were washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated to afford the title acid as a near colorless solid which was used without further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 229.26 [M+1]+.
Compound ct: 4-(5-fluoropyrimidin-2-yl)-1,5-dimethyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000127_0001
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described for Compound aa using tert-butyl 4-bromo-1,5-dimethyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylate and 2-chloro-5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidine. ESI-MS (m/z): 236.80 [M+1]+.
Compound cu: 6-methyl-3-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)picolinic acid
Figure imgf000127_0002
Step 1: methyl 6-methyl-3-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)picolinate
Figure imgf000127_0003
To a solution of methyl 3-bromo-6-methylpicolinate (1 eq) and (1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4- yl)boronic acid (1.5 eq) in DMF/H2O (5:1) was added K2CO3 (1.5 eq) and Pd(PPh3)4 (2.5 mol%). The mixture was degassed and then heated overnight in an 80°C oil bath under argon. When the reaction was complete as judged by analytical HPLC, the reaction mixture was cooled to RT, and filtered through a celite pad to remove K2CO3 and Pd. The filter cake was washed with toluene. The filtrate was diluted with toluene was washed with H2O and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with toluene (2x). The combined organic layers were dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated to provide the title compound which was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex). ESI-MS (m/z): 213.95 [M+1]+. Step 2: 6-methyl-3-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)picolinic acid
Figure imgf000128_0001
Methyl 6-methyl-3-(1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-4-yl)picolinate was stirred in THF/1M LiOH (1/1 v:v) until starting material was consumed as judged by analytical HPLC. When complete, the reaction was diluted with EtOAc, and 1M HCl was added to adjust the pH ~5-6. The layers were separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (2x). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated to afford the title compound as a solid that was used without further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 217.97[M+1]+.
Compound cv: 6-chloro-1,2-dimethyl-1H-benzo[d]imidazole-4-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000128_0002
To a solution of methyl 2,3-diamino-5-chlorobenzoate (1eq) and 1,1,1-trimethoxyethane (5eq) in MeOH was added NH2SO3H. The reaction was stirred at room temperature for 12 h, and then concentrated in vacuo. The crude was taken up in EtOAc, and washed with sat. aq. NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo. Purification by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex afforded the benzimidazole.
To a solution of the benzimidazole inTHF was added NaH (1.4 eq). After 30min, MeI (2eq) was added. When the starting material was consumed as judged by analytical HPLC, the reaction was quenched with 0.5 M HCl, and diluted with EtOAc. The layers were separated, and the organic layer was washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo. The crude N- methyl benzimidazole was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex).
To a solution of the crude N-methyl benzimidazole in MeOH/H2O was added 1M KOH. The reaction was warmed to 50̊C until starting material was consumed as judged by T.L.C. analysis. The reaction was cooled to room temperature, acidified with 2 M HCl until the pH was ~5-6, and concentrated in vacuo. The crude was taken up in EtOAc and water, and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated to give the title compound as a light yellow solid. ESI-MS (m/z): 225.1 [M+1]+. Synthesis of Compounds 1 and 2
Compound 1: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-fluoro-2-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)phenyl)methanone
Figure imgf000129_0001
Step 1: (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate.
Figure imgf000129_0002
To a mixture of (2S,3R)-Benzyl 2-(aminomethyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate (1 eq) and K2CO3 (2 eq) in DMF (20 mL) was added 2-chloro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidine (2 eq). The reaction was warmed to 80̊C for 2h wherein the starting material was judged consumed as indicated by reverse-phase analytical HPLC. The reaction was cooled, and diluted with EtOAc, and water. The layers were separated, and the organic phase was washed with water (3x), brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a near colorless oil which solidified. ESI-MS (m/z): 445.4 [M+1]+.
Step 2: N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin- 2-amine hydrobromide.
Figure imgf000129_0003
To the carbamate from the previous step was added to 30%HBr in HOAc. The reaction was stirred at rt (1-2 h) until sm was consumed as judged by HPLC analysis. The reaction was concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound as a pale yellow foam which was used without further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 311.3 [M+1]+. Step 3: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-fluoro-2-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)phenyl)methanone.
Figure imgf000130_0001
To a solution of N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-amine hydrobromide (10 mg) in DMF (0.5mL) was added DIEA (3eq) followed by 5-fluoro-2-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)benzoic acid (6mg) and HATU (8 mg). The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature for 15 h, and was then diluted with EtOAc and washed with 1 M HCl, sat aq. NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on silica gel (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a colorless oil which solidified. ESI-MS (m/z): 500.09 [M+1]+.
Compound 2: ((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3- methylpiperidin-1-yl)(5-fluoro-2-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)phenyl)methanone
Figure imgf000130_0002
Step 1: (2S,3R)-benzyl 2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3- methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate.
Figure imgf000130_0003
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1 using 2,5-dichloropyrimidine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 411.2 [M+1]+.
Step 2: 5-chloro-N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)pyrimidin-2-amine
Figure imgf000131_0001
The title compound was prepared following the same general protocol as described in
Compound 1, Step 2. ESI-MS (m/z): 277.1 [M+1]+.
Step 3: ((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1- l 5-fluoro-2- 2H-123-triazol-2- l hen l methanone
Figure imgf000131_0002
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1, Step 3, using 5-fluoro-2-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)benzoic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 466.19 [M+1]+. Compounds 3-15, 19-53, 58-98, 100-101, 103-119, 121-161, 163-203, 210-211, 217-219, 221, 224-227, 229-233, 237-242, 249-250, 252-253, and 254 were prepared in a manner analogous to that shown above for Compound 1.
Compound 68: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-methylthiazol-4-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000131_0003
1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 8.42 (s, 2H), 7.44-7.39 (m, 2H), 7.18-7.13 (m, 2H), 4.9-4.77 (m, 1H), 4.20 (br s, 1H), 3.82-3.60 (m, 1H), 3.47 (m, 2H), 3.4-3.25 (m, 1H), 2.45 (s, 3H), 2.0-1.75 (m, 2H), 1.35-1.1 (m, 2H), 0.87 (d, 3H); ESI-MS (m/z): 530.12 [M+1]+.
Compound 97: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000132_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.80-8.79 (m, 2H), 8.54 (s, 0.6H), 8.45-8.42 (m, 1.4H), 8.20 (s, 0.6H), 8.10 (s, 0.4H), 7.25-7.20 (m, 0.4H), 7.13-7.09 (m, 1H), 7.02-7.0 (m, 0.6H), 5.29-5.26 (m, 0.6H), 5.20-5.05 (t, 0.4H), 4.25-4.16 (m, 0.6H), 4.10-4.05 (m, 0.4H), 3.99 (s, 1.9H), 3.97 (s, 1.1H), 3.9-3.7 (m, 1H), 3.55-3.45 (m, 1H), 3.40-3.25 (m, 0.6H), 3.10-3.0 (m, 0.4H), 2.6-2.45 (m, 1H), 2.4-2.1 (m, 1H), 2.05-1.75 (m, 1H), 1.20 (d, 1.9H), 0.99 (d, 1.1H); ESI-MS (m/z): 497.38 [M+1]+.
Compound 98: ((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3- methylpiperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl- -(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000132_0002
1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz) δ 8.79-8.78 (d, 0.6H), 8.63-8.62 (d, 1.4H), 8.48 (s, 0.3H), 8.4- 8.3 (br s, 0.5H), 8.26 (s, 0.7H), 8.2-8.1 (m, 1.5H), 7.32-7.28 (m, 1H), 7.23-7.21 (m, 0.7H), 7.05- 7.0 (m, 0.3H), 5.0-4.95 (m, 0.3H), 4.85-4.75 (m, 0.7H), 4.0-3.95 (m, 0.7H), 3.91 (s, 1H), 3.85- 3.8 (m, 0.3H), 3.67 (s, 2H), 3.7-3.3 (m, 3H), 2.10-1.95 (m, 3H), 1.10 (d, 1H), 0.80 (d, 2H); ESI- MS (m/z): 463.2 [M+1]+.
Compound 159: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000132_0003
1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz) δ 8.71-8.69 (d, 0.4H), 8.62-8.60 (d, 1.6H), 8.43 (s, 0.4H), 8.18 (s, 1.6H), 7.95 (br s, 1H), 7.88 (s, 1H), 7.27-7.21 (m, 1H), 5.0-4.79 (m, 1H), 3.85 (s, 0.5H), 4.0- 3.75 (m, 1H), 3.55 (s, 2.5H), 3.6-3.50 (m, 2H), 3.40-3.30 (m, 1H), 2.15-1.95 (m, 3H), 1.11 (d, 0.5H), 0.82 (d, 2.5H); ESI-MS (m/z): 497.24 [M+1]+.
Compound 200: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl) -methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000133_0001
1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz) δ 8.73 (d, 0.6H), 8.64 (d, 1.4H), 8.5 (s, 0.3H), 8.45 (br s, 0.3H), 8.20 (s, 0.7H), 8.15 (s, 0.7H), 7.7-7.6 (m, 0.3H), 7.55-7.5 (m, 0.7H), 7.30-7.25 (m, 0.3H), 7.25- 7.15 (m, 1.7H), 6.60-6.50 (m, 0.3H), 6.45-6.35 (m, 0.7H), 5.0-4.9 (br s, 0.2H), 4.85-4.75 (m, 0.7H), 3.90 (s, 0.7H), 3.95-3.9 (m, 0.5H), 3.59 (s, 2.3H), 3.65-3.45 (m, 2.5H), 3.40-3.30 (m, 1H), 2.20-1.95 (m, 3H), 1.15 (d, 0.7H), 0.83 (d, 2.3H); ESI-MS (m/z): 496.15 [M+1]+.
Compound 202: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(6-methoxy-3-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)pyridin-2- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000133_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.38-8.14 (m, 2H), 7.89 (s, 1H), 7.74 (s, 1H), 7.6-7.55 (m, 0.5H), 7.55-7.45 (m, 0.5H), 6.95-6.92 (m, 1H), 6.6-6.35 (m, 2H), 5.2-5.05 (m, 0.5H), 5.0-4.9 (m, 0.5H), 4.25-4.15 (m, 0.5H), 3.98 (s, 1.6H), 3.92 (s, 1.4H), 3.9-3.6 (m, 2.5H), 3.5-3.35 (m, 0.5H), 3.1- 2.95 (m, 0.5H), 2.8-2.7 (m, 0.5H), 2.5-2.4 (m, 0.5H), 2.3-2.0 (m, 2H), 1.4 (d, 1.6H), 1.08 (d, 1.4H); ESI-MS (m/z): 512.5 [M+1]+.
Compound 203: (3-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)-6-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5- difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000134_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.66-8.60 (m, 1H), 8.37-8.33 (m, 1H), 7.95-7.84 (m, 3H), 7.58- 7.54 (m, 1H), 6.6-6.4 (m, 2H), 5.2-5.1 (m, 0.2H), 4.99-4.92 (t, 0.8H), 4.20-4.00 (m, 1.5H), 4.0- 3.7 (m, 0.5H), 3.5-3.3 (m, 1H), 3.15-3.0 (dd, 1H), 2.70 (br s, 0.8H), 2.5 (br s, 0.2H), 2.3-2.2 (m, 1H), 2.1-1.95 (m, 1H), 1.2 (d, 0.6H), 1.02 (d, 2.4H); ESI-MS (m/z): 550.2 [M+1]+.
Compound 217: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(4-(5-fluoropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000134_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.8 (s, 1.2H), 8.7 (s, 0.8H), 8.6-8.45 (m, 2H), 8.15 (s, 0.6H), 8.0 (s, 0.4H), 7.1 (br s, 0.6H), 6.8 (m, 0.4H), 5.35-5.25 (m, 0.6H), 5.2-5.1 (m, 0.4H), 4.2-4.1 (m, 1H), 3.98 (s, 1.6H), 3.97 (s, 1.4H), 3.9-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.6-3.55 (m, 0.6H), 3.5-3.4 (m, 0.4H), 3.35-3.2 (m, 0.6H), 3.2-3.0 (m, 0.4H), 2.6-2.35 (m, 1H), 2.3-2.1 (m, 1H), 2-1.8 (m, 1H), 1.2 (d, 1.8H), 1.0 (d, 1.2H); ESI-MS (m/z): 515.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 218: (4-(5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5- difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000134_0003
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.85 (s, 1.2H), 8.75 (s, 0.8H), 8.6-8.4 (m, 2H), 8.2 (s, 0.6H), 8.05 (s, 0.4H), 7.0 (br s, 0.6H), 6.68 (m, 0.4H), 5.35-5.25 (m, 0.6H), 5.2-5.1 (m, 0.4H), 4.15-4.05 (m, 1H), 4.07 (s, 1.6H), 4.06 (s, 1.4H), 3.9-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.6-3.5 (m, 0.6H), 3.5-3.4 (m, 0.4H), 3.35- 3.2 (m, 0.6H), 3.2-3.0 (m, 0.4H), 2.6-2.4 (m, 1H), 2.3-2.15 (m, 1H), 2.05-1.8 (m, 1H), 1.2 (d, 1.8H), 1.0 (d, 1.2H); ESI-MS (m/z): 531.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 219: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(5-methylpyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000135_0001
1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz) δ 8.75-8.65 (m, 0.5H), 8.65-8.6 (m, 1.0H), 8.55-8.5 (m, 0.5H), 8.5-8.4 (m, 1.5H), 8.25-8.15 (m, 0.5H), 7.95-7.85 (m, 0.5H), 7.75-7.2 (m, 0.5H), 6.95-6.65 (m, 0.5H), 5.35-5.3 (m, 0.5H), 4.85-4.75 (m, 0.5H), 4.5-4.45 (m, 0.5H), 4.05-3.90 (m, 1.0H), 3.89 (s, 1.0H), 3.8-3.65 (m, 1.0H), 3.61 (s, 2.0H), 2.25 (s, 1.0H), 2.23 (2.0H), 2.05-1.9 (m, 3.0H), 1.5- 1.4 (m, 1.0H) 1.11 (d, 1.0H), 0.86 (d, 2.0H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 511.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 221: (4-(5-chloropyridin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro- 3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000135_0002
1H NMR (d6-DMSO, 400 MHz) δ 8.7-8.5 (m, 1H), 8.4 (m, 1.3H), 8.35 (s, 0.3H), 8.3 (m, 0.7H), 8.2 (s, 0.7H), 8.0 (m, 0.7H), 7.9 (dd, 0.3H), 7.8 (m, 0.3H), 7.8 (dd, 0.7H), 7.5 (d, 0.3H), 7.35 (d, 0.7H), 5.1 (m, 0.3H), 4.8 (m, 0.7H), 3.9 (s, 0.8H), 3.7 (s, 2.2H), 3.6-3.3 (m, 3H), 2.2-1.9 (m, 3H), 1.1 (d, 0.6H), 0.9 (d, 2.4H); ESI-MS (m/z): 529.9 [M+1]+.
Compound 224: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrazin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000136_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.8 (d, 1H), 8.55 (d, 1H), 8.5-8.3 (m, 3H), 7.8 (d, 1H), 7.3 (m, 0.6H), 6.35 (m, 0.4H), 5.3-5.0 (m, 3H), 4.3 (m, 0.5H), 4.0 (s, 1.5H), 3.9 (s, 1.5H), 3.9-2.7 (m, 0.5H), 3.5-3.3 (m, 0.5H), 3.1-3.0 (m, 0.5H), 2.4-2.3 (m, 1H), 2.2-1.9 (m, 2H), 1.2 (d, 1.5H), 1.0 (d, 1.5H); ESI-MS (m/z): 497.32 [M+1]+.
Compound 225: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(4-methylpyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000136_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.7 (d, 1.2H), 8.65 (d, 0.8H), 8.6-8.4 (m, 2H), 8.2 (s, 0.6H), 8.1 (s, 0.4H), 7.4 (br s, 0.6H), 7.2 (m, 0.4H), 5.3-5.2 (m, 0.6H), 5.2-5.1 (m, 0.4H), 4.25-4.15 (m, 0.6H), 4.1-4.0 (m, 0.4H), 3.97 (s, 3H), 3.9-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.6-3.45 (m, 1H), 3.4-3.35 (m, 0.6H), 3.15-3.0 (m, 0.4H), 2.5 (s, 1.8), 2.49 (s, 1.2H), 2.45-1.7 (m, 3H), 1.2 (d, 1.8H), 1.0 (d, 1.2H); ESI-MS (m/z): 511.4 [M+1]+.
Compound 226: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H- pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000136_0003
1H NMR (d6-DMSO, 400 MHz) δ 9.2 (s, 0.6H), 9.0 (s, 1.4H), 8.75 (m, 0.5H), 8.6 (m, 0.5H), 8.42 (br s, 1.4H), 8.3 (br s, 0.6H), 7.8 (m, 0.7H), 7.6 (m, 0.3H), 5.2 (m, 0.3H), 4.85 (m, 0.7H), 4.05 (m, 1H), 3.95 (s, 0.8H), 3.8 (s, 2.2H), 3.8-3.4 (m, 3H), 2.2-1.9 (m, 3H), 1.2 (d, 0.8H), 0.85 (d, 2.2H); ESI-MS (m/z): 565.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 227: (4-(4-chloropyridin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro- 3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000137_0001
1H NMR (d6-DMSO, 400 MHz) δ 8.55-8.35 (m, 3H), 8.2 (s, 1H), 8.0 (m, 0.8H), 7.8 (m, 0.2H), 7.6 (d, 0.2H), 7.45 (d, 0.8H), 7.4 (dd, 0.2H), 7.3 (dd, 0.8H), 5.1 (m, 0.2H), 4.8 (m, 0.8H), 4.3 (m, 1H), 3.7 (s, 0.8H), 3.4 (s, 2.2H), 3.6-3.3 (m, 3H), 2.2-2.0 (m, 3H), 1.15 (d, 0.6H), 0.9 (d, 2.4H); ESI-MS (m/z): 530.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 229: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(6-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol- 3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000137_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.6-8.4 (m, 2H), 8.1 (s, 0.7H), 8.05 (s, 0.3H), 7.93 (s, 1H), 7.9- 7.7 (m, 1H), 7.6-7.5 (m, 1H), 7.4 (br s, 0.7H), 5.9 (br s, 0.3H), 5.3-5.1 (m, 1H), 4.4-4.3 (m, 0.7H), 4.2-3.9 (m, 1.2H), 4.05 (s, 2H), 3.92 (s, 1H), 3.7-3.4 (m, 1.4H), 3.2-3.0 (m, 0.7H), 2.5-2.1 (m, 2H), 2.1-1.7 (m, 1H), 1.2 (d, 1H), 1.0 (d, 2H); ESI-MS (m/z): 563.7 [M+1]+.
Compound 230: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-5-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000138_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 9.1 (br d, 1H), 8.9-8.7 (m, 2H), 8.6-8.4 (m, 2H), 7.65 (s, 1H), 7.6 (s, 1H), 7.25 (br s, 0.5H), 5.9 (br s, 0.5H), 5.2-5.1 (m, 0.5H), 5.1-5.0 (m, 0.5H), 4.7-4.6 (m, 0.5H), 4.5-4.4 (m, 0.5H), 4.2-3.9 (m, 1H), 4.05 (s, 1.5H), 3.9 (s, 1.5H), 3.9-2.7 (m, 0.5H), 3.7- 3.5 (m, 1.5H), 3.2-3.0 (m, 0.5H), 2.4-1.8 (m, 3H), 1.2 (d, 1.6H), 1.0 (d, 1.4H); ESI-MS (m/z): 496.8 [M+1]+.
Compound 231: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl) '-dimethyl-[2,3'-bipyridin]-2'-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000138_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.8 (br s, 1H), 8.5 (s, 3H), 7.95 (d, 1H), 7.6-7.5 (m, 2H), 7.3 (m, 1H), 5.1-5.0 (m, 1H), 4.25-4.15 (m, 1H), 3.9-3.8 (m, 1H), 3.45-3.4 (m, 1H), 3.1-2.9 (m, 1H), 2.9-2.8 (m, 1H), 2.7 (s, 3H), 2.4 (s, 3H), 2.1-2.0 (m, 2H), 1.0 (d, 3H); ESI-MS (m/z): 521.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 232: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-y -ethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000138_0003
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.9 (s, 2H), 8.6-8.3 (m, 3H), 7.4-7.0 (m, 2H), 5.4-5.3 (m, 0.5H), 5.2-5.1 (0.5H), 4.4-4.3 (m, 2H), 4.3-4.1 (m, 1H), 4.0-3.8 (m, 1H), 3.6-3.1 (m, 2H), 2.5-2.0 (m, 3H), 1.7-1.6 (m, 3H), 1.2 (d, 1.6H), 1.0 (d, 1.4H); ESI-MS (m/z): 511.0 [M+1]+. Compound 233: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1,5-dimethyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000139_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.9-8.8 (m, 2H), 8.6-8.45 (m, 2H), 7.6 (br s, 0.6H), 7.15-7.05 (m, 1H), 6.85-6.8 (m, 0.4H), 5.35-5.3 (m, 0.4H), 5.2-5.1 (m, 0.6H), 4.2-4.1 (m, 1H), 4.0-3.8 (m, 1H), 3.9 (s, 3H), 3.6-3.55 (m, 0.4H), 3.5-3.4 (m, 0.6H), 3.3-3.2 (m, 0.4H), 3.1-3.0 (m, 0.6H), 2.8 (s, 1.3H), 2.7 (s, 1.7H), 2.6-2.5 (m, 0.6H), 2.5-2.4 (m, 0.4H), 2.3-2.15 (m, 1H), 2.1-1.8 (m, 1H), 1.2 (d, 1.3H), 1.05 (d, 1.7H); ESI-MS (m/z): 511.1 [M+1]+.
Compound 237: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-isopropyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000139_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.80-8.78 (m, 2H), 8.54-8.42 (m, 2H), 8.25-8.14 (m, 1H), 7.12- 7.08 (m, 1H), 5.3-5.2 (m, 0.5H), 5.15-5.05 (m, 0.5H), 4.60-4.54 (m, 1H), 4.2-4.1 (m, 0.5H), 4.1- 4.0 (m, 0.5H), 3.85-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.55-3.35 (m, 1H), 3.35-2.95 (m, 1H), 2.6-2.35 (m, 1H), 2.3- 2.05 (m, 1H), 1.57 (d, 6H), 1.19 (d, 1.7H), 0.98 (m, 1.3H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 525.40 [M+1]+. Compound 238: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1-(2,2,2-trifluoroethyl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000140_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.86-8.83 (m, 2H), 8.54-8.38 (m, 2H), 8.35 (s, 0.5H), 8.22 (s, 0.5H), 7.19-7.13 (m, 1H), 7.1-7.0 (m, 0.5H), 6.85-6.75 (m, 0.5H), 5.3-5.2 (m, 0.5H), 5.15-5.05 (m, 0.5H), 4.84-4.72 (m, 2H), 4.15-4.0 (m, 0.5H), 4.0-3.95 (m, 0.5H), 3.8-3.7 (m, 1H), 3.6-3.5 (m, 0.5H), 3.5-3.4 (m, 0.5H), 3.4-3.35 (m, 0.5H), 3.15-3.0 (m, 0.5H), 2.6-2.5 (m, 0.5H), 2.4-2.3 (m, 0.5H), 2.25-2.1 (m, 1H), 1.20 (d, 1.5H), 0.98 (d, 1.5H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 565.70 [M+1]+. Compound 239: ((2S,3R)-2-(((5-ethylpyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3- methylpiperidin-1-yl)(5-(4-flu rophenyl)-2-methylthiazol-4-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000140_0002
1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 8.03 (s, 2.0H), 7.40-7.36 (m, 2.0H), 7.16-7.08 (m, 2.0H), 4.85- 4.75 (m, 1.0H), 4.3-4.2 (m, 1.0H), 4.45-4.4 (m, 2.0H), 3.30 (s, 2.0H), 2.5-2.4 (m, 5.0H), 1.9-1.8 (m, 2.0H), 1.18 (t, 3.0H), 0.88 (d, 3.0H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 490.43 [M+1]+.
Compound 240: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(6-methyl-3-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)pyridin-2- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000140_0003
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1 using 6-methyl-3-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)picolinic acid in Step 3. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.43 (s, 2.0H), 8.31 (d, 1.0H), 7.31 (d, 1.0H), 5.35-5.25 (m, 1.0H), 5.05- 4.95 (m, 1.0H), 4.31 (s, 3.0H), 3.95-3.85 (m, 1.0H), 3.85-3.75 (m, 1.0H), 3.4-3.3 (m, 1.0H), 3.1- 2.95 (m, 1.0H), 2.69 (s, 3.0H), 1.6-1.5 (m, 1.0H), 0.93 (d, 3.0H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 512.4 [M+1]+.
Compound 241: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl 1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-4-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000141_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 9.20 (s, 1H), 8.65-8.62 (m, 1H), 8.55-8.4 (m, 2H), 8.10 (s, 0.6H), 8.03 (s, 0.4H), 7.52-7.50 (m, 0.6H), 7.44-7.42 (m, 0.4H), 6.4-6.3 (m, 0.4H), 5.3-5.2 (m, 0.4H), 5.15-5.05 (m, 0.6H), 4.3-4.2 (m, 0.6H), 4.01 (s, 1.6H), 3.95 (s, 1.4H), 3.92-3.8 (m, 2H), 3.55-3.4 (m, 1.3H), 3.15-3.0 (m, 0.7H), 2.5-2.35 (m, 0.4H), 2.35-2.25 (m, 0.6H), 2.2-2.1 (m, 1.3H), 1.21 (d, 1.4H), 1.01 (d, 1.6H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 497.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 242: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(((3-fluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(4-(5-fluoropyrimidin-2-yl)-1-methyl-1H- pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000141_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.50 (s, 0.9H), 8.41 (s, 0.6H), 8.20 (s, 0.4H), 8.13 (s, 0.5H), 8.09 (s, 0.3H), 8.02 (s, 0.4H), 7.31-7.27 (m, 1.0H), 6.57 (br s, 0.5H), 6.25 (br s, 0.3H), 5.25-5.05 (m, 0.9H), 4.15-4.05 (m, 1.0H), 3.97 (d, 3.0H), 3.8-3.65 (m, 1.0H), 3.45-3.3 (m, 1.0H), 3.2-3.0 (m, 0.8H), 2.4-2.35 (m, 1.0H), 2.25-2.2 (m, 0.7H), 2.2-2.1 (m, 1.0H), 2.05-1.95 (m, 1.0H), 1.22 (d, 1.3H), 0.98 (d, 1.7H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 532.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 252: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-fluoro-2-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)phenyl)methanone
Figure imgf000142_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.5-8.4 (m, 1.8H), 8.4-8.3 (m, 0.2H), 8.2-8.1 (m, 0.6H), 8.1-8.0 (m, 0.4H), 7.2-7.1 (m, 0.4H), 7.1-7.0 (m, 0.6H), 7.0-6.9 (m, 1H), 5.4-5.25 (m, 0.8H), 5.1-5.0 (m, 0.8H), 4.37 (s, 2.0H), 4.28 (s, 1.0H), 4.2-4.1 (m, 0.8H), 3.7-3.6 (m, 1H), 3.5-3.4 (m, 1.8H), 2.35- 2.2 (m, 1H), 2.2-2.05 (m, 1H), 2.0-1.9 (m, 2H), 1.85-1.7 (m, 2.0H), 1.6-1.5 (m, 2H), 1.10 (d, 2.0H), 1.02 (d, 1.0H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 515.00 [M+1]+.
Compound 16: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl '-methyl-[2,3'-bipyridin]-2'-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000142_0002
Step 1: (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl mino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000142_0003
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1 using 3-bromo-6-methylpicolinic acid in Step 3. ESI-MS (m/z): 508.06/510.08 [M+1]+.
Step 2: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(6'-methyl-[2,3'-bipyridin]-2'-yl)methanone
To a solution of (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone (1eq) and 2- (tributylstannyl)pyridine (1.2eq) in DMF was added Pd(PPh3)4 (10 mol%). The reaction mixture was heated to 120°C for 2h in a microwave reactor and then the mixture was cooled and concentrated. The crude was dissolved with EtOAc and washed with sat’d NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The crude was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to obtain the title compound. ESI-MS (m/z): 507.2 [M+1]+. Compounds 17, 54, and 99 were prepared in a manner analogous to that for Compound 16. Compound 17: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl -methyl-3-(pyrimidin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000143_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.81-8.79 (m, 2H), 8.6 (br s, 1H), 8.55-8.50 (m, 2H), 7.37-7.35 (m, 1H), 7.25-7.22 (m, 1H), 5.15-5.05 (m, 1H), 4.15-4.05 (m, 1H), 3.9-3.8 (m, 1H), 3.4-3.35 (m, 1H), 3.15-2.95 (m, 1H), 2.85-2.8 (m, 1H), 2.76 (s, 3H), 2.25-2.2 (m, 1H), 2.05-2.0 (m, 1H), 1.00 (d, 3H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 508.03 [M+1]+.
Compound 18: ((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3- methylpiperidin-1-yl)(6-methyl-3-(pyrimidin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000143_0002
Step 1: (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)- 5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000143_0003
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1 using 2,5-dichloropyrimidine in Step 1 and 3-bromo-6-methylpicolinic acid in Step 3. ESI-MS (m/z): 473.93/475.81 [M+1]+.
Step 2: ((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1- yl)(6-methyl-3-(pyrimidin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 16 using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyrimidine in Step 2. ESI-MS (m/z): 474.05 [M+1]+. Compound 55: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl) -methyl-2-(pyrimidin-2-yl)phenyl)methanone
Figure imgf000144_0001
Step 1: (2-bromo-5-methylphenyl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl mino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000144_0002
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1 using 2-bromo-5-methylbenzoic acid in Step 3. ESI-MS (m/z): 507.0/509.0
[M+1]+.
Step 2: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-methyl-2-(pyrimidin-2-yl)phenyl)methanone
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 16 using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyrimidine in Step 2. ESI-MS (m/z): 506.94 [M+1]+. Compound 56: (5-chloro-2-(pyrimidin-2-yl)phenyl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000145_0001
Step 1: (5-chloro-2-iodophenyl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl mino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000145_0002
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in Compound 1 using 2-bromo-5-chlorobenzoic acid in Step 3. ESI-MS (m/z): 575.0 [M+1]+. Step 2: (5-chloro-2-(pyrimidin-2-yl)phenyl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in Compound 16 using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyrimidine in Step 2.. ESI-MS (m/z): 526.92 [M+1]+. Compound 57: (5-chloro-2-(pyrimidin-2-yl)phenyl)((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000145_0003
Step 1: (5-chloro-2-iodophenyl)((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5- difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000145_0004
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1 using 2,5-dichloropyrimidine in Step 1 and 2-bromo-5-chlorobenzoic in Step 3. ESI-MS (m/z): 540.93 [M+1]+.
Step 2: (5-chloro-2-(pyrimidin-2-yl)phenyl)((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)methanone
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 16 using 2-(tributylstannyl)pyrimidine in Step 2. ESI-MS (m/z): 493.3 [M+1]+. Compound 102: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(((4-methoxy-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000146_0001
Step 1: (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-2-(((4-methoxy-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)-3-methylpiperidine-1-carbox late
Figure imgf000146_0002
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1 using 2-chloro-4-methoxy-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 475.22 [M+1]+.
Step 2: N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-4-methoxy-5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-amine
Figure imgf000146_0003
A mixture of (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-2-(((4-methoxy-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)-3-methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate and 10% Pd/C and EtOAc was stirred under a balloon of hydropgen. When starting material was consumed as judged by T.L.C. analysis, the reaction mixture was filtered through a pad of celite and washed with EtOAc. The organics were concentrated in vacuo to afford the title compound which was used without further purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 341.06 [M+1]+.
Step 3: ((2S,3R)-2-(((5-chloropyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-1- yl)(5-fluoro-2-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)phenyl)methanone
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1, Step 3, using 1-methyl-4-(pyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 526.2 [M+1]+.
Compound 120: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-phenyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000147_0001
Step 1: (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidine-1-carbox late
Figure imgf000147_0002
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1 using 2-chloro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazine in Step 1. ESI-MS (m/z): 445.4
[M+1]+.
Step 2: N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- amine hydrobromide
Figure imgf000148_0001
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in Compound 1, Step 2. ESI-MS (m/z): 311.3 [M+1]+.
Step 3: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl) -methyl-4-phenyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000148_0002
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in Compound 1, Step 3, using 1-methyl-4-phenyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.15 (s, 0.25H), 8.05 (s, 0.75H), 7.8 (s, 0.75H), 7.7 (s, 0.25H), 7.2-7.1 (m, 6H), 6.4 (m, 0.8H), 5.1 (m, 0.2H), 5.0 (m, 0.26H), 4.75 (m, 0.75H), 3.7-3.8 (m, 1H), 3.65 (s, 0.8H), 3.60 (s, 2.2H), 3.4-3.3 (m, 2H), 2.75-2.9 (m, 1H), 1.8 (m, 1H), 1.3-1.5 (m, 2H), 1.0 (d, 0.85H), 0.70 (d, 2.15H); ESI-MS (m/z): 495.07 [M+1]+.
Compound 162: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(4-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000148_0003
Step 1: (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate
Figure imgf000149_0001
To a mixture of (2S,3R)-benzyl 2-(aminomethyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate (1eq) and K2CO3 (2eq) in DMF (20mL) was added 2-fluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine (3eq). The reaction was warmed to 80̊C for 2h wherein the starting material was judged consumed as indicated by reverse-phase analytical HPLC. The reaction was cooled, and diluted with EtOAc, and water. The layers were separated, and the organic phase was washed with water (3x), brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a near colorless oil which solidified. ESI-MS (m/z): 444.4 [M+1]+.
Step 2: N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- amine hydrobromide
Figure imgf000149_0002
To the carbamate from the previous step was added to 30%HBr in HOAc. The reaction was stirred at rt (1-3h) until sm was consumed as judged by HPLC analysis. The reaction was concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound as a pale yellow foam which was used without purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 310.3 [M+1]+.
Step 3: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(4-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000149_0003
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in Compound 1 using 1-methyl-4-(4-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid in Step 3. ESI-MS (m/z): 509.22 [M+1]+. Compound 183: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl -methyl-3-(pyrimidin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000150_0001
Step 1: (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)amin methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000150_0002
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in Compound 1 using 2-chloro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine in Step 1 and 3-bromo-6- methylpicolinic acid in Step 3. ESI-MS (m/z): 507.12/509.1 [M+1]+.
Step 4: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(6-methyl-3-(pyrimidin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for Compound 16 using (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone and 2- (tributylstannyl)pyrimidine. ESI-MS (m/z): 507.16 [M+1]+.
Compound 204: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(6-methyl-3-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000150_0003
Step 1: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methanol
Figure imgf000151_0001
A mixture of (2S, 3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-2-(hydroxymethyl)-3-methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate and 10% Pd/C and EtOAc were stirred under a balloon of H2 until T.L.C. analysis indicated starting material had been consumed. The reaction was filtered through a celite pad washing with EtOAc. The organics were concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound which was used without further purification.1H NMR (CD3OD, 400 MHz) δ 3.5-3.65 (m, 2H), 3.05-3.15 (m, 1H), 2.8-2.95 (m, 2H), 2.15-2.25 (m, 1H), 1.85-2.1 (m, 2H), 0.97-1.01 (dm, 3H).
Step 2: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(hydroxymethyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(6-methyl-3-(2H-1,2,3- triazol-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000151_0002
To a solution of ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methanol (1eq) and DIEA (4 eq) in DMF was added 6-methyl-3-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)picolinic acid (1.5 eq) followed by HATU (1.2 eq). The reaction was stirred at room temperature for 2h, and then diluted with 1M HCl and EtOAc. The layers were separated, and the organic layer was washed with 1M HCl (2x), sat. aq. NaHCO3 (2x), brine (1x), dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on silica gel to give the title compound as a colorless solid. ESI-MS (m/z): 351.99 [M+1]+.
Step 3: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(6-methyl-3-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000151_0003
To a solution of ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(hydroxymethyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(6-methyl-3- (2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone (1eq) and 2-fluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine (4 eq) in DMF was added NaH (1.5 eq). After 20 min, one drop of 1M HCl was added to quench the reaction, and the crude mixture was purified by reverse-phase preparative HPLC to afford the title compound as a colorless solid.. ESI-MS (m/z): 496.9 [M+1]+.
Compound 205: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(4-(4-fluorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000152_0001
Step 1: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(hydroxymethyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(4-(4-fluorophenyl)-1- methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000152_0002
The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for Compound 204 using ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methanol and 4-(4- fluorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 368.09 [M+1]+.
Step 2: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(4-(4-fluorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for Compound 204 using ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(hydroxymethyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(4-(4- fluorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone and 2-fluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 512.73 [M+1]+.
Compound 206: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000153_0001
Step 1: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(hydroxymethyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(5- methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000153_0002
The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for Compound 204 using ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methanol and 1-methyl-4- (5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid. ESI-MS (m/z): 365.11 [M+1]+.
Step 2: (2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for Compound 204 using ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(hydroxymethyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(1- methyl-4-(5-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone and 2-fluoro-5- (trifluoromethyl)pyridine. ESI-MS (m/z): 510.14 [M+1]+. Compounds 207, 222-223, and 244-248 were prepared in a manner analogous to that for Compound 204.
Compound 207: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-methylthiazol-4-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000153_0003
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.45 (s, 0.4H), 8.30 (s, 0.6H), 7.77-7.72 (m, 1H), 7.46-7.40 (m, 2H), 7.11-7.07 (m, 1H), 6.97-6.92 (m, 1H), 6.76-6.72 (m, 1H), 5.2 (br s, 0.4H), 5.0-4.9 (m, 0.6H), 4.75-4.7 (m, 0.5H), 4.6-4.5 (m, 0.5H), 4.40-4.37 (m, 0.6H), 4.10 (br s, 0.5H), 3.85-3.75 (m, 0.5H), 3.50-3.35 (m, 0.5H), 3.15-3.05 (m, 0.5H), 2.69 (s, 1.3H), 2.59 (s, 1.7H), 2.30-2.20 (m, 0.7H), 2.15-1.90 (m, 2H), 1.85-1.6 (m, 1H), 1.15 (d, 1.3H), 0.86 (d, 1.7H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 530.25 [M+1]+.
Compound 222: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000154_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.80 (s, 1.3H), 8.70 (s, 0.7H), 8.59-8.57 (m, 0.7H), 8.48-8.46 (m, 1.3H), 8.11 (s, 0.7H), 8.06 (s, 0.3H), 7.05-6.95 (m, 0.4H), 6.96-6.93 (m, 0.6H), 5.35-5.15 (m, 1H), 4.95-4.88 (m, 1.4H), 4.68-4.65 (m, 0.6H), 3.98 (s, 2.1H), 3.88 (s, 0.9H), 3.85-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.7-3.55 (m, 1H), 2.5-2.4 (m, 1H), 2.2-2.05 (m, 2H), 1.20 (s, 2.1H), 0.96 (d, 0.9H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 498.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 223: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000154_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.6-8.58 (m, 1H), 8.56-8.49 (m, 0.6H), 8.48-8.46 (m, 1H), 8.35- 8.31 (m, 0.4H), 8.29-8.28 (m, 1H), 8.11 (s, 0.6H), 7.99 (s, 0.4H), 7.05-7.02 (m, 0.5H), 6.98-6.95 (m, 0.5H), 5.4-5.15 (m, 1H), 4.90-4.87 (m, 1H), 4.7-4.55 (m, 1H), 4.2-4.1 (m, 0.4H), 3.96 (s, 1.7H), 3.9-3.8 (m, 0.6H), 3.76 (s, 1.3H), 3.55-3.4 (m, 0.6H), 3.3-3.2 (m, 0.4H), 2.5-2.35 (m, 1H), 2.25-2.15 (m, 1H), 2.10-1.85 (m, 1H), 1.20 (d, 1.7H), 0.96 (d, 1.3H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 498.2 [M+1]+. Compound 208: (4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3- methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000155_0001
Step 1: (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperi ine-1-carboxylate
Figure imgf000155_0002
To a mixture of (2S, 3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-2-(hydroxymethyl)-3-methylpiperidine-1- carboxylate (1eq) and Cs2CO3 (2 eq) in DMF was added 2-fluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine (5eq). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 12h, and then diluted with EtOAc and water. The layers were separated, and the organic layer was washed with 1M HCl (2x), sat. aq. NaHCO3 (2x), brine (1x), dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo.
Chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) afforded the title compound.
Step 2: 2-(((2S,3R)- -difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methoxy)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine
Figure imgf000155_0003
To the carbamate from the previous step was added to 30%HBr in HOAc. The reaction was stirred at rt (1-3h) until sm was consumed as judged by HPLC analysis. The reaction was concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound as a pale yellow foam which was used without purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 311.3 [M+1]+.
Step 3: (4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000156_0001
To a solution of 2-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methoxy)-5- (trifluoromethyl)pyridine (1eq) and DIEA (4 eq) in DMF was added 4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1- methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid (1.5 eq) followed by HATU (1.2 eq). The reaction was stirred at room temperature for 2h, and then diluted with 1M HCl and EtOAc. The layers were separated, and the organic layer was washed with 1M HCl (2x), sat. aq. NaHCO3 (2x), brine (1x), dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo. The crude residue was purified by
chromatography on silica gel to give the title compound as a colorless solid.1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.46 (s, 0.5H), 8.30 (s, 0.5H), 8.80-8.75 (m, 0.5H), 8.70-8.65 (m, 0.5H), 7.49 (s, 0.5H), 7.42 (s, 0.5H), 7.36-7.26 (m, 3H), 7.17-7.15 (m, 1H), 6.75-6.72 (m, 0.5H), 6.55-6.50 (m, 0.5H), 5.30 (br s, 0.5H), 5.05-4.95 (m, 0.5H), 4.8-4.7 (m, 0.5H), 4.63-4.6 (m, 0.5H), 4.5-4.35 (m, 1H), 4.3 (br s, 0.5H), 4.1-4.0 (m, 0.5H), 3.93 (s, 1.5H), 3.84 (s, 1.5H), 3.45-3.3 (m, 0.5H), 3.2-3.05 (m, 0.5H), 2.4-2.25 (m, 0.5H), 2.23-2.2 (m, 0.5H), 2.05-1.95 (m, 2H), 1.7-1.6 (m, 1H), 1.16 (d, 1.5H), 0.89 (d, 1.5H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 529.3 [M+1]+. Compounds 212-214, 216, 220, and 243 were prepared in a manner analogous to that for Compound 208.
Compound 212: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000156_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.60 (d, 0.7H), 8.51 (s, 0.7H), 8.42 (d, 1.3H), 8.35 (s, 0.3H), 8.15-8.10 (m, 1H), 7.81-7.78 (m, 1H), 7.05-7.0 (m, 0.4H), 6.95-6.92 (m, 0.6H), 6.84-6.80 (m, 1H), 5.30-5.15 (m, 1.2H), 4.86 (m, 1.3H), 4.56 (m, 0.8H), 4.2-4.05 (m, 0.6H), 3.97 (s, 2H), 3.84 (s, 1H), 3.82-3.7 (m, 1H), 3.65-3.5 (m, 0.6H), 3.35-3.2 (m, 0.4H), 2.5-2.3 (m, 1.4H), 2.25-2.05 (m, 1.6H), 1.19 (d, 2H), 0.95 (d, 1H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 497.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 213: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)( -methyl-5-(pyrimidin-2-yl)thiazol-4-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000157_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.64-8.63 (m, 0.7H), 8.51-8.48 (m, 2H), 8.33 (s, 0.3H), 7.82-7.78 (m, 1H), 7.09-7.05 (m, 0.4H), 7.01-6.95 (m, 0.6H), 6.83-6.8 (m, 1H), 5.25-5.15 (br m, 1H), 4.90-4.87 (m, 1.3H), 4.57-4.54 (m, 0.7H), 3.95 (br s, 0.4H), 3.75-3.55 (m, 1.4H), 3.4-3.25 (m, 0.4H), 2.76 (s, 2H), 2.64 (s, 1H), 2.5-2.3 (m, 1H), 2.25-2.1 (m, 2H), 2.05-1.95 (m, 1.4H), 1.9-1.7 (m, 1.8H), 1.7-1.6 (m, 0.6H), 1.19 (d, 2H), 0.96 (d, 1H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 514.08 [M+1]+. Compound 214: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(2-methyl-5-(pyridin-2-yl)thiazol-4-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000157_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 8.77-8.73 (m, 1H), 8.46-8.41 (m, 2H), 7.90-7.82 (m, 1H), 7.48- 7.45 (m, 1H), 7.34-7.28 (m, 1H), 7.0-6.9 (m, 0.6H), 5.35-5.30 (m, 0.7H), 5.05-4.95 (m, 0.8H), 4.85-4.70 (m, 3H), 4.5-4.3 (m, 1H), 3.8-3.6 (m, 0.9H), 3.5-3.3 (m, 1H), 2.98 (s, 1.5H), 2.90 (s, 1.5H), 2.5-2.3 (m, 1H), 2.25-2.1 (m, 2H), 2.05-1.95 (m, 2H), 1.80-1.70 (m, 3H), 1.20 (d, 2H), 0.88 (d, 1H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 513.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 216: (5-chloro-2-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)phenyl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3- methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000158_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.50-8.36 (m, 1.0H), 8.15-8.05 (m, 1.0H), 7.92-7.75 (m, 1.0H), 7.55-7.35 (m, 3.0H), 7.0-6.8 (m, 1.0H), 5.4-5.3 (m, 2.0H), 5.15-4.95 (m, 1.0H), 4.85-4.65 (m, 1.0H), 4.36 (s, 2.0H), 4.15 (s, 1.0H), 3.90-3.8 (m, 0.4H), 3.7-3.4 (m, 1.2H), 3.25-3.05 (m, 0.3H), 2.25-2.15 (m, 2.0H), 1.21 (d, 2.0H), 0.90 (d, 1.0H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 553.2 [M+Na]+.
Compound 220: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000158_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.6 (br s, 0.5H), 8.5 (br s, 0.5H), 8.4 (br s, 0.5H), 8.3 (br s, 0.5H), 7.9-7.8 (m, 1H), 7.8-7.5 (m, 3H), 7.2 (m, 0.5H), 7.05 (m, 0.5H), 6.8 (d, 0.5H), 6.6 (d, 0.5H), 5.4 (m, 0.5H), 5.1 (m, 0.5H), 4.9-4.7 (m, 1H), 4.6-4.4 (m, 1H), 4.35 (m, 0.5H), 4.0 (m, 0.5H), 3.95 (s, 1.5H), 3.8 (s, 1.5H), 3.6-3.5 (m, 0.5H), 3.3-3.2 (m, 0.5H), 2.4-1.7 (m, 3H), 1.2 (d, 1.5H), 0.95 (d, 1.5H); ESI-MS (m/z): 496.0 [M+1]+.
Compound 243: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-m hyl-4-phenyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000158_0003
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.6-8.47 (m, 1.0H), 8.4-8.31 (m, 1.0H), 7.94-7.89 (m, 1.0H), 7.85-7.75 (m, 0.5H), 7.7-7.6 (m, 1.5H), 7.6-7.45 (m, 2.0H), 7.2-7.1 (m, 0.5H), 7.1-7.0 (m, 0.5H), 6.85-6.75 (m, 0.5H), 6.55-6.5 (m, 0.5H), 5.4-5.35 (m, 0.5H), 5.1-5.0 (m, 0.5H), 4.85-4.7 (m, 1.0H), 4.55-4.4 (m, 1.0H), 4.4-4.3 (m, 0.5H), 4.1-4.0 (m, 0.5H), 3.94 (s, 1.5H), 3.85 (s, 1.5H), 3.6-3.55 (m, 0.5H), 3.3-3.15 (m, 0.5H), 2.4-2.3 (m, 0.5H), 2.25-2.2 (m, 0.5H), 2.1-2.05 (m, 1.0H), 1.7-1.6 (m, 1.0H), 1.19 (d, 1.5H), 0.93 (d, 1.5H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 495.97 [M+1]+. Compound 215: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)( -methyl-3-(pyrimidin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000159_0001
Step 1: (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000159_0002
The title compound was synthesized following the same general protocol as described for Compound 208 using 2-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methoxy)-5- (trifluoromethyl)pyridine and 3-bromo-6-methylpicolinic acid.
Step 2: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(6-methyl-3-(pyrimidin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
To a solution of (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone (1eq) and 2- (tributylstannyl)pyrimidine (1.2eq) in DMF was added Pd(PPh3)4 (10 mol%). The reaction mixture was heated to 120°C for 2h in a microwave reactor and then the mixture was cooled and concentrated. The crude was dissolved with EtOAc and washed with sat’d NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The crude was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to obtain the title compound.1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.69-8.67 (m, 1.0H), 8.58-8.54 (m, 1.6H), 8.47-8.45 (m, 1.0H), 8.45-8.4 (m, 0.4H), 7.74-7.72 (m, 1.0H), 7.3-7.27 (m, 1.0H), 7.2- 7.15 (m, 0.4H), 7.05-7.0 (m, 0.6H), 6.8-6.75 (m, 1.0H), 5.15-5.05 (m, 1.0H), 4.85-4.8 (m, 1.0H), 4.7-4.6 (m, 1.0H), 3.8-3.75 (m, 0.5H), 3.6-3.45 (m, 1.0H), 3.4-3.25 (m, 0.5H), 2.57 (s, 1.6H), 2.50 (s, 1.4H), 2.45-2.4 (m, 0.4H), 2.4-2.3 (m, 0.6H), 2.2-2.0 (m, 2.0H), 1.12 (d, 1.6H), 0.86 (d, 1.4H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 508.4 [M+1]+.
Compound 228: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(((3-fluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000160_0001
Step 1: (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-2-(((3-fluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)-3-methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate
Figure imgf000160_0002
To a mixture of (2S,3R)-benzyl 2-(aminomethyl)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidine-1-carboxylate (1eq) and Cs2CO3 (2eq) in DMF (20mL) was added 2,3-difluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine (3eq). The reaction was stirred at room temperature for 2h wherein the starting material was judged consumed as indicated by reverse-phase analytical HPLC. The reaction was cooled, and diluted with EtOAc, and water. The layers were separated, and the organic phase was washed with water (3x), brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a near colorless oil which solidified. ESI-MS (m/z): 462.2 [M+1]+.
Step 2: N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-3-fluoro-5- (trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-amine hydrobromide
Figure imgf000160_0003
To the carbamate from the previous step was added to 30%HBr in HOAc. The reaction was stirred at rt (1-3h) until sm was consumed as judged by HPLC analysis. The reaction was concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound as a pale yellow foam which was used without purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 328.3 [M+1]+.
Step 3: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(4-methylpyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000161_0001
The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as described in
Compound 1 using 1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid in Step 3. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.65 (d, 1H), 8.6 (d, 1H), 8.25 (s, 0.5H), 8.2 (s, 0.5H), 8.15 (s, 0.5H), 8.1 (s, 0.5H), 7.35-7.2 (m, 1H), 7.1 (m, 1H), 6.7-6.6 (m, 1H), 5.35-5.2 (m, 1H), 4.35-4.25 (m, 0.5H), 4.15-4.05 (m, 0.5H), 4.0 (s, 1.5H), 3.95 (s, 1.5H), 3.9-3.8 (m, 0.5H), 3.6-3.5 (m, 0.5H), 3.5-3.3 (m, 1.5H), 3.2-3.05 (m, 0.5H), 2.5-2.4 (m, 1H), 2.2-2.1 (m, 1H), 2-1.6 (m, 1H), 1.25 (d, 1.5H), 1.0 (d, 1.5H); ESI-MS (m/z): 513.7 [M+1]+.
Compound 234: (3-(cyclopropylethynyl)-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3- methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000161_0002
To a solution of (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone (1eq) and
ethynylcyclopropane (1.2 eq) in diisopropylamine was added CuI (0.1 eq), and Pd(Ph3P)2Cl2 (5 mol%). The reaction was warmed to 85̊C for 14h, and then cooled and concentrated. The crude was taken up in EtOAc and washed with sat. aq. NaHCO3, brine, dried (Na2SO4) and
concentrated in vacuo. The crude was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to afford the title compound. 1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 8.65-8.45 (m, 1.0H), 8.3-8.25 (s, 0.7H), 7.75-7.55 (m, 1.0H), 7.4-7.3 (s, 0.3H), 7.25-7.05 (m, 1.0H), 5.4-5.3 (m, 0.7H), 4.05-3.95 (m, 1.0H),3.7-3.6 (m, 1.0H), 2.86 (s, 0.5H), 2.66 (s, 2.5H), 2.1-2.0 (m, 4.0H), 1.65-1.55 (m, 1.0H), 1.45-1.4 (m, 1.0H), 1.23 (d, 0.5H), 1.07 (d, 2.5H), 0.9-0.8 (m, 4.0H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 494.4 [M+1]+.
Compound 235: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-y -methyl-3-(prop-1-yn-1-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000162_0001
To a solution of (3-bromo-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone (1eq) and
tributyl(prop-1-yn-1-yl)stannane (1.2 eq) in DMF was added CsF (2eq), CuI (0.1 eq), and Pd(Ph3P)4 (5 mol%). The reaction was warmed to 80 ̊C for 12h, and then cooled and
concentrated. The crude was taken up in EtOAc and washed with sat. aq. NaHCO3, brine, dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated in vacuo. The crude was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to afford the title compound. 1H NMR (MeOD, 400 MHz) δ 8.50 (s, 1.0H), 8.27 (s, 1.0H), 8.57-8.54 (m, 1.0H), 7.12-7.09 (m, 1.0H), 5.4-5.3 (m, 1.0H), 4.15-3.95 (m, 1.0H), 3.7- 3.6 (m, 1.0H), 3.6-3.4 (m, 2.0H), 2.65-2.55 (m, 1.0H), 2.5-2.4 (m, 1.0H), 2.34 (s, 3.0H), 2.2-2.1 (m, 4.0H), 1.06 (d, 3.0H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 468.32 [M+1]+.
Compound 236: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl -ethynyl-6-methylpyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000162_0002
The title compound was prepared following the same general protocol as described for
Compound 235 using tributyl(ethynyl)stannane. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.51-8.47 (m, 2.0H), 7.95-7.85 (s, 0.7H), 7.81-7.71 (m, 1.0H), 7.22-7.14 (m, 1.0H), 6.05-6.0 (m, 0.3H), 5.3-5.2 (m, 0.3H), 5.15-5.05 (m, 0.7H), 3.90-3.7 (m, 2.0H), 3.55-3.45 (m, 0.5H), 3.4-3.3 (m, 1.5H), 3.1- 2.95 (m, 1.0H), 2.67 (s, 2.1H), 2.52 (s, 0.9H), 2.45-2.35 (m, 1.0H), 2.25-2.15 (m, 1.0H), 1.95- 1.80 (m, 1.0H), 1.20 (d, 0.9H), 1.01 (d, 2.1H) ppm; ESI-MS (m/z): 454.27 [M+1]+. Compound 251: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(2-fluoro-3-methyl-6-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2- yl)phenyl)methanone
Figure imgf000163_0001
To 2-fluoro-3-methyl-6-(2H-1,2,3-triazol-2-yl)benzoic acid in CH2Cl2 was added SOCl2. The reaction was warmed to 50̊C for 3h, and then concentrated in vacuo. A solution of this acid chloride in CH2Cl2 was added to a solution of N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2- yl)methyl)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2-amine hydrobromide and DIEA (4eq) in CH2Cl2. The reaction was stirred at room temperature until starting piperidine was consumed by HPLC analysis. The reaction was concentrated in vacuo, and then taken up in EtOAc and washed with 1M HCl, sat. aq. NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. Purification by
chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) provided the title compound as a solid. ESI-MS (m/z): 514.1 [M+1]+. Synthesis of Compound 185 and Compound 129
Compound 185: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-methylthiazol-4-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000163_0002
Step 1: (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate. To a mixture of the crude amine compound r (1eq) and K2CO3 (2eq) in DMF (20mL) was added 2-fluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridine (3eq). The reaction was warmed to 80̊C for 2h wherein the starting material was judged consumed as indicated by reverse-phase analytical HPLC. The reaction was cooled, and diluted with EtOAc, and water. The layers were separated, and the organic phase was washed with water (3x), brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a near colorless oil which solidified. ESI-MS (m/z): 444.4 [M+1]+.
Step 2: N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- amine hydrobromide. To the carbamate from the previous step was added to 30%HBr in HOAc. The reaction was stirred at rt (1-3h) until sm was consumed as judged by HPLC analysis. The reaction was concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound as a pale yellow foam which was used without purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 310.3 [M+1]+.
Step 3: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-methylthiazol-4-yl)methanone. To a solution of N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin- 2-amine hydrobromide (10mg) in DMF (0.5mL) was added DIEA (3eq) followed by 5-(4- fluorophenyl)-2-methylthiazole-4-carboxylic acid (6mg) and HATU (8mg). The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature for 15h, and was then diluted with EtOAc and washed with 1M HCl, sat aq. NaHCO3, brine, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on silica gel (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a colorless oil which solidified. ESI-MS (m/z): 529.5 [M+1]+.
Compound 129: (4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3- methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000164_0001
Step 1: (2S,3R)-benzyl 5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidine-1-carboxylate. To a mixture of the crude amine compound r (1eq) and K2CO3 (2eq) in DMF (20mL) was added 2-chloro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazine (1.5eq). The reaction was warmed to 80 ̊C for 2h wherein the starting material was judged consumed as indicated by reverse-phase analytical HPLC. The reaction was cooled, and diluted with EtOAc, and water. The layers were separated, and the organic phase was washed with water (3x), brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated. The crude residue was purified by chromatography on SiO2 (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a pale yellow solid. ESI-MS (m/z): 445.4 [M+1]+. Step 2: N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- amine hydrobromide. To the carbamate from the previous step was added to 30%HBr in HOAc. The reaction was stirred at rt (1-3h) until sm was consumed as judged by HPLC analysis. The reaction was concentrated in vacuo to give the title compound as a pale yellow foam which was used without purification. ESI-MS (m/z): 311.3 [M+1]+.
Step 3: (4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5- (trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2-yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone. The title compound was prepared following the same general procedure as that described for Compound 1, Step 3 using N-(((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methylpiperidin-2-yl)methyl)-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- amine hydrobromide and 4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazole-3-carboxylic acid.
Purification of the crude residue by chromatography on silica gel (EtOAc/hex) to give the title compound as a light yellow oil which solidified. ESI-MS (m/z): 529.9 [M+1]+. Compounds 207, 208, 212, 213, 214, 215, 216, 220, 222, 223, and 228, were prepared in a manner analogous to that shown above for Compounds 185 and 129.
Compound 207: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(5-(4-fluorophenyl)-2-methylthiazol-4-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000165_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.45 (s, 0.4H), 8.30 (s, 0.6H), 7.77-7.72 (m, 1H), 7.46-7.40 (m, 2H), 7.11-7.07 (t, 1H), 6.97-6.92 (t, 1H), 6.76-6.72 (t, 1H), 5.2 (br s, 0.4H), 5.0-4.9 (m, 0.6H), 4.75-4.7 (m, 1H), 4.6-4.5 (m, 0.5H), 4.40-4.37 (m, 1H), 4.10 (br s, 0.5H), 3.85-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.50-3.35 (m, 0.5H), 3.15-3.05 (m, 0.5H), 2.69 (s, 1.3H), 2.59 (s, 1.7H), 2.30-1.8 (m, 2H), 1.15 (d, 1.2H), 0.86 (d, 1.8H); ESI-MS (m/z): 530.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 208: (4-(4-chlorophenyl)-1-methyl-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3- methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000166_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.46 (s, 0.5H), 8.30 (s, 0.5H), 7.80-7.75 (dd, 0.5H), 7.70-7.65 (dd, 0.5H), 7.49 (s, 0.5H), 7.42 (s, 0.5H), 7.36-7.26 (m, 3H), 7.2 (d, 1H), 6.75 (d, 0.5H), 6.55 (d, 0.5H), 5.30 (br s, 0.5H), 5.05-4.95 (m, 0.5H), 4.8-4.7 (m, 0.5H), 4.63-4.6 (m, 0.5H), 4.5-4.4 (m, 1H), 4.3 (br s, 0.5H), 4.1-4.0 (m, 0.5H), 3.93 (s, 1.5H), 3.84 (s, 1.5H), 3.45-3.3 (m, 0.5H), 3.2- 3.05 (m, 0.5H), 2.3-2.25 (m, 0.5H), 2.23-2.2 (m, 0.5H), 2.05-1.7 (m, 2H), 1.16 (d, 1.5H), 0.89 (d, 1.5H); ESI-MS (m/z): 529.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 212: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000166_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.60 (d, 0.7H), 8.51 (s, 0.7H), 8.42 (d, 1.3H), 8.35 (s, 0.3H), 8.15-8.10 (m, 1H), 7.81-7.78 (m, 1H), 7.05-7.0 (m, 0.4H), 6.95-6.92 (m, 0.6H), 6.84-6.80 (m, 1H), 5.30-5.15 (m, 1H), 4.86 (m, 1H), 4.56 (m, 1H), 4.2-4.05 (m, 0.3H), 3.97 (s, 2H), 3.84 (s, 1H), 3.82-3.7 (m, 0.7H), 3.65-3.5 (m, 0.6H), 3.35-3.2 (m, 0.4H), 2.5-2.3 (m, 1H), 2.25-2.05 (m, 2H), 1.19 (d, 2H), 0.95 (d, 1H); ESI-MS (m/z): 497.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 213: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(2-methyl-5-(pyrimidin-2-yl)thiazol-4-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000166_0003
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.64-8.63 (d, 0.7H), 6.62 (br s, 0.7H), 8.5 (d, 1.3H), 8.33 (s, 0.3H), 7.82-7.78 (m, 1H), 7.09-7.05 (t, 0.4H), 7.01-6.95 (t, 0.6H), 6.83-6.8 (m, 1H), 5.25-5.15 (m, 1H), 4.90-4.87 (m, 1.3H), 4.57-4.54 (m, 0.7H), 3.95 (m, 0.4H), 3.75-3.55 (m, 1.2H), 3.4- 3.25 (m, 0.4H), 2.76 (s, 2H), 2.64 (s, 1H), 2.5-2.3 (m, 1H), 2.4-1.8 (m, 2H), 1.19 (d, 2H), 0.96 (d, 1H); ESI-MS (m/z): 514.08 [M+1]+.
Compound 214: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(2-methyl-5-(pyridin-2-yl)thiazol-4-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000167_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz) δ 8.77-8.73 (m, 1H), 8.46-8.41 (m, 2H), 7.90-7.82 (m, 1H), 7.48- 7.45 (m, 1H), 7.34-7.28 (m, 1H), 7.0-6.9 (m, 0.6H), 5.35-5.30 (m, 0.5H), 5.05-4.95 (m, 0.5H), 4.85-4.70 (m, 2.5H), 4.5-4.3 (m, 0.5H), 3.8-3.6 (m, 0.5H), 3.5-3.3 (m, 0.5H), 2.98 (s, 1.5H), 2.9 (s, 1.5H), 2.8-2.6 (s, 1H), 2.4-2.3 (m, 1H), 2.25-1.8 (m, 1H), 1.2 (d, 2H), 0.9 (d, 1H); ESI-MS (m/z): 513.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 215: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)( -methyl-3-(pyrimidin-2-yl)pyridin-2-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000167_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.67 (d, 1H), 8.63-8.55 (m, 1.6H), 8.5 (s, 1H), 8.35 (br s, 0.4H), 7.8-7.7 (m, 1H), 7.35-7.25 (m, 1H), 7.25 (t, 0.5H), 7.05 (t, 0.5H), 6.8 (t, 1H), 5.2-5.1 (m, 1H), 4.9-4.85 (m, 1H), 4.7-4.6 (m, 1H), 3.8 (br s, 0.5H), 3.65-3.45 (m, 1H), 3.4-3.25 (m, 0.5H), 2.6 (s, 1.6H), 2.5 (s, 1.4H), 2.5-2.3 (m, 1H), 2.2-1.9 (m, 2H), 1.2 (d, 1.5H), 0.9 (d, 1.5H); ESI-MS (m/z): 508.4 [M+1]+.
Compound 216: (5-chloro-2-(2-methyl-2H-tetrazol-5-yl)phenyl)((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3- methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2-yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000168_0001
ESI-MS (m/z): 531.3 [M+1]+.
Compound 220: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-m hyl-4-(pyridin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000168_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.6 (br s, 0.5H), 8.5 (br s, 0.5H), 8.4 (br s, 0.5H), 8.3 (br s, 0.5H), 7.9-7.8 (m, 1H), 7.8-7.5 (m, 3H), 7.2 (m, 0.5H), 7.05 (m, 0.5H), 6.8 (d, 0.5H), 6.6 (d, 0.5H), 5.4 (m, 0.5H), 5.1 (m, 0.5H), 4.9-4.7 (m, 1H), 4.6-4.4 (m, 1H), 4.35 (m, 0.5H), 4.0 (m, 0.5H), 3.95 (s, 1.5H), 3.8 (s, 1.5H), 3.6-3.5 (m, 0.5H), 3.3-3.2 (m, 0.5H), 2.4-1.7 (m, 3H), 1.2 (d, 1.5H), 0.95 (d, 1.5H); ESI-MS (m/z): 496.0 [M+1]+.
Compound 222: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-m hyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000168_0003
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.8 (s, 1.4H), 8.7 (s, 0.6H), 8.6 (d, 0.6H), 8.5 (d, 1.4H), 8.15 (s, 0.7H), 8.1 (s, 0.3H), 7.2 (m, 0.5H), 7.0 (t, 0.3H), 6.9 (t, 0.7H), 5.4-5.2 (m, 1H), 5.0-4.9 (m, 2H), 4.2-4.1 (m, 0.3H), 4.0 (s, 2H), 3.9 (s, 1H), 3.9-3.8 (m, 0.7H), 3.75-3.6 (m, 0.7H), 3.4 (m, 0.3H), 2.5-2.4 (m, 1H), 2.4-2.0 (m, 2H), 1.2 (d, 2H), 1.0 (d, 1H); ESI-MS (m/z): 498.3 [M+1]+. Compound 223: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrazin-2- yl)oxy)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3-yl)methanone
Figure imgf000169_0001
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.65 (d, 1H), 8.6 (s, 0.5H), 8.5 (d, 1.5H), 8.4 (s, 0.5H), 8.3 (s, 0.5H), 8.15 (s, 0.55H), 8.0 (s, 0.45H), 7.05 (t, 0.4H), 7.0 (m, 0.6H), 5.4-5.35 (m, 0.5H), 5.3 (t, 0.5H), 4.9 (dd, 1H), 4.7-4.6 (m, 1H), 4.25-4.15 (m, 0.5H), 4.0 (s, 1.6H), 3.9-3.8 (m, 0.5H), 3.8 (s, 1.4H), 3.6-3.5 (m, 0.5H), 3.45-3.35 (m, 0.5H), 2.5-2.4 (m, 1H), 2.3-1.9 (m, 2H), 1.2 (d, 1.6H), 1.0 (d, 1.4H); ESI-MS (m/z): 498.2 [M+1]+.
Compound 228: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-2-(((3-fluoro-5-(trifluoromethyl)pyridin-2- yl)amino)methyl)-3-methylpiperidin-1-yl)(1-methyl-4-(pyrimidin-2-yl)-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000169_0002
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz) δ 8.65 (d, 1H), 8.6 (d, 1H), 8.25 (s, 0.5H), 8.2 (s, 0.5H), 8.15 (s, 0.5H), 8.1 (s, 0.5H), 7.35-7.2 (m, 1H), 7.1 (m, 1H), 6.7-6.6 (m, 1H), 5.35-5.2 (m, 1H), 4.35-4.25 (m, 0.5H), 4.15-4.05 (m, 0.5H), 4.0 (s, 1.5H), 3.95 (s, 1.5H), 3.9-3.8 (m, 0.5H), 3.6-3.5 (m, 0.5H), 3.5-3.3 (m, 1.5H), 3.2-3.05 (m, 0.5H), 2.5-2.4 (m, 1H), 2.2-2.1 (m, 1H), 2-1.6 (m, 1H), 1.25 (d, 1.5H), 1.0 (d, 1.5H); ESI-MS (m/z): 513.7 [M+1]+.
Compound 264: ((2S,3R)-5,5-difluoro-3-methyl-2-(((5-(trifluoromethyl)pyrimidin-2- yl)amino)methyl)piperidin-1-yl)(4-(5-fluoropyrimidin-2-yl)-1,5-dimethyl-1H-pyrazol-3- yl)methanone
Figure imgf000170_0001
ESI-MS (m/z): 529.1 [M+1]+.
Table 2. MS Characterization of Exemplary Compounds
Figure imgf000170_0002
Figure imgf000170_0003
Figure imgf000170_0004
Figure imgf000170_0005
Figure imgf000171_0001
Compound # MS (m/z)
248 514.79 249 531.35 250 500.19 253 511.2 254 461.06 264 529.1
Figure imgf000172_0001
Example 2: Orexin Receptor Cell-Based Functional Assay
Measurement of [Ca2+]i using a FLIPR: CHO-OX1 or CHO-OX2 cells were seeded into black-walled clear-base 384-well plates (Corning, catalog #3712) at a density of 20,000 cells per well in F12-K medium supplemented with 10% FBS and then incubated in a 5% CO2, 37 ºC incubator overnight to reach 90% confluency. The cells were incubated with equal volume of calcium6 loading buffer (Molecular Devices, Inc.) containing 2.5 mM probenecid at 37 °C for 2 h, followed by test compounds (dose-range 0.1 nM– 10 µM) for another 30 min. The plates were then placed into a FLIPR (Molecular Devices, Inc.) to monitor fluorescence (λ excitation 488 nm, λ emission 540 nm) before and after the addition of EC90 of [OX]. Results for exemplary compounds of Formulae (I), (Ia), (Ib), (II), (IIa), (III), (IIIa), (IV), (IVa), (V), or (Va)are shown in Table 3.
Table 3: IC50 Bioactivity of Exemplary Compounds of the Application with Respect to OX1 and
Figure imgf000172_0002
Figure imgf000173_0001
Figure imgf000174_0001
Figure imgf000175_0001
Figure imgf000176_0001
Example 3: Nicotine Self-Administration Assay
For all experiments, rats weighing 250-300 g were housed in groups of 1-23 per cage, in a temperature-controlled vivarium under a reversed 12-h light/dark cycle (lights off at 8 am). Food and water were provided ad libitum until behavioral training commences. During training, rats were food-restricted to maintain ~85-90% of their free-feeding body weight. Behavioral testing occurred during the dark portion of the light/dark cycle between the hours of 9 am-1 pm, during the early portion of the dark phase of the cycle. All procedures were conducted in strict adherence with the National Institutes of Health Guide for the Care and Use of Laboratory Animals and were approved by the Institutional Animal Care and Use Committee of The Scripps Research Institute. Rats were anesthetized by inhalation of 1-3% isoflurane in oxygen and silastic catheters were inserted into the jugular veins. Briefly, the catheters consist of a 14 cm length of silastic tubing fitted to a guide cannula (Plastics One, Wallingford, CT), bent at a curved right angle and encased in dental acrylic. The catheter tubing was passed subcutaneously from each animal’s back to the right jugular vein, and 1 cm length of the catheter tip is inserted into the vein. After surgery, catheters are flushed daily with 0.1 mL of a heparinized (30 USP units/ml) sterile saline solution. Following 7 d of surgical recovery, rats were mildly food restricted to 85-90% of their free-feeding body weight and trained to press a lever in an operant chamber (Med Associates, St. Albans, VT) for food pellets (20 mg; TestDiet, Richmond, IN) under a fixed-ratio 5, time out 20 s (FR5TO20 s) schedule of reinforcement prior to catheter implantation. Once stable responding was achieved (> 25 pellets per session), rats were permitted to acquire IV nicotine self-administration by autoshaping during 1-h daily sessions, 7 days per week. Nicotine was delivered through the tubing into the IV catheter by a Razel syringe pump (Med Associates). Each nicotine self-administration session was performed using two retractable levers (1 active; 1 inactive). Completion of the response criteria on the active lever resulted in the delivery of an IV nicotine infusion (0.03 mg/kg/infusion). After 1 week, the nicotine dose was increased to 0.1 mg/kg/inf for the remainder of the experiment, including subsequent training and test sessions. Delivery of all nicotine infusions coincided with the initiation of a 20-s time-out (TO) period, signaled by a light cue located above the lever. During the TO period, responding on the lever was recorded but without scheduled consequence.
Catheter integrity was tested with the ultrashort-acting barbiturate Brevital (methohexital sodium; Eli Lilly) at the end of the experiment.
Example 4: Metabolic Stability and Intrinsic Clearances in Rat Hepatocytes
Stock solutions of compounds and control compounds were prepared in 10 mM in appropriate solvent, such as DMSO. L-15 medium was placed in a 37 oC water bath and allowed to warm for at least 15 minutes prior to use. A quenching plate was prepared by adding 80 µL of acetonitrile to each well of a 96-well plate. In a new 96-well plate, the 10 mM stock solution of test compounds and control compounds were diluted to 100 µM by combining 198 µL of acetonitrile and 2 µL of the 10 mM stock. A vial of cryopreserved rat hepatocytes were removed from storage and maintained at cryogenic temperatures until thawing. The cells were thawed as quickly as possible, in a 37 oC water bath under gentle shaking. The vials were kept in the water bath until all ice crystals have dissolved and are no longer visible. After the thawing was completed, the vials were sprayed with 70% ethanol and transferred to a biosafety cabinet. The contents of the vial were transferred into a 50 mL conical tube containing L-15 medium. The conical tube was then centrifuged at 50 g for 3 minutes at room temperature and a pellet was formed at the bottom of the tube. After aspiration, the pellet was resuspended with a small volume of buffer (~ 200 µL) first and then diluted to 50 mL in buffer for centrifugation. Upon completion of spin and aspiration, the pellet of hepatocytes was resuspended in enough incubation medium to yield ~ 1.5x106 cells/mL.
Cells were then counted with Cellometer® Vision. Cells with poor viability (<80% viability) were not acceptable for use. Counted cells were then diluted with incubation medium to a working cell density of 1.0 × 106 viable cells/mL.247.5 μL of hepatocytes were transferred into each wells of a 96‐well cell culture plate and the plate was placed on an Eppendorf Thermomixer Comfort plate shaker to allow the hepatocytes to warm for 10 minutes.2.5 µL of 100 μM test compound or control compounds were added into an incubation well containing cells and the mixture was mixed to achieve a homogenous suspension at 0.5 min, which when achieved, were defined as the 0.5 min time point. At the 0.5 min time point, 20 µL incubated mixture was transferred to wells in a "Quenching plate" followed by vortexing. The quenching plate was incubated at 37 °C at 900 rpm on an Eppendorf Thermomixer Comfort plate shaker. At 5, 15, 30, 45, 60, 80, 100 and 120 min, the incubation system was mixed and aliquots of samples (20 µL) were transferred and incubated at each time point to wells in a separated "Quenching plate" followed by vortexing. The quenching plates were centrifuged for 20 minutes at 4,000 rpm. Four different compounds were pooled into one cassette and used for LC/MS/MS analysis. All incubations were performed in singlicate.
All calculations were carried out using Microsoft Excel. Peak areas were determined from extracted ion chromatograms. in vitro half‐life (t1/2) of parent compound was determined by regression analysis of the Ln percent parent disappearance vs. time curve. The in vitro intrinsic clearance (in vitro Clint, in μL/min/106 cells) was determined from the slope value using the following equation: in vitro Clint = kV/N: V = incubation volume (0.25 mL);
N = number of hepatocytes per well (0.25 × 106 cells).
Table 4. Metabolic Stabilit and Intrinsic Clearances in Rat Hepatocytes
Figure imgf000178_0001
Example 5: Metabolic Stability and Intrinsic Clearances in Human Liver Microsomes Human Liver Microsomes (HLM) were obtained from BD Gentest UltraPool
150 donor (Lot no.38289) at a concentration of 20 mg/mL protein. HLMs are stored in a‐80oC freezer. Prior to use, the pooled HLM were removed from the freezer and allowed to thaw in a 37 oC water bath and then stored on wet ice.100 μmol/L test compound solution and positive control (PC) solutions (phenacetin, verapamil, diclofenac, imiprimine, benzydamine and metoprolol) were prepared by adding 2 μL of 10 mmol/L stock solution in DMSO to 198 μL of acetonitrile. HML mixtures were prepared by adding 1325 μL of 20 mg/mL HLM to 22260 μL of phosphate buffer to obtain the HLM mixture at 1.1236 mg/mL. Prior to testing the compounds, 222.5 μL of 1.1236 mg/mL HLM mixtures and 25 μL of the 10 mM NADPH were mixed in the incubation plates on a whirly mixer for 10 seconds. The incubation plates were pre- warmed at 37°C for 8 min. The reaction was initiated with the addition of 2.5 μL of the 100 μM test compound solutions or PC solutions to the incubation plate and the reaction solutions were mixed on a whirly mixer for 10 seconds and incubated at 37°C.20 µL of reaction mixture was transferred at 0.5, 5, 10, 15, 20, and 30 minutes into the quenching plate containing 100 µL of cold acetonitrile. The quenching plates were then centrifuged at 4000 rpm for 20 minutes and were placed at 4°C for 30 minutes, then re‐centrifuged at 4000 rpm for 20 minutes to precipitate protein.40 µL of supernatant of each compound was transferred into a 96‐well analysis plate.4 compounds were pooled together into one cassette and 160 µL of pure water was added into each well. All incubations were performed in singlicate.
Quantitative LC-MS analysis were carried out with an API 4000 (AB sciex, USA) Ultra mass spectrometer at MRM mode (MS/MS). Peak areas were determined from extracted ion chromatograms. Percent parent remaining was calculated from peak area of test compound or PC. The slope value, k, was determined by linear regression of the natural logarithm of percent parent remaining vs. incubation time curve. All calculations were carried out using Microsoft Excel.
The in vitro half‐life (in vitro t1/2) was determined from the slope value: in vitro t1/2 =‐ (0.693 / k). Conversion of the in vitro t1/2 (in min) into the in vitro intrinsic clearance (in vitro CLint, in µL/min/mg proteins) is done using the following equation:
.
Table 5. Metabolic Stability and Intrinsic Clearances in Human Liver Microsomes
Figure imgf000179_0001
e compoun s escr e n this patent application show favorable rat and human in vitro metabolic stabilities (as measured in human liver microsomes and rat hepatocytes) as well as good in vivo pharmacokinetic properties in rodents. Example 6: Pharmacokinetic Evaluation via Intravenous Cassette Administration in Harlan RCC Strain of Wistar Rats
Two male Wistar rats (strain: Harlan RCC) of 10-12 weeks old on the day of dosing were recruited and assigned as one study group. Each rat weighed 250-300 g on the day of dosing and was not fasted prior to dosing. Rats were housed in a controlled environment (set up to maintain 20-25^ and 40-70% relative humidity). A 12-hour light/12-hour dark cycle was maintained except when interrupted by study-related events. The rats were dosed via IV bolus to tail vein over approximately 5 seconds. Individual dosing values were calculated based on the rats’ most recently recorded body weight. The dosing level was 0.5 mg/kg body weight (1 mL/kg with a concentration of 0.5 mg/mL). Rats were evaluated during in-life phase. The single dose formulation samples were collected from the middle of formulation and stored at 5±3℃ for potential analysis. Samples (0.2 mL sample size) were collected from blood via a cannulated tube in foot dorsal vein at 2 min, 5 min, 10 min, 30 min, 1 h, 2 h, 4 h, 8 h, and 24 h post dosing. EDTA was used as an anticoagulant.
The blood samples were then centrifuged at 5 minutes at 4^ to obtain plasma. Plasma samples were stored in polypropylene tubes, quickly frozen in ice box and kept at -80^. Then the plasma samples were deproteinated by solvent precipitation. Concentrations of test articles in plasma and tissue samples were analyzed using a LC-MS/MS method with 8-10 standards, 2x dilutions, with 10 ng/mL LOQ and 75% of standards within 25% of nominal; high, medium and low duplicate QCs were 5/6 < 25% error. WinNonlin version 6.2 was used for pharmacokinetic parameters calculations. PK parameters including C0, Cmax, Tmax, CL, Vss, Vz, T1/2, Tlast, AUC0-t, AUC0-infinity, AUC Extrap (%), and MRT using non-compartmental model.
To determine terminal T1/2, the latest three time points with quantifiable concentration were used. T1/2 was reported as not calculated, if the correlative coefficient (Rsq adjusted) was < 0.85 at the terminal phase. AUC were calculated using log trapezoidal method.
Example 7: Pharmacokinetics and Brain/Plasma Distribution in Male Sprague-Dawley Rats after Cassette Intravenous (Bolus) and Oral Administration
Male SD (Sprague-Dawley) rats, 250-300 g and 7-9 weeks old, were recruited and assigned into two dose groups: Group #1 for intravenous administration (IV) study and Group #2 for oral administration (PO, per os). In Group #1, rats were dosed at 0.5 mg/kg, (0.5 mg/kg for each analyte) with a dosing concentration of 0.5 mg/mL (of each analyte). The formulation for IV dosing comprises: 5: 95 DMSO:SBE-β-CD (30 % w/v) in water. pH value was adjusted with 1M HCl (SBE is same as Captisol). The formulation was administered via IV bolus at a dose volume of 1 mL/kg for each single dose. Brains were harvested from rats at 15 min after second dose on Day 2 of the study. In Group #2, rats were dosed at 1.0 mg/kg (1 mg/kg for each analyte) with a dosing concentration of 0.2 mg/mL (of each analyte). The formulation for PO dosing comprises: 0.5% HPMC, 0.1% Tween80 and were administrated via oral gavage at a level of 5 mL/kg for each single dose.150 µL of blood sample was collected per each time point in both groups at 5, 10, 15, 30, 60, 120, 240, 360, 480, 720 and 1440 min.
In a second arm study, plasma samples from each rat in both groups were collected for PK study. Brain and plasma samples from Group #1 administered an IV dose (0.5 mg/kg of each analyte as a cassette dose) were collected at 15 min post dose. Group #1 rats were dosed on second day, after the last time point (24 h) has been collected from the initial dose. Brain samples were weighed into appropriate size tubes so they can be homogenized in the same vessel. Dose solutions and plasma/brain samples were stored at -80 oC until being analyzed.
Aliquots of dose formulation were diluted with appropriate solvent and analyzed by LC/MS to obtain the concentrations of the analyte in the dosing solutions. The plasma samples from PK study were analyzed by a LC/MS/MS method developed by Frontage Laboratories according to Frontage Bioanalytical Tier 2 criteria. The brain samples were homogenized in 0.1 M phosphate buffer, pH 7.4 (1:3 volumes, brain:buffer) and an aliquot from each homogenate were further diluted 2-4 fold with control rat plasma before extracted by protein precipitation for analyses by LC/MS/MS. An aliquot of the brain homogenates (prepared in 0.1M phosphate buffer only) were also subjected to equilibrium dialysis in RED device (6 h) and free brain concentrations were determined. At the same time, LC/Ms/MS analyses of brain homogenates, plasma and samples from the RED study (all from the IV dosed animals sacrificed at 15 min post dose) were carried out. The concentrations of analytes present in plasma and brain were used to obtain brain/plasma ratio for each compound. The measured plasma concentrations of each analyte were used to obtain the PK parameters using Phoenix® WinNonlin® software (version 6.5.1). Incorporation by Reference All references cited in this application, and their references, are incorporated by reference herein in their entirety where appropriate for teachings of additional or alternative details, features, and/or technical background.

Claims

Claims 1. A compound of formula (I),
Figure imgf000183_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
X is halogen;
X’ is H or halogen;
Z is NR2 or O;
A is aryl, aroyl, heteroaryl, or heteroaroyl , wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRaRb, -N(Ra)C(O) alkyl, -N(Ra)CO2alkyl, -N(Ra)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRaRb, -SO2alkyl, and– SO2NRaRb; wherein Ra and Rb are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; B is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRcRd, -N(Rc)C(O) alkyl, -N(Rc)CO2alkyl, -N(Rc)SO2alkyl, - C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRcRd, -SO2alkyl, and–SO2NRcRd; wherein Rc and Rd are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
E is aryl or heteroaryl, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NReRf, -N(Re)C(O) alkyl, -N(Re)CO2alkyl, -N(Re)SO2alkyl, - C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONReRf, -SO2alkyl, and–SO2NReRf; wherein Re and Rf are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl;
n = 1, 2, or 3;
R1 is alkyl; and
R2 is H or alkyl.
2. The compound of claim 1, wherein A is aryl or heteroaryl.
3. The compound of claim 1 or 2, wherein the compound has the structure of formula (Ia):
Figure imgf000184_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
4. The compound of any one of claims 1-3, wherein Z is NR2.
5. The compound of any one of claims 1-4, wherein R2 is hydrogen.
6. The compound of any one of claims 1-4, wherein R2 is methyl.
7. The compound of any one of claims 1-6, wherein X is -F.
8. The compound of any one of claims 1-7, wherein X’ is -F.
9. The compound of any one of claims 1-8, wherein R1 is
Figure imgf000184_0002
10. The compound of any one of claims 1-9, wherein R1 is methyl.
11. The compound of any one of claims 1-10, wherein A is an optionally substituted
monocyclic or bicyclic heteroaryl.
12. The compound of any one of claims 1-11, wherein A is selected from the list consisting of pyridinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, and benzoxazolyl.
13. The compound of any one of claims 1-12, wherein A is pyridinyl.
14. The compound of any one of claims 1-12, wherein A is pyrimidinyl.
15. The compound of any one of claims 1-12, wherein A is pyrazinyl.
16. The compound of any one of claims 1-12, wherein A is pyridazinyl.
17. The compound of any one of claims 1-16, wherein A is unsubstituted.
18. The compound of any one of claims 1-16, wherein A is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, and halo.
19. The compound of any one of claims 1-16 or claim 18, wherein A is optionally
substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of–F, -Br, -Cl, -CF3, methyl, ethyl, and methoxy.
20. The compound of any one of claims 1-16 or claim 18, wherein A is optionally
substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the list consisting of–F, -Br, -Cl, - CHF2, -CF3, methyl, ethyl, and methoxy.
21. The compound of any one of claims 1-16 or claims 18-20 wherein A is monosubstituted.
22. The compound of claim 21, wherein A is substituted with -CHF2 or -CF3.
23. The compound of claim 21, wherein A is substituted with -CF3.
24. The compound of any one of claims 1-23, wherein B is an optionally substituted aryl. 25. The compound of any one of claims 1-24, wherein B is an optionally substituted phenyl. 26. The compound of any one of claims 1-24, wherein B is an optionally substituted
monocyclic heteroaryl or bicyclic heteroaryl.
27. The compound of any one of claims 1-23 or claims 26, wherein B is selected from the list consisting of pyridinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, imidazolyl, triazolyl, thiazolyl, thiophenyl, pyrazolyl, and benzoimidazolyl.
28. The compound of claim 27, wherein B is selected from the list consisting of pyridinyl, thiophenyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, pyrazolyl, triazolyl, and benzoimidazolyl.
29. The compound of any one of claims 1-23 or claims 26-28, wherein B is pyridinyl.
30. The compound of any one of claims 1-23 or claims 26-28, wherein B is thiophenyl. 31. The compound of any one of claims 1-23 or claims 26-28, wherein B is oxazolyl.
32. The compound of any one of claims 1-23 or claims 26-28, wherein B is thiazolyl.
33. The compound of any one of claims 1-23 or claims 26-28, wherein B is pyrazolyl.
34. The compound of any one of claims 1-23 or claims 26-28, wherein B is triazolyl.
35. The compound of any one of claims 1-23 or claims 26-28, wherein B is benzoimidazolyl. 36. The compound of any one of claims 1-35, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of an alkyl, halo, alkoxy, and–CN.
37. The compound of any one of claims 1-36, wherein B is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of -F, -Cl, -Br, -CN, methyl, ethyl, isopropyl, -CF3, -CH2CF3, isopropoxy, and methoxy.
38. The compound of claim 37, wherein B is substituted with one or more methyl.
39. The compound of any one of claims 1-38, wherein B is monosubstituted.
40. The compound of claim 39, wherein B is substituted with methyl.
41. The compound of any one of claims 1-40, wherein E is an optionally substituted phenyl. 42. The compound of any one of claims 1-40, wherein E is an optionally substituted
monocyclic heteroaryl.
43. The compound of any one of claims 1-40 or 42, wherein E is selected from the group consisting of triazolyl, tetrazolyl, pyrazolyl, pyridinyl, oxadiazolyl, pyrazinyl, and pyrimidinyl.
44. The compound of any one of claims 1- 40 or 42, wherein E is triazolyl.
45. The compound of any one of claims 1- 40 or 42, wherein E is tetrazolyl.
46. The compound of any one of claims 1- 40 or 42, wherein E is pyrazolyl.
47. The compound of any one of claims 1- 40 or 42, wherein E is pyridinyl.
48. The compound of any one of claims 1- 40 or 42, wherein E isoxadiazolyl.
49. The compound of any one of claims 1- 40 or 42, wherein E is pyrimidinyl.
50. The compound of any one of claims 1-49, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halo, and alkoxy.
51. The compound of any one of claims 1-50, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more -F, -Cl, -Br, methoxy, methyl, ethyl,–CF2H or–CF3.
52. The compound of claim 51, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more -F, -Cl, -Br, methoxy, methyl, ethyl, or–CF3.
53. The compound of any one of claims 1-52, wherein E is optionally substituted with one or more methyl or -F.
54. The compound of any one of claims 1-53, wherein E is monosubstituted.
55. The compound of any one of claims 1-49, wherein E is unsubstituted.
56. The compound of any one of claims 1-23, wherein the fragment -B-E has the structure
Figure imgf000186_0001
wherein:
Y, independently for each occurrence, represents CH or N; and
R3 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRgRh, -N(Rg)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rg)CO2alkyl, -N(Rg)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRgRh, - SO2alkyl, or–SO2NRgRh; wherein Rg and Rh are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
57. The compound of claim 56, wherein the structure
Figure imgf000187_0004
is selected from the following:
58.
Figure imgf000187_0001
59. The compound of any one of claims 56-58, wherein R3 is alkyl or alkoxy.
60. The compound of any one of claims 56-59, wherein R3 is -CH3, -CF3, or methoxy.
61. The compound of any one of the claims 1-23 or claims 56-57, wherein the fragment -B-E
has the structure
Figure imgf000187_0002
62. The compound of claim 61, wherein R3 is CN, halo or alkyl.
63. The compound of claim 62, wherein R3 is -F, -Cl, -CN, or methyl.
64. The compound of any one of claims 1-23, wherein the fragment -B-E forms a hetero- aromatic ring structure of
Figure imgf000187_0003
wherein:
, independently for each occurrence, represents a single or double bond; W, independently for each occurrence, represents N, S, O, or CH; V represents N or C; and
R4 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRiRj, - N(Ri)C(O) alkyl, -N(Ri)CO2alkyl, -N(Ri)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, - CO2alkyl, -CONRiRj, -SO2alkyl, or–SO2NRiRj; wherein Ri and Rj are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl.
Figure imgf000188_0001
66. The compound of claim 64, wherein the structure .
67. The compound of claim 64, wherein the structure
68. The compound of any one of claims 64-67, where
Figure imgf000188_0002
69. The compound of claim 68, wherein R4 is methyl.
70. The compound of any of claims 1-3 or 7-69, wherein Z is O.
71. The compound of any of claims 1-70, wherein n =1.
72. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound has a structure of formula (II):
Figure imgf000189_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; wherein:
m is 1, 2, or 3;
R5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRjRk, -N(Rj)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rj)CO2alkyl, -N(Rj)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRjRk, - SO2alkyl, or–SO2NRjRk; wherein Rj and Rk are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
X, X’, Z, B, E, n, R1 and R2 are as defined in claim 1.
73. The compound of claim 1 wherein the com ound has a structure of formula (III):
Figure imgf000189_0002
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; wherein:
m is 1, 2, 3 or 4;
R5 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRjRk, -N(Rj)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rj)CO2alkyl, -N(Rj)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRjRk, - SO k
2alkyl, or–SO2NRjRk; wherein Rj and R are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
X, X’, Z, B, E, n, R1 and R2 are as defined in claim 1.
74. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound has a structure of formula (IV):
Figure imgf000189_0003
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof; wherein: R6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRoRp, -N(Ro)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rp)CO2alkyl, -N(Ro)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRoRp, - SO2alkyl, or–SO2NRoRp; wherein Ro and Rp are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
X, X’, Z, A, E, n, R1 and R2 are as defined in claim 1.
75. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound has a structure of formula (V):
Figure imgf000190_0003
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, wherein:
R6 represents alkyl, cycloalkyl, halo, -OH, alkoxy, -CN, -NRoRp, -N(Ro)C(O) alkyl, - N(Rp)CO2alkyl, -N(Ro)SO2alkyl, -C(O)alkyl, -CO2H, -CO2alkyl, -CONRoRp, - SO2alkyl, or–SO2NRoRp; wherein Ro and Rp are independently for each occurrence H or alkyl; and
X, X’, Z, A, E, n, R1 and R2 are as defined in claim 1.
76. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound is compound 185,
Figure imgf000190_0001
, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
77. The compound of claim 1, wherein the compound is compound 129,
Figure imgf000190_0002
, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
78. The com ound of claim 1 wherein the compound is compound 217,
Figure imgf000191_0001
, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
79. The com ound of claim 1, wherein the compound is compound 264,
Figure imgf000191_0002
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
80. The com ound of claim 1 wherein the compound is compound 66,
Figure imgf000191_0003
, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
81. The com ound of claim 1 wherein the compound is compound
211,
Figure imgf000191_0004
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
82. A compound selected from the group consisting of compounds as shown in Table 1, and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
83. A pharmaceutical composition comprising (a) a compound of any of the preceding
claims; and (b) a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
84. A compound of any one of claims 1-82 or a pharmaceutical composition of claim 83 for use as a medicament.
85. A method of treating a disease or disorder mediated by orexin receptor activity,
comprising administering to a subject in need of such treatment an effective amount of at least one compound of any one of claims 1-82 or a pharmaceutical composition of claim 83.
86. The method of claim 85, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group
consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease,
Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, pain, epilepsy, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, and psychosexual disorder.
87. The method of claim 86, wherein the drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine. 88. The method of claim 85, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group
consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
89. Use of a compound of any of claims 1-82 or a pharmaceutical composition of claim 83, in the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of diseases or disorders regulated by orexin receptor activity, and the use of such compounds for treatment of such diseases and disorders.
90. The use of claim 89, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group
consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease,
Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, pain, epilepsy, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, and psychosexual disorder.
91. The use of claim 90, wherein the drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine. 92. The use of claim 89, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group
consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
93. Use of a compound of any one of claims 1-82 or a pharmaceutical composition of claim 83, in the preparation of a medicament for treating a disease or disorder in a patient in need thereof.
94. The use of claim 93, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group
consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease,
Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, pain, epilepsy, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, and psychosexual disorder.
95. The use of claim 94, wherein the drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine. 96. The use of claim 93, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group
consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
97. A method of modulating the activity of an orexin receptor OX1, OX2, or both,
comprising contacting a cell comprising the orexin receptor with an effective amount of at least one compound of any one of claims 1-82 or a pharmaceutical composition of claim 83.
98. The method of claim 97, wherein the contacting is in vitro, ex vivo, or in vivo.
99. A method of treating a disease or disorder in a patient in need thereof, comprising
administering a compound of any one of claims 1-82 or a pharmaceutical composition of claim 83.
100. The method of claim 99, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group
consisting of drug abuse or addiction, a sleep disorder, a cognitive dysfunction in a psychiatric or neurologic disorder, depression, anxiety, panic disorder, post-traumatic stress disorder, seasonal affective disorder, schizophrenia, Alzheimer’s disease,
Parkinson’s disease, Huntington’s chorea, pain, behavior disorder, mood disorder, manic depression, dementia, sex disorder, and psychosexual disorder.
101. The method of claim 99, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group
consisting of an eating disorder, obesity, alcoholism or an alcohol-related disorder, headache, migraine, gastrointestinal diseases, inflammations, immune-related diseases, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, diarrhea, gastroesophageal reflux, endocrine-related diseases, cancer, hypertension, and renal disease.
102. The method of claim 99, wherein the disease or disorder is selected from the group consisting of drug abuse or addiction, panic disorder, anxiety, post-traumatic stress disorder, pain, depression, seasonal affective disorder, an eating disorder, and hypertension.
103. The method of claim 100 or 102, wherein the drug abuse or addiction is selected from abuse of or addiction to cocaine, opiates, amphetamines, ethanol, cannabis/marijuana, or nicotine.
PCT/US2017/017408 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators WO2017139603A1 (en)

Priority Applications (27)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
MX2018009656A MX2018009656A (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators.
EP17750847.0A EP3414241B1 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
RS20220714A RS63471B1 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
AU2017217931A AU2017217931B2 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
CN201780022666.9A CN109219606B (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halogen substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
ES17750847T ES2923790T3 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halosubstituted piperidines as modulators of orexin receptors
MYPI2018702747A MY195239A (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-Substituted Piperidines as Orexin Receptor Modulators
PL17750847.0T PL3414241T3 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
CA3013927A CA3013927C (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
HRP20220906TT HRP20220906T1 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
LTEPPCT/US2017/017408T LT3414241T (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
DK17750847.0T DK3414241T3 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 HALOGEN SUBSTITUTED PIPERIDINES AS OREXIN RECEPTOR MODULATORS
TNP/2018/000280A TN2018000280A1 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators.
BR112018016446-1A BR112018016446B1 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 HALO-SUBSTITUTED PIPERIDINE COMPOUND, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION COMPRISING SAID COMPOUND AND THERAPEUTIC USE THEREOF
SG11201806368VA SG11201806368VA (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
CR20180429A CR20180429A (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 PIPERIDINS REPLACED WITH HALO AS MODULATORS OF THE OREXINE RECEIVER
EA201891714A EA036542B9 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
SI201731191T SI3414241T1 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
KR1020187025645A KR20180107232A (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 The halo-substituted piperidine as an orexin receptor modulator
JP2018542231A JP6883045B2 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidine as an orexin receptor regulator
US16/076,818 US10894789B2 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
IL260788A IL260788B (en) 2016-02-12 2018-07-26 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
PH12018501708A PH12018501708A1 (en) 2016-02-12 2018-08-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
ZA2018/05839A ZA201805839B (en) 2016-02-12 2018-08-30 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
CONC2018/0009290A CO2018009290A2 (en) 2016-02-12 2018-09-04 Halo substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
US17/116,773 US11434236B2 (en) 2016-02-12 2020-12-09 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
US17/868,856 US12084437B2 (en) 2016-02-12 2022-07-20 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US201662294940P 2016-02-12 2016-02-12
US62/294,940 2016-02-12
US201662336102P 2016-05-13 2016-05-13
US62/336,102 2016-05-13

Related Child Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US16/076,818 A-371-Of-International US10894789B2 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
US17/116,773 Continuation US11434236B2 (en) 2016-02-12 2020-12-09 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2017139603A1 true WO2017139603A1 (en) 2017-08-17

Family

ID=59563558

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2017/017408 WO2017139603A1 (en) 2016-02-12 2017-02-10 Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators

Country Status (32)

Country Link
US (3) US10894789B2 (en)
EP (1) EP3414241B1 (en)
JP (1) JP6883045B2 (en)
KR (1) KR20180107232A (en)
CN (1) CN109219606B (en)
AU (1) AU2017217931B2 (en)
BR (1) BR112018016446B1 (en)
CA (1) CA3013927C (en)
CL (1) CL2018002121A1 (en)
CO (1) CO2018009290A2 (en)
CR (1) CR20180429A (en)
DK (1) DK3414241T3 (en)
DO (1) DOP2018000179A (en)
EA (1) EA036542B9 (en)
ES (1) ES2923790T3 (en)
HR (1) HRP20220906T1 (en)
HU (1) HUE059280T2 (en)
IL (1) IL260788B (en)
LT (1) LT3414241T (en)
MX (1) MX2018009656A (en)
MY (1) MY195239A (en)
PH (1) PH12018501708A1 (en)
PL (1) PL3414241T3 (en)
PT (1) PT3414241T (en)
RS (1) RS63471B1 (en)
SG (1) SG11201806368VA (en)
SI (1) SI3414241T1 (en)
SV (1) SV2018005731A (en)
TN (1) TN2018000280A1 (en)
TW (1) TWI710557B (en)
WO (1) WO2017139603A1 (en)
ZA (1) ZA201805839B (en)

Cited By (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2019063605A1 (en) * 2017-09-28 2019-04-04 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Novel n-(2,2-difluoroethyl)-n-[(pyrimidinylamino)propanyl]arylcarboxamides
WO2020023723A1 (en) * 2018-07-27 2020-01-30 Icahn School Of Medicine At Mount Sinai Method of treating aggression with orexin receptor antagonists
WO2021085550A1 (en) 2019-11-01 2021-05-06 ユニマテック株式会社 Fluorinated pyrimidine compound and method for manufacturing same
US11660293B2 (en) 2017-09-01 2023-05-30 Chronos Therapeutics Limited Substituted 2-azabicyclo[3.1.1]heptane and 2-azabicyclo[3.2.1]octane derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists

Families Citing this family (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2017139603A1 (en) * 2016-02-12 2017-08-17 Astrazeneca Ab Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators

Citations (15)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4172896A (en) 1978-06-05 1979-10-30 Dainippon Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Methane-sulfonamide derivatives, the preparation thereof and composition comprising the same
US5358970A (en) 1993-08-12 1994-10-25 Burroughs Wellcome Co. Pharmaceutical composition containing bupropion hydrochloride and a stabilizer
US5427798A (en) 1992-08-14 1995-06-27 Burroughs Wellcome Co. Controlled sustained release tablets containing bupropion
US5541231A (en) 1993-07-30 1996-07-30 Glaxo Wellcome Inc. Stabilized Pharmaceutical
US5731000A (en) 1993-07-30 1998-03-24 Glaxo Wellcome Inc. Stabilized pharmaceutical composition containing bupropion
US6110973A (en) 1998-01-29 2000-08-29 Sepracor Methods for treating obesity and weight gain using optically pure (-)-bupropion
US6583124B2 (en) 1997-07-29 2003-06-24 Alcon Manufacturing, Ltd. Ophthalmic compositions containing galactomannan polymers and borate
US20050004074A1 (en) 2003-07-01 2005-01-06 Allergan, Inc. Inhibition of irritating side effects associated with use of a topical ophthalmic medication
US20050031697A1 (en) 2003-08-07 2005-02-10 Allergan, Inc. Compositions for delivery of therapeutics into the eyes and methods for making and using same
US20050059744A1 (en) 2003-09-12 2005-03-17 Allergan, Inc. Methods and compositions for the treatment of pain and other alpha 2 adrenergic-mediated conditions
US20050080056A1 (en) 1999-09-16 2005-04-14 Gerald Horn Ophthalmic formulations including selective alpha 1 antagonists
WO2008147518A1 (en) 2007-05-23 2008-12-04 Merck & Co., Inc. Pyridyl piperidine orexin receptor antagonists
WO2013119639A1 (en) * 2012-02-07 2013-08-15 Eolas Therapeutics, Inc. Substituted prolines / piperidines as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2013127913A1 (en) * 2012-03-01 2013-09-06 Rottapharm S.P.A. 4,4-difluoro-piperidine-compounds
WO2015123355A1 (en) * 2014-02-12 2015-08-20 Eolas Therapeutics, Inc. Substituted prolines / piperidines as orexin receptor antagonists

Family Cites Families (144)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5049578A (en) 1990-03-09 1991-09-17 E. R. Squibb & Sons, Inc. 1-aroyl or 1-acyl-2-2pyrrolidinyl-3,5-dihydroxy alkanoic and alkenoic acids, salts, esters and lactones
EP1075478B1 (en) 1998-05-08 2003-04-16 SmithKline Beecham plc Phenylurea and phenylthio urea derivatives
WO2000047576A1 (en) 1999-02-12 2000-08-17 Smithkline Beecham Plc Cinnamide derivatives as orexin-1 receptors antagonists
AU2804400A (en) 1999-02-12 2000-08-29 Smithkline Beecham Plc Phenyl urea and phenyl thiourea derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2000047580A2 (en) 1999-02-12 2000-08-17 Smithkline Beecham Plc Phenyl urea and phenyl thiourea derivatives
AU5041300A (en) 1999-05-24 2000-12-12 Cor Therapeutics, Inc. Inhibitors of factor xa
AU779266B2 (en) 2000-05-11 2005-01-13 Banyu Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. N-acyltetrahydroisoquinoline derivatives
US6677354B2 (en) 2000-06-16 2004-01-13 Smithkline Beecham P.L.C. Piperdines for use as orexin receptor antagonists
EP1353918B1 (en) 2000-11-28 2005-01-12 Smithkline Beecham Plc Morpholine derivatives as antagonists of orexin receptors
WO2002051232A2 (en) 2000-12-27 2002-07-04 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd. Novel benzazepines and related heterocyclic derivatives
BR0209334A (en) 2001-05-05 2004-06-15 Smithkline Beecham Plc Cyclic n-aroil amines
US20040192673A1 (en) 2001-05-05 2004-09-30 Pascale Gaillard N-aroyl cyclic amine derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
GB0115862D0 (en) 2001-06-28 2001-08-22 Smithkline Beecham Plc Compounds
GB0124463D0 (en) 2001-10-11 2001-12-05 Smithkline Beecham Plc Compounds
GB0126292D0 (en) 2001-11-01 2002-01-02 Smithkline Beecham Plc Compounds
GB0127145D0 (en) 2001-11-10 2002-01-02 Smithkline Beecham Compounds
GB0130393D0 (en) 2001-12-19 2002-02-06 Smithkline Beecham Plc Compounds
GB0130341D0 (en) 2001-12-19 2002-02-06 Smithkline Beecham Plc Compounds
GB0130335D0 (en) 2001-12-19 2002-02-06 Smithkline Beecham Plc Compounds
JP4498922B2 (en) 2002-07-09 2010-07-07 アクテリオン ファーマシューティカルズ リミテッド 7,8,9,10-Tetrahydro-6H-azepino, 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-pyrido and 2,3-dihydro-2H-pyrrolo [2,1-b] -quinazolinone derivatives
AU2003262516A1 (en) 2002-09-18 2004-04-08 Glaxo Group Limited N-aroyl cyclic amines as orexin receptor antagonists
KR20050043988A (en) 2002-10-11 2005-05-11 액테리온 파마슈티칼 리미티드 Sulfonylamino-acetic acid derivatives and their use as orexin receptor antagonists
GB0225938D0 (en) 2002-11-06 2002-12-11 Glaxo Group Ltd Novel compounds
GB0225884D0 (en) 2002-11-06 2002-12-11 Glaxo Group Ltd Novel compounds
GB0225944D0 (en) 2002-11-06 2002-12-11 Glaxo Group Ltd Novel compounds
AU2003299648A1 (en) 2002-12-12 2004-06-30 Janssen Pharmaceutica, N.V. Substituted 4-phenyl-(1,3)-dioxanes
CN100432056C (en) 2003-03-26 2008-11-12 埃科特莱茵药品有限公司 Tetrahydroisoquinolyl acetamide derivatives for use as orexin receptor antagonists
ES2297413T3 (en) 2003-04-28 2008-05-01 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd. QUINOXALINONA-3-ONA DERIVATIVES USED AS AN OREXINE RECEIVER ANTAGONISTS.
HUP0304101A3 (en) 2003-12-22 2008-10-28 Sanofi Aventis Pyrazole derivatives, process for producing them, their use, pharmaceutical compositions containing them and their intermediates
HUP0400405A3 (en) 2004-02-10 2009-03-30 Sanofi Synthelabo Pyrimidine derivatives, process for producing them, their use, pharmaceutical compositions containing them and their intermediates
CA2557163C (en) 2004-03-01 2011-08-16 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Substituted 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinoline derivatives
WO2006067224A2 (en) 2004-12-23 2006-06-29 Biovitrum Ab (Publ) Spiro-benzodioxole and spiro-benzodioxane compounds as orexin receptor antagonists
EP1871752A4 (en) 2005-04-12 2009-09-30 Merck & Co Inc Amidopropoxyphenyl orexin receptor antagonists
US7968289B2 (en) 2005-05-03 2011-06-28 Ensemble Therapeutics Corporation Turn over probes and use thereof for nucleic acid detection
JP2008542276A (en) 2005-05-23 2008-11-27 メルク エンド カムパニー インコーポレーテッド Proline bisamidoorexin receptor antagonist
CA2617324A1 (en) 2005-08-04 2007-02-15 Merck & Co., Inc. Aminoethane sulfonamide orexin receptor antagonists
AU2006282955A1 (en) 2005-08-26 2007-03-01 Merck & Co., Inc. Diazaspirodecane orexin receptor antagonists
WO2007061763A2 (en) 2005-11-22 2007-05-31 Merck & Co., Inc. Indole orexin receptor antagonists
CN101009515A (en) 2006-01-24 2007-08-01 华为技术有限公司 Management method of the communication terminal device and communication terminal
TW200800020A (en) 2006-01-26 2008-01-01 Basf Ag Methods to use 3-pyridyl derivatives as pesticides
FR2896798A1 (en) 2006-01-27 2007-08-03 Sanofi Aventis Sa SULFONAMIDE DERIVATIVES, THEIR PREPARATION AND THEIR THERAPEUTIC APPLICATION
FR2896799B1 (en) 2006-02-02 2008-03-28 Sanofi Aventis Sa SULFONAMIDE DERIVATIVES, THEIR PREPARATION AND THEIR THERAPEUTIC APPLICATION
US20090105318A1 (en) 2006-03-29 2009-04-23 Coleman Paul J Amidoethylthioether Orexin Receptor Antagonists
WO2007116374A1 (en) 2006-04-11 2007-10-18 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Novel sulfonamide compounds
WO2007122591A2 (en) 2006-04-26 2007-11-01 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Pyrazolo-tetrahydro pyridine derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2007143813A1 (en) 2006-06-16 2007-12-21 Husky Injection Molding Systems Ltd. Preventative maintenance update system
WO2008008517A2 (en) 2006-07-14 2008-01-17 Merck & Co., Inc. Bridged diazepan orexin receptor antagonists
DK2049529T3 (en) 2006-07-14 2010-11-29 Merck Sharp & Dohme Substituted diazepan-orexin receptor antagonists
US20100029736A1 (en) 2006-07-14 2010-02-04 Merck & Co., Inc. 2-substituted proline bis-amide orexin receptor antagonists
CN101506199A (en) 2006-08-15 2009-08-12 埃科特莱茵药品有限公司 Azetidine compounds as orexin receptor antagonists
JP2010502587A (en) 2006-08-28 2010-01-28 アクテリオン ファーマシューティカルズ リミテッド 1,4,5,6,7,8-Hexahydro-1,2,5-triaza-azulene derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
ATE481383T1 (en) 2006-09-29 2010-10-15 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd 3-AZA-BICYCLOÄ3.1.0ÜHEXANE DERIVATIVES
DE602007012142D1 (en) 2006-12-01 2011-03-03 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd 3-heteroaryl (amino bzw. amido)-1- (biphenyl bzw. phenylthiazolyl) carbonylpiperdinderivate als orexinrezeptor-inhibitoren
PE20081229A1 (en) 2006-12-01 2008-08-28 Merck & Co Inc DIAZEPAM OREXIN RECEPTOR ANTAGONISTS REPLACED
CN101568542B (en) 2006-12-22 2013-03-27 埃科特莱茵药品有限公司 5,6,7,8-tetrahydro-imidazo[1,5-a]pyrazine derivatives
CL2007003827A1 (en) 2006-12-28 2008-09-26 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd COMPOUNDS DERIVED FROM N- (2-AZA-BICYCLE (3.1.0) HEX-3-ILMETIL) AMIDA; AND ITS USE TO PREVENT OR TREAT DEPRESSION, NEUROSIS, SCHIZOPHRENIA, ANXIETY, ADDICTIONS, EPILEPSY, PAIN, HEART DISEASES, AMONG OTHERS.
WO2008087611A2 (en) 2007-01-19 2008-07-24 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Pyrrolidine- and piperidine- bis-amide derivatives
AU2008223546A1 (en) 2007-03-02 2008-09-12 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Bipyridine carboxamide orexin receptor antagonists
MX2009009121A (en) 2007-03-05 2009-09-03 Hoffmann La Roche Aminoamides as orexin antagonists.
BRPI0808737A2 (en) 2007-03-15 2014-08-12 Hoffmann La Roche MALONAMIDES AS OREXIN ANTAGONISTS.
CL2008000836A1 (en) 2007-03-26 2008-11-07 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Thiazolidine derivative compounds, orexin receptor antagonists; pharmaceutical composition that includes them; and its use in the treatment of emotional neurosis, severe depression, psychotic disorders, Alzheimer's, parkinson's, pain, among others.
CA2681163A1 (en) 2007-04-04 2008-10-16 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Heterocycles as orexin antagonists
DE602008002934D1 (en) 2007-05-14 2010-11-18 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd 2-CYCLOPROPYLTHIAZOLDERIVATE
EP2150114A4 (en) 2007-05-18 2012-01-18 Merck Sharp & Dohme Oxo bridged diazepan orexin receptor antagonists
WO2008150364A1 (en) 2007-05-23 2008-12-11 Merck & Co., Inc. Cyclopropyl pyrrolidine orexin receptor antagonists
EP2164847B1 (en) 2007-07-03 2011-09-14 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd. 3-aza-bicyclo[3.3.0]octane compounds
CN101790515A (en) 2007-07-27 2010-07-28 埃科特莱茵药品有限公司 trans-3-aza-bicyclo[3.1.0]hexane derivatives
US8288429B2 (en) 2007-07-27 2012-10-16 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd. 2-aza-bicyclo[3.3.0]octane derivatives
AU2008281876A1 (en) 2007-08-02 2009-02-05 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Monoamide derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2009020642A1 (en) 2007-08-09 2009-02-12 Merck & Co., Inc. Pyridine carboxamide orexin receptor antagonists
NZ583823A (en) 2007-08-10 2011-07-29 Cortex Pharma Inc Furazanes for enhancing glutamatergic synaptic responses
KR20100055464A (en) 2007-08-15 2010-05-26 액테리온 파마슈티칼 리미티드 1,2-diamido-ethylene derivatives as orexin antagonists
WO2009040730A2 (en) 2007-09-24 2009-04-02 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Pyrrolidines and piperidines as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2009058238A1 (en) 2007-10-29 2009-05-07 Merck & Co., Inc. Substituted diazepan orexin receptor antagonists
EP2231155A4 (en) 2007-12-18 2011-09-14 Concert Pharmaceuticals Inc Tetrahydroisoquinoline derivatives
AU2008340421B2 (en) 2007-12-21 2013-12-19 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Heteroaryl derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2009092642A1 (en) 2008-01-21 2009-07-30 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Sulfonamides as orexin antagonists
BRPI0907627A2 (en) 2008-02-12 2015-07-21 Hoffmann La Roche Piperidine Sulphonamides Derivatives
MX2010008993A (en) 2008-02-21 2010-09-07 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd 2-aza-bicyclo[2.2.1]heptane derivatives.
GB0806536D0 (en) 2008-04-10 2008-05-14 Glaxo Group Ltd Novel compounds
KR20110020906A (en) 2008-06-11 2011-03-03 액테리온 파마슈티칼 리미티드 Tetrazole compounds as orexin receptor antagonists
MX2010013192A (en) 2008-06-16 2010-12-17 Hoffmann La Roche Heteroaromatic monoamides as orexinin receptor antagonists.
EP2307417A2 (en) 2008-06-25 2011-04-13 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd. 5,6,7,8-tetrahydro-imidazo[1,5-a]pyrazine compounds
US20110105491A1 (en) 2008-07-07 2011-05-05 Hamed Aissaoui Thiazolidine compounds as orexin receptor antagonists
MX2011000462A (en) 2008-07-29 2011-04-05 Hoffmann La Roche Pyrrolidin-3-ylmethyl-amine as orexin antagonists.
AR072899A1 (en) 2008-08-07 2010-09-29 Merck Sharp & Dohme DERIVATIVES OF TERPIRIDINE-CARBOXAMIDE ANTAGONISTS OF OREXIN RECEPTORS, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS CONTAINING THEM AND USE OF THE SAME IN THE TREATMENT OF INSOMNIUM AND OBESITY.
EP2161266A1 (en) 2008-08-22 2010-03-10 EVOTEC Neurosciences GmbH Benzofuran derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
KR20110071004A (en) 2008-10-14 2011-06-27 액테리온 파마슈티칼 리미티드 Phenethylamide derivatives and their heterocyclic analogues
CA2739916A1 (en) 2008-10-21 2010-04-29 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. 2,5-disubstituted piperidine orexin receptor antagonists
AU2009307920A1 (en) 2008-10-21 2010-04-29 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. 2,3-disubstituted piperidine orexin receptor antagonists
CA2739917A1 (en) 2008-10-21 2010-04-29 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. 2,5-disubstituted morpholine orexin receptor antagonists
CA2739919A1 (en) 2008-10-21 2010-04-29 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. 2,4-disubstituted pyrrolidine orexin receptor antagonists
CA2739915A1 (en) 2008-10-21 2010-04-29 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. 2,5-disubstituted piperidine orexin receptor antagonists
AU2009307921A1 (en) 2008-10-21 2010-04-29 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Disubstituted azepan orexin receptor antagonists
EP2349267B1 (en) 2008-10-30 2014-06-25 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Pyridazine carboxamide orexin receptor antagonists
JP5635991B2 (en) 2008-10-30 2014-12-03 メルク・シャープ・アンド・ドーム・コーポレーションMerck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Isonicotinamide orexin receptor antagonist
US8399494B2 (en) 2008-10-30 2013-03-19 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. 2,5-disubstituted phenyl carboxamide orexin receptor antagonists
WO2010060472A1 (en) 2008-11-26 2010-06-03 Glaxo Group Limited Imidazopyridazine derivatives acting as orexin antagonists
JP2012509911A (en) 2008-11-26 2012-04-26 グラクソ グループ リミテッド New compounds
EP2358711A1 (en) 2008-11-26 2011-08-24 Glaxo Group Limited Piperidine derivatives useful as orexin receptor antagonists
AR074238A1 (en) 2008-12-02 2010-12-29 Glaxo Group Ltd COMPOSITE OF N - {[(1R, 4S, 6R) -3- (2-PIRIDINILCARBONIL) -3-AZABICICLO [4,1.0] HEPT-4-IL] METHYL} -2-HETEROARYLAMINE, ITS USE FOR THE PREPARATION OF A USEFUL MEDICATION FOR THE TREATMENT OF A DISEASE THAT REQUIRES AN ANTAGONIST OF THE RECEIVER OF HUMAN OREXIN AND PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION THAT UNDERSTANDS
MX2011005799A (en) 2008-12-02 2011-06-20 Glaxo Group Ltd N-{[(ir,4s,6r-3-(2-pyridinylcarbonyl)-3-azabicyclo [4.1.0] hept-4-yl] methyl}-2-heteroarylamine derivatives and uses thereof.
JP2010155827A (en) 2008-12-04 2010-07-15 Takeda Chem Ind Ltd Spiro-ring compound
GB0823467D0 (en) 2008-12-23 2009-01-28 Glaxo Group Ltd Novel Compounds
US20100222396A1 (en) 2009-01-30 2010-09-02 Novartis Ag 4-aryl-butane-1,3-diamides
EA201171293A1 (en) 2009-04-24 2012-05-30 Глэксо Груп Лимитед 3-AZABICYCLO [4.1.0] HEPTANS APPLIED AS ANTAGONISTS OF OREXIN
EP2451281A4 (en) 2009-07-09 2013-03-13 Merck Sharp & Dohme Tetrahydronapthyridine orexin receptor antagonists
EP2275421A1 (en) 2009-07-15 2011-01-19 Rottapharm S.p.A. Spiro amino compounds suitable for the treatment of inter alia sleep disorders and drug addiction
WO2011016234A1 (en) 2009-08-04 2011-02-10 Raqualia Pharma Inc. Picolinamide derivatives as ttx-s blockers
EP2470523A1 (en) 2009-08-24 2012-07-04 Glaxo Group Limited 5-methyl-piperidine derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists for the treatment of sleep disorder
EP2470525A1 (en) 2009-08-24 2012-07-04 Glaxo Group Limited Piperidine derivatives used as orexin antagonists
MX2012004753A (en) 2009-10-23 2012-09-07 Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv Disubstituted octahy - dropyrrolo [3,4-c] pyrroles as orexin receptor modulators.
US8680275B2 (en) 2009-10-23 2014-03-25 Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv Fused heterocyclic compounds as orexin receptor modulators
US9062044B2 (en) 2009-10-23 2015-06-23 Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv Disubstituted octahydropyrrolo[3,4-c]pyrroles as orexin receptor modulators
US20120196901A1 (en) 2009-10-29 2012-08-02 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Tertiary amide orexin receptor antagonists
EP2504316A1 (en) 2009-11-23 2012-10-03 MSD Oss B.V. Heterocylic compounds as antagonists of the orexin receptors
WO2011073316A1 (en) 2009-12-18 2011-06-23 Novartis Ag 4-aryl-butane-1,3-diamides
WO2011076744A1 (en) 2009-12-21 2011-06-30 Novartis Ag Disubstituted heteroaryl-fused pyridines
EP2516439B1 (en) 2009-12-21 2014-01-22 Novartis AG Diaza-spiro[5.5]undecanes as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2011138266A1 (en) 2010-05-03 2011-11-10 Evotec Ag Indolizine and imidazopyridine derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2011138265A2 (en) 2010-05-03 2011-11-10 Evotec Ag Indole and indazole derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
KR20140000703A (en) 2010-12-17 2014-01-03 다이쇼 세이야꾸 가부시끼가이샤 Pyrazole derivative
US20120165331A1 (en) 2010-12-22 2012-06-28 Sangamesh Badiger Di/tri-aza-spiro-C9-C11alkanes
WO2012085857A1 (en) 2010-12-22 2012-06-28 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd 3,8-diaza-bicyclo[4.2.0]oct-3-yl amides
US20120165339A1 (en) 2010-12-22 2012-06-28 Eisai R&D Management Co., Ltd. Cyclopropane derivatives
WO2012089606A1 (en) 2010-12-28 2012-07-05 Glaxo Group Limited Azabicyclo [4.1.0] hept - 4 - yl derivatives as human orexin receptor antagonists
WO2012089607A1 (en) 2010-12-28 2012-07-05 Glaxo Group Limited Novel compounds with a 3a-azabicyclo [4.1.0] heptane core acting on orexin receptors
WO2012110986A1 (en) 2011-02-18 2012-08-23 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Novel pyrazole and imidazole derivatives useful as orexin antagonists
WO2012114252A1 (en) 2011-02-21 2012-08-30 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd Novel indole and pyrrolopyridine amides
US9586962B2 (en) 2011-04-20 2017-03-07 Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv Disubstituted octahydropyrrolo [3,4-C] pyrroles as orexin receptor modulators
WO2012153729A1 (en) 2011-05-10 2012-11-15 大正製薬株式会社 Heteroaromatic ring derivative
JPWO2013005755A1 (en) 2011-07-05 2015-02-23 大正製薬株式会社 Methylpiperidine derivatives
WO2013050938A1 (en) 2011-10-04 2013-04-11 Actelion Pharmaceuticals Ltd 3,7-diazabicyclo[3.3.1]nonane and 9-oxa-3,7-diazabicyclo[3.3.1]nonane derivatives
AR088352A1 (en) 2011-10-19 2014-05-28 Merck Sharp & Dohme ANTAGONISTS OF THE RECEIVER OF 2-PIRIDILOXI-4-NITRILE OREXINE
US9029364B2 (en) 2011-10-21 2015-05-12 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. 2,5-disubstituted thiomorpholine orexin receptor antagonists
US8940898B2 (en) 2011-10-25 2015-01-27 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Piperidinyl alkyne orexin receptor antagonists
WO2013062858A1 (en) 2011-10-25 2013-05-02 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Isoxazolopyridine orexin receptor antagonists
PL2776430T3 (en) 2011-11-08 2016-09-30 2- (1,2,3-triazol-2-yl) benzamide and 3-(1,2,3-triazol-2-yl) picolinamide derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
ITMI20112329A1 (en) 2011-12-21 2013-06-22 Rottapharm Spa NEW EXAMINED EXPANDED DERIVATIVES
US9440982B2 (en) 2012-02-07 2016-09-13 Eolas Therapeutics, Inc. Substituted prolines/piperidines as orexin receptor antagonists
US9416109B2 (en) 2012-02-17 2016-08-16 Eisai R&D Management Co., Ltd. Methods and compounds useful in the synthesis of orexin-2 receptor antagonists
ITMI20120424A1 (en) 2012-03-19 2013-09-20 Rottapharm Spa CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS
ES2901418T3 (en) 2014-08-13 2022-03-22 Eolas Therapeutics Inc Difluoropyrrolidines as orexin receptor modulators
WO2017139603A1 (en) * 2016-02-12 2017-08-17 Astrazeneca Ab Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators

Patent Citations (16)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4172896A (en) 1978-06-05 1979-10-30 Dainippon Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Methane-sulfonamide derivatives, the preparation thereof and composition comprising the same
US5427798A (en) 1992-08-14 1995-06-27 Burroughs Wellcome Co. Controlled sustained release tablets containing bupropion
US5541231A (en) 1993-07-30 1996-07-30 Glaxo Wellcome Inc. Stabilized Pharmaceutical
US5731000A (en) 1993-07-30 1998-03-24 Glaxo Wellcome Inc. Stabilized pharmaceutical composition containing bupropion
US5763493A (en) 1993-07-30 1998-06-09 Glaxo Wellcome Inc. Stabilized pharmaceutical
US5358970A (en) 1993-08-12 1994-10-25 Burroughs Wellcome Co. Pharmaceutical composition containing bupropion hydrochloride and a stabilizer
US6583124B2 (en) 1997-07-29 2003-06-24 Alcon Manufacturing, Ltd. Ophthalmic compositions containing galactomannan polymers and borate
US6110973A (en) 1998-01-29 2000-08-29 Sepracor Methods for treating obesity and weight gain using optically pure (-)-bupropion
US20050080056A1 (en) 1999-09-16 2005-04-14 Gerald Horn Ophthalmic formulations including selective alpha 1 antagonists
US20050004074A1 (en) 2003-07-01 2005-01-06 Allergan, Inc. Inhibition of irritating side effects associated with use of a topical ophthalmic medication
US20050031697A1 (en) 2003-08-07 2005-02-10 Allergan, Inc. Compositions for delivery of therapeutics into the eyes and methods for making and using same
US20050059744A1 (en) 2003-09-12 2005-03-17 Allergan, Inc. Methods and compositions for the treatment of pain and other alpha 2 adrenergic-mediated conditions
WO2008147518A1 (en) 2007-05-23 2008-12-04 Merck & Co., Inc. Pyridyl piperidine orexin receptor antagonists
WO2013119639A1 (en) * 2012-02-07 2013-08-15 Eolas Therapeutics, Inc. Substituted prolines / piperidines as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2013127913A1 (en) * 2012-03-01 2013-09-06 Rottapharm S.P.A. 4,4-difluoro-piperidine-compounds
WO2015123355A1 (en) * 2014-02-12 2015-08-20 Eolas Therapeutics, Inc. Substituted prolines / piperidines as orexin receptor antagonists

Non-Patent Citations (20)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
"Harwood Academic Publishers", 1991
"Loudon, Organic Chemistry, Fourth Edition", vol. 1084-1085, 2002, OXFORD UNIVERSITY PRESS, pages: 360 - 361
"Remington's Pharmaceutical Science", 1985, MACK PUBLISHING COMPANY
BAGSHAWE, DRUG DEV. RES., vol. 34, 1995, pages 220 - 230
BERTOLINI ET AL., J. MED. CHEM., vol. 40, 1997, pages 2011 - 2016
BIOORGANIC&MEDICINAL CHEMISTRY LETTERS, vol. 22, 2012, pages 3890 - 3894
BIOORGANIC&MEDICINAL CHEMISTRY LETTERS, vol. 25, 2015, pages 1884 - 1891
BODOR, ADV. DRUG RES., vol. 13, 1984, pages 255 - 331
CHEMMEDCHEM, vol. 7, 2012, pages 415 - 424
GREENEWUTS: "Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry", 1999, JOHN WILEY & SONS
ISSELBACHER ET AL., HARRISON'S PRINCIPLES OF INTERNAL MEDICINE, 1996, pages 1814 - 1882
J. MED. CHEM., vol. 58, 2015, pages 5620 - 5636
J. MED. CHEM., vol. 59, no. 2, 2016, pages 504 - 530
JIANG, R. ET AL.: "Disubstituted piperidines as potent orexin (hypocretin) receptor antagonists", BIOORGANIC & MEDICINAL CHEMISTRY LETTERS, vol. 22, 2012, pages 3890 - 3894, XP029121646, DOI: doi:10.1016/j.bmcl.2012.04.122 *
NYHARRISON ET AL.: "Compendium of Synthetic Organic Methods", vol. 1-8, 1971, JOHN WILEY & SONS
S.M. BERGE ET AL.: "Pharmaceutical Salts", J. PHARM. SCI., vol. 66, 1977, pages 1 - 19, XP002675560, DOI: 10.1002/jps.2600660104
SAKURAI T. ET AL., CELL, vol. 92, 1998, pages 573 - 585
SHAN ET AL., J. PHARM. SCI., vol. 86, no. 7, 1997, pages 765 - 767
SIMPLICIO ET AL.: "Prodrugs for Amines", MOLECULES, vol. 13, 2008, pages 519 - 547, XP002710664, DOI: 10.3390/molecules13030519
SMITHMARCH: "March's Advanced Organic Chemistry: Reactions, Mechanisms, and Structure", 2001, WILEY-INTERSCIENCE

Cited By (7)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11660293B2 (en) 2017-09-01 2023-05-30 Chronos Therapeutics Limited Substituted 2-azabicyclo[3.1.1]heptane and 2-azabicyclo[3.2.1]octane derivatives as orexin receptor antagonists
WO2019063605A1 (en) * 2017-09-28 2019-04-04 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh Novel n-(2,2-difluoroethyl)-n-[(pyrimidinylamino)propanyl]arylcarboxamides
CN111132975A (en) * 2017-09-28 2020-05-08 勃林格殷格翰国际有限公司 Novel N- (2, 2-difluoroethyl) -N- [ (pyrimidinylamino) propyl ] arylcarboxamides
US11324724B2 (en) 2017-09-28 2022-05-10 Boehringer Ingelheim International Gmbh N-(2,2-difluoroethyl)-N-[(pyrimidinylamino)propanyl]arylcarboxamides
CN111132975B (en) * 2017-09-28 2023-05-23 勃林格殷格翰国际有限公司 N- (2, 2-difluoroethyl) -N- [ (pyrimidinylamino) propyl ] arylcarboxamide
WO2020023723A1 (en) * 2018-07-27 2020-01-30 Icahn School Of Medicine At Mount Sinai Method of treating aggression with orexin receptor antagonists
WO2021085550A1 (en) 2019-11-01 2021-05-06 ユニマテック株式会社 Fluorinated pyrimidine compound and method for manufacturing same

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US20220380359A1 (en) 2022-12-01
CA3013927A1 (en) 2017-08-17
CN109219606B (en) 2021-10-01
DK3414241T3 (en) 2022-08-01
IL260788A (en) 2018-10-31
TW201731835A (en) 2017-09-16
PH12018501708A1 (en) 2019-05-20
HRP20220906T1 (en) 2022-10-14
US20190135800A1 (en) 2019-05-09
SV2018005731A (en) 2018-11-27
CL2018002121A1 (en) 2019-01-11
AU2017217931A1 (en) 2018-08-09
ZA201805839B (en) 2022-05-25
EP3414241A4 (en) 2019-07-17
ES2923790T3 (en) 2022-09-30
EA036542B9 (en) 2020-12-22
KR20180107232A (en) 2018-10-01
BR112018016446A2 (en) 2018-12-26
CN109219606A (en) 2019-01-15
LT3414241T (en) 2022-08-25
US10894789B2 (en) 2021-01-19
EA201891714A1 (en) 2019-02-28
IL260788B (en) 2021-08-31
RS63471B1 (en) 2022-08-31
BR112018016446B1 (en) 2024-02-06
SG11201806368VA (en) 2018-08-30
EA036542B1 (en) 2020-11-20
DOP2018000179A (en) 2018-10-15
CA3013927C (en) 2024-02-13
TWI710557B (en) 2020-11-21
CR20180429A (en) 2018-12-05
MY195239A (en) 2023-01-11
EP3414241A1 (en) 2018-12-19
EP3414241B1 (en) 2022-05-04
HUE059280T2 (en) 2022-11-28
PT3414241T (en) 2022-07-29
SI3414241T1 (en) 2022-10-28
CO2018009290A2 (en) 2018-10-10
AU2017217931B2 (en) 2020-10-22
MX2018009656A (en) 2019-02-20
US11434236B2 (en) 2022-09-06
JP6883045B2 (en) 2021-06-02
US20210214348A1 (en) 2021-07-15
US12084437B2 (en) 2024-09-10
JP2019511466A (en) 2019-04-25
TN2018000280A1 (en) 2020-01-16
PL3414241T3 (en) 2022-10-03

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
EP3180332B1 (en) Difluoropyrrolidines as orexin receptor modulators
US12084437B2 (en) Halo-substituted piperidines as orexin receptor modulators
ES2791315T3 (en) Triazole agonists of the APJ receptor
JP6001048B2 (en) Thiazolopyrimidine compounds
US8987310B2 (en) Heterocycle amide T-type calcium channel antagonists
WO2015124934A1 (en) Subsituted cyclopentanes, tetrahydrofuranes and pyrrolidines as orexin receptor antagonists
JP4870164B2 (en) Naphthyridine derivatives

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 17750847

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 11201806368V

Country of ref document: SG

Ref document number: 260788

Country of ref document: IL

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 3013927

Country of ref document: CA

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: MX/A/2018/009656

Country of ref document: MX

Ref document number: 001501-2018

Country of ref document: PE

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2017217931

Country of ref document: AU

Date of ref document: 20170210

Kind code of ref document: A

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2018-000084 I

Country of ref document: NI

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2018542231

Country of ref document: JP

Kind code of ref document: A

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

REG Reference to national code

Ref country code: BR

Ref legal event code: B01A

Ref document number: 112018016446

Country of ref document: BR

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 201891714

Country of ref document: EA

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 20187025645

Country of ref document: KR

Kind code of ref document: A

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: CR2018-000429

Country of ref document: CR

Ref document number: 1020187025645

Country of ref document: KR

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2017750847

Country of ref document: EP

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2017750847

Country of ref document: EP

Effective date: 20180912

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 112018016446

Country of ref document: BR

Kind code of ref document: A2

Effective date: 20180813